2008-10-17 Michael Snyder <msnyder@vmware.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
53 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
54 @end ifset
55 Version @value{GDBVN}.
56
57 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
58 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
59 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
60
61 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
62 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
63 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
64 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
65 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
66 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
67
68 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
69 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
70 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
71 @end ifinfo
72
73 @titlepage
74 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
75 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
76 @sp 1
77 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
78 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
81 @end ifset
82 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
83 @page
84 @tex
85 {\parskip=0pt
86 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
87 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
88 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
89 }
90 @end tex
91
92 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
93 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
94 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
95 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
96 @sp 2
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
103 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
104 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
105 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
106 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
107 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
108
109 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
110 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
111 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
112 @page
113 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
114 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
115 software in general. We will miss him.
116 @end titlepage
117 @page
118
119 @ifnottex
120 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
121
122 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
123
124 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
125
126 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
127 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
128 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
129 @end ifset
130 Version @value{GDBVN}.
131
132 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
133
134 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
135 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
136 software in general. We will miss him.
137
138 @menu
139 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
140 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
141
142 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
143 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
144 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
145 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
146 * Stack:: Examining the stack
147 * Source:: Examining source files
148 * Data:: Examining data
149 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
150 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
151 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
152
153 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
154
155 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
156 * Altering:: Altering execution
157 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
158 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
159 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
160 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
161 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
162 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
163 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
164 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
165 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
166 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
167 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
168
169 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
170
171 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
173 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
174 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
175 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
176 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
177 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
178 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
179 @value{GDBN}
180 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
181 how you can copy and share GDB
182 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
183 * Index:: Index
184 @end menu
185
186 @end ifnottex
187
188 @contents
189
190 @node Summary
191 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
192
193 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
194 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
195 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
196
197 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
198 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
199
200 @itemize @bullet
201 @item
202 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
203
204 @item
205 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
206
207 @item
208 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
209
210 @item
211 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
212 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
213 @end itemize
214
215 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
216 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
217 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
218
219 @cindex Modula-2
220 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
221 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
222
223 @cindex Pascal
224 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
225 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
226 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
227 syntax.
228
229 @cindex Fortran
230 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
231 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
232 underscore.
233
234 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
235 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
236
237 @menu
238 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
239 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
240 @end menu
241
242 @node Free Software
243 @unnumberedsec Free Software
244
245 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
246 General Public License
247 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
248 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
249 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
250 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
251 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
252 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
253
254 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
255 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
256 from anyone else.
257
258 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
259
260 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
261 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
262 include with the free software. Many of our most important
263 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
264 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
265 when an important free software package does not come with a free
266 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
267 gaps today.
268
269 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
270 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
271 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
272 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
273 them from the free software world.
274
275 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
276 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
277 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
278 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
279 contract to make it non-free.
280
281 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
282 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
283 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
284 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
285 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
286 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
287 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
288
289 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
290 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
291 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
292 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
293
294 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
295 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
296 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
297 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
298 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
299 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
300 community.
301
302 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
303 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
304 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
305 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
306 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
307 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
308 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
309 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
310 of the manual.
311
312 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
313 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
314 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
315 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
316 manual to replace it.
317
318 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
319 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
320 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
321 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
322 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
323 the free software community.
324
325 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
326 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
327 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
328 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
329 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
330 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
331 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
332 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
333 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
334
335 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
336 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
337 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
338 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
339 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
340 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
341 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
342 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
343
344 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
345 published by other publishers, at
346 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
347
348 @node Contributors
349 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
350
351 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
352 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
353 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
354 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
355 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
356 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
357 blow-by-blow account.
358
359 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
360
361 @quotation
362 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
363 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
364 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
365 @end quotation
366
367 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
368 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
369 releases:
370 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
371 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
372 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
373 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
374 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
375 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
376 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
377 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
378 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
379
380 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
381 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
382
383 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
384 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
385 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
386 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
387 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
388
389 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
390 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
391 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
392
393 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
394 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
395
396 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
397
398 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
399 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
400 support.
401 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
402 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
403 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
404 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
405 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
406 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
407 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
408 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
409 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
410 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
411 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
412 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
413 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
414 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
415 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
416 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
417
418 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
419
420 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
421 libraries.
422
423 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
424 about several machine instruction sets.
425
426 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
427 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
428 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
429 and RDI targets, respectively.
430
431 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
432 command-line editing and command history.
433
434 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
435 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
436
437 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
438 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
439 symbols.
440
441 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
442 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
443
444 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
445
446 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
447 processors.
448
449 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
450
451 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
452
453 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
454
455 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
456 watchpoints.
457
458 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
459
460 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
461
462 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
463 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
464
465 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
466 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
467 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
468 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
469 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
470 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
471 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
472
473 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
474 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
475
476 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
477 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
478 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
479 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
480 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
481 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
482 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
483 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
484 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
485 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
486 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
487 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
488 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
489 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
490 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
491
492 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
493 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
494
495 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
496 Hat.
497
498 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
499 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
500 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
501 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
502 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
503 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
504
505 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
506 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
507 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
508 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
509 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
510 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
511 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
512 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
513 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
514 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
515 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
516 Weigand.
517
518 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
519 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
520 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
521 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
522
523 @node Sample Session
524 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
525
526 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
527 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
528 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
529
530 @iftex
531 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
532 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
533 @end iftex
534
535 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
536 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
537
538 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
539 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
540 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
541 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
542 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
543 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
544 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
545 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
546 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
547
548 @smallexample
549 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
550 $ @b{./m4}
551 @b{define(foo,0000)}
552
553 @b{foo}
554 0000
555 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
556
557 @b{bar}
558 0000
559 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
560
561 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
562 @b{baz}
563 @b{Ctrl-d}
564 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
565 @end smallexample
566
567 @noindent
568 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
569
570 @smallexample
571 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
572 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
573 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
574 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
575 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
576 the conditions.
577 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
578 for details.
579
580 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
581 (@value{GDBP})
582 @end smallexample
583
584 @noindent
585 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
586 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
587 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
588 that examples fit in this manual.
589
590 @smallexample
591 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
592 @end smallexample
593
594 @noindent
595 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
596 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
597 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
598 @code{break} command.
599
600 @smallexample
601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
602 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
607 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
608 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
609
610 @smallexample
611 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
612 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
613 @b{define(foo,0000)}
614
615 @b{foo}
616 0000
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
621 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
622 context where it stops.
623
624 @smallexample
625 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
626
627 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
628 at builtin.c:879
629 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
634 the next line of the current function.
635
636 @smallexample
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
639 : nil,
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
644 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
645 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
646 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
647
648 @smallexample
649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
650 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
651 at input.c:530
652 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
653 @end smallexample
654
655 @noindent
656 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
657 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
658 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
659 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
660 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
661 stack frame for each active subroutine.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
665 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
666 at input.c:530
667 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
668 at builtin.c:882
669 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
670 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
671 at macro.c:71
672 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
673 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
678 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
679 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
680
681 @smallexample
682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
683 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
685 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
686 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
688 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
689 : xstrdup(rq);
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
691 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
692 @end smallexample
693
694 @noindent
695 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
696 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
697 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
698 (@code{print}) to see their values.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
702 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
704 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
709 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
710 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
714 533 xfree(rquote);
715 534
716 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
717 : xstrdup (lq);
718 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
719 : xstrdup (rq);
720 537
721 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
722 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
723 540 @}
724 541
725 542 void
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
730 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
731
732 @smallexample
733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
734 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
735 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
736 540 @}
737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
738 $3 = 9
739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
740 $4 = 7
741 @end smallexample
742
743 @noindent
744 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
745 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
746 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
747 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
748 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
749 assignments.
750
751 @smallexample
752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
753 $5 = 7
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
755 $6 = 9
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @noindent
759 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
760 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
761 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
762 example that caused trouble initially:
763
764 @smallexample
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
766 Continuing.
767
768 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
769
770 baz
771 0000
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
776 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
777 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
778
779 @smallexample
780 @b{Ctrl-d}
781 Program exited normally.
782 @end smallexample
783
784 @noindent
785 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
786 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
787 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
788
789 @smallexample
790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
791 @end smallexample
792
793 @node Invocation
794 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
795
796 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
797 The essentials are:
798 @itemize @bullet
799 @item
800 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
801 @item
802 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
803 @end itemize
804
805 @menu
806 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
807 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
808 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
809 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
810 @end menu
811
812 @node Invoking GDB
813 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
814
815 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
816 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
817
818 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
819 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
820
821 The command-line options described here are designed
822 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
823 options may effectively be unavailable.
824
825 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
826 specifying an executable program:
827
828 @smallexample
829 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
830 @end smallexample
831
832 @noindent
833 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
834 specified:
835
836 @smallexample
837 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
838 @end smallexample
839
840 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
841 to debug a running process:
842
843 @smallexample
844 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
845 @end smallexample
846
847 @noindent
848 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
849 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
850
851 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
852 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
853 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
854 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
855 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
856
857 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
858 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
859 option processing.
860 @smallexample
861 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
862 @end smallexample
863 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
864 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
865
866 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
867 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
868
869 @smallexample
870 @value{GDBP} -silent
871 @end smallexample
872
873 @noindent
874 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
875 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
876
877 @noindent
878 Type
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} -help
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
886 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
887
888 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
889 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
890 @samp{-x} option is used.
891
892
893 @menu
894 * File Options:: Choosing files
895 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
896 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
897 @end menu
898
899 @node File Options
900 @subsection Choosing Files
901
902 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
903 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
904 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
905 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
906 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
907 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
908 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
909 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
910 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
911 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
912 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
913 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
914 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
915
916 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
917 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
918 argument and ignore it.
919
920 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
921 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
922 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
923 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
924 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
925
926 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
927 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
928 @c it.
929
930 @table @code
931 @item -symbols @var{file}
932 @itemx -s @var{file}
933 @cindex @code{--symbols}
934 @cindex @code{-s}
935 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
936
937 @item -exec @var{file}
938 @itemx -e @var{file}
939 @cindex @code{--exec}
940 @cindex @code{-e}
941 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
942 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
943
944 @item -se @var{file}
945 @cindex @code{--se}
946 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
947 file.
948
949 @item -core @var{file}
950 @itemx -c @var{file}
951 @cindex @code{--core}
952 @cindex @code{-c}
953 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
954
955 @item -pid @var{number}
956 @itemx -p @var{number}
957 @cindex @code{--pid}
958 @cindex @code{-p}
959 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
960
961 @item -command @var{file}
962 @itemx -x @var{file}
963 @cindex @code{--command}
964 @cindex @code{-x}
965 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
966 Files,, Command files}.
967
968 @item -eval-command @var{command}
969 @itemx -ex @var{command}
970 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
971 @cindex @code{-ex}
972 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
973
974 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
975 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
976
977 @smallexample
978 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
979 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
980 @end smallexample
981
982 @item -directory @var{directory}
983 @itemx -d @var{directory}
984 @cindex @code{--directory}
985 @cindex @code{-d}
986 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
987
988 @item -r
989 @itemx -readnow
990 @cindex @code{--readnow}
991 @cindex @code{-r}
992 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
993 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
994 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
995
996 @end table
997
998 @node Mode Options
999 @subsection Choosing Modes
1000
1001 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1002 batch mode or quiet mode.
1003
1004 @table @code
1005 @item -nx
1006 @itemx -n
1007 @cindex @code{--nx}
1008 @cindex @code{-n}
1009 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1010 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1011 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1012 Files}.
1013
1014 @item -quiet
1015 @itemx -silent
1016 @itemx -q
1017 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1018 @cindex @code{--silent}
1019 @cindex @code{-q}
1020 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1021 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1022
1023 @item -batch
1024 @cindex @code{--batch}
1025 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1026 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1027 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1028 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1029 in the command files.
1030
1031 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1032 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1033 make this more useful, the message
1034
1035 @smallexample
1036 Program exited normally.
1037 @end smallexample
1038
1039 @noindent
1040 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1041 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1042 mode.
1043
1044 @item -batch-silent
1045 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1046 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1047 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1048 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1049 for an interactive session.
1050
1051 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1052 messages, for example.
1053
1054 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1055 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1056
1057 @item -return-child-result
1058 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1059 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1060 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1061
1062 @itemize @bullet
1063 @item
1064 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1065 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1066 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1067 @item
1068 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1069 @item
1070 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1071 the exit code will be -1.
1072 @end itemize
1073
1074 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1075 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1076 interface.
1077
1078 @item -nowindows
1079 @itemx -nw
1080 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1081 @cindex @code{-nw}
1082 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1083 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1084 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1085
1086 @item -windows
1087 @itemx -w
1088 @cindex @code{--windows}
1089 @cindex @code{-w}
1090 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1091 used if possible.
1092
1093 @item -cd @var{directory}
1094 @cindex @code{--cd}
1095 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1096 instead of the current directory.
1097
1098 @item -fullname
1099 @itemx -f
1100 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1101 @cindex @code{-f}
1102 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1103 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1104 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1105 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1106 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1107 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1108 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1109 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1110 frame.
1111
1112 @item -epoch
1113 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1114 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1115 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1116 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1117 separate window.
1118
1119 @item -annotate @var{level}
1120 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1121 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1122 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1123 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1124 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1125 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1126 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1127 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1128 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1129
1130 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1131 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1132
1133 @item --args
1134 @cindex @code{--args}
1135 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1136 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1137 This option stops option processing.
1138
1139 @item -baud @var{bps}
1140 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1141 @cindex @code{--baud}
1142 @cindex @code{-b}
1143 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1144 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1145
1146 @item -l @var{timeout}
1147 @cindex @code{-l}
1148 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1149 for remote debugging.
1150
1151 @item -tty @var{device}
1152 @itemx -t @var{device}
1153 @cindex @code{--tty}
1154 @cindex @code{-t}
1155 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1156 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1157
1158 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1159 @item -tui
1160 @cindex @code{--tui}
1161 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1162 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1163 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1164 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1165 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1166 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1167 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1168
1169 @c @item -xdb
1170 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1171 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1172 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1173 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1174 @c systems.
1175
1176 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1177 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1178 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1179 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1180 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1181 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1182
1183 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1184 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1185 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1186 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1187 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1188 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1189
1190 @item -write
1191 @cindex @code{--write}
1192 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1193 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1194 (@pxref{Patching}).
1195
1196 @item -statistics
1197 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1198 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1199 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1200
1201 @item -version
1202 @cindex @code{--version}
1203 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1204 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1205
1206 @end table
1207
1208 @node Startup
1209 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1210 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1211
1212 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1213
1214 @enumerate
1215 @item
1216 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1217 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1218
1219 @item
1220 @cindex init file
1221 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1222 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1223 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1224 that file.
1225
1226 @item
1227 Processes command line options and operands.
1228
1229 @item
1230 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1231 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1232 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1233 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1234 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1235 @value{GDBN}.
1236
1237 @item
1238 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1239 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1240
1241 @item
1242 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1243 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1244 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1245 @end enumerate
1246
1247 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1248 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1249 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1250 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1251 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1252 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1253
1254 @cindex init file name
1255 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1256 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1257 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1258 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1259 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1260 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1261 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1262 the file to the standard name.
1263
1264
1265 @node Quitting GDB
1266 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1267 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1268 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1269
1270 @table @code
1271 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1272 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1273 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1274 @itemx q
1275 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1276 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1277 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1278 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1279 error code.
1280 @end table
1281
1282 @cindex interrupt
1283 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1284 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1285 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1286 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1287 until a time when it is safe.
1288
1289 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1290 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1291 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1292
1293 @node Shell Commands
1294 @section Shell Commands
1295
1296 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1297 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1298 just use the @code{shell} command.
1299
1300 @table @code
1301 @kindex shell
1302 @cindex shell escape
1303 @item shell @var{command string}
1304 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1305 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1306 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1307 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1308 @end table
1309
1310 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1311 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1312 @value{GDBN}:
1313
1314 @table @code
1315 @kindex make
1316 @cindex calling make
1317 @item make @var{make-args}
1318 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1319 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1320 @end table
1321
1322 @node Logging Output
1323 @section Logging Output
1324 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1325 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1326
1327 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1328 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1329
1330 @table @code
1331 @kindex set logging
1332 @item set logging on
1333 Enable logging.
1334 @item set logging off
1335 Disable logging.
1336 @cindex logging file name
1337 @item set logging file @var{file}
1338 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1339 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1340 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1341 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1342 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1343 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1344 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1345 @kindex show logging
1346 @item show logging
1347 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1348 @end table
1349
1350 @node Commands
1351 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1352
1353 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1354 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1355 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1356 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1357 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1358
1359 @menu
1360 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1361 * Completion:: Command completion
1362 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1363 @end menu
1364
1365 @node Command Syntax
1366 @section Command Syntax
1367
1368 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1369 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1370 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1371 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1372 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1373 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1374
1375 @cindex abbreviation
1376 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1377 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1378 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1379 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1380 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1381 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1382 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1383
1384 @cindex repeating commands
1385 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1386 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1387 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1388 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1389 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1390 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1391 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1392
1393 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1394 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1395 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1396
1397 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1398 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1399 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1400 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1401 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1402
1403 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1404 @cindex comment
1405 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1406 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1407 Files,,Command Files}).
1408
1409 @cindex repeating command sequences
1410 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1411 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1412 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1413 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1414 for editing.
1415
1416 @node Completion
1417 @section Command Completion
1418
1419 @cindex completion
1420 @cindex word completion
1421 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1422 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1423 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1424 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1425
1426 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1427 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1428 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1429 enter it). For example, if you type
1430
1431 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1432 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1433 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1434 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1435 @smallexample
1436 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1437 @end smallexample
1438
1439 @noindent
1440 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1441 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1442
1443 @smallexample
1444 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1445 @end smallexample
1446
1447 @noindent
1448 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1449 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1450 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1451 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1452 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1453 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1454
1455 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1456 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1457 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1458 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1459 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1460 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1461 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1462 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1463 example:
1464
1465 @smallexample
1466 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1467 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1468 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1469 make_abs_section make_function_type
1470 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1471 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1472 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1473 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1474 @end smallexample
1475
1476 @noindent
1477 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1478 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1479 command.
1480
1481 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1482 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1483 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1484 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1485 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1486
1487 @cindex quotes in commands
1488 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1489 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1490 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1491 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1492 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1493 @value{GDBN} commands.
1494
1495 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1496 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1497 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1498 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1499 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1500 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1501 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1502 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1503 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1504 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1505 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1506
1507 @smallexample
1508 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1509 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1510 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1511 @end smallexample
1512
1513 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1514 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1515 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1516 place:
1517
1518 @smallexample
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1520 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1521 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1522 @end smallexample
1523
1524 @noindent
1525 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1526 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1527 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1528
1529 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1530 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1531 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1532 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1533
1534 @cindex completion of structure field names
1535 @cindex structure field name completion
1536 @cindex completion of union field names
1537 @cindex union field name completion
1538 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1539 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1540 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1541 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1542 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1543 left-hand-side:
1544
1545 @smallexample
1546 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1547 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1548 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1549 @end smallexample
1550
1551 @noindent
1552 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1553 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1554 follows:
1555
1556 @smallexample
1557 struct ui_file
1558 @{
1559 int *magic;
1560 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1561 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1562 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1563 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1564 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1565 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1566 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1567 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1568 void *to_data;
1569 @}
1570 @end smallexample
1571
1572
1573 @node Help
1574 @section Getting Help
1575 @cindex online documentation
1576 @kindex help
1577
1578 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1579 using the command @code{help}.
1580
1581 @table @code
1582 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1583 @item help
1584 @itemx h
1585 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1586 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1587
1588 @smallexample
1589 (@value{GDBP}) help
1590 List of classes of commands:
1591
1592 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1593 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1594 data -- Examining data
1595 files -- Specifying and examining files
1596 internals -- Maintenance commands
1597 obscure -- Obscure features
1598 running -- Running the program
1599 stack -- Examining the stack
1600 status -- Status inquiries
1601 support -- Support facilities
1602 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1603 stopping the program
1604 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1605
1606 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1607 commands in that class.
1608 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1609 documentation.
1610 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1611 (@value{GDBP})
1612 @end smallexample
1613 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1614
1615 @item help @var{class}
1616 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1617 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1618 help display for the class @code{status}:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1622 Status inquiries.
1623
1624 List of commands:
1625
1626 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1627 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1628 info -- Generic command for showing things
1629 about the program being debugged
1630 show -- Generic command for showing things
1631 about the debugger
1632
1633 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1634 documentation.
1635 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1636 (@value{GDBP})
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @item help @var{command}
1640 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1641 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1642
1643 @kindex apropos
1644 @item apropos @var{args}
1645 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1646 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1647 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1648
1649 @smallexample
1650 apropos reload
1651 @end smallexample
1652
1653 @noindent
1654 results in:
1655
1656 @smallexample
1657 @c @group
1658 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1659 multiple times in one run
1660 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1661 multiple times in one run
1662 @c @end group
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @kindex complete
1666 @item complete @var{args}
1667 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1668 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1669 command you want completed. For example:
1670
1671 @smallexample
1672 complete i
1673 @end smallexample
1674
1675 @noindent results in:
1676
1677 @smallexample
1678 @group
1679 if
1680 ignore
1681 info
1682 inspect
1683 @end group
1684 @end smallexample
1685
1686 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1687 @end table
1688
1689 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1690 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1691 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1692 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1693 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1694 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1695
1696 @c @group
1697 @table @code
1698 @kindex info
1699 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1700 @item info
1701 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1702 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1703 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1704 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1705 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1706 @w{@code{help info}}.
1707
1708 @kindex set
1709 @item set
1710 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1711 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1712 @code{set prompt $}.
1713
1714 @kindex show
1715 @item show
1716 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1717 @value{GDBN} itself.
1718 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1719 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1720 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1721 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1722
1723 @kindex info set
1724 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1725 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1726 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1727 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1728 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1729 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1730 @end table
1731 @c @end group
1732
1733 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1734 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1735
1736 @table @code
1737 @kindex show version
1738 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1739 @item show version
1740 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1741 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1742 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1743 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1744 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1745 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1746 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1747 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1748 @value{GDBN}.
1749
1750 @kindex show copying
1751 @kindex info copying
1752 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1753 @item show copying
1754 @itemx info copying
1755 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1756
1757 @kindex show warranty
1758 @kindex info warranty
1759 @item show warranty
1760 @itemx info warranty
1761 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1762 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1763
1764 @end table
1765
1766 @node Running
1767 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1768
1769 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1770 debugging information when you compile it.
1771
1772 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1773 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1774 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1775 kill a child process.
1776
1777 @menu
1778 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1779 * Starting:: Starting your program
1780 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1781 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1782
1783 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1784 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1785 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1786 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1787
1788 * Inferiors:: Debugging multiple inferiors
1789 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1790 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1791 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1792 @end menu
1793
1794 @node Compilation
1795 @section Compiling for Debugging
1796
1797 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1798 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1799 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1800 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1801 and addresses in the executable code.
1802
1803 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1804 the compiler.
1805
1806 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1807 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1808 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1809 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1810 executables containing debugging information.
1811
1812 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1813 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1814 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1815 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1816 in pushing your luck.
1817
1818 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1819 @cindex debugging optimized code
1820 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1821 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1822 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1823 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1824 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1825 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1826
1827 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1828 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1829 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1830 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1831 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1832
1833 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1834 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1835 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1836
1837 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1838 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1839 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1840 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1841 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1842 provides macro information if you specify the options
1843 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1844 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1845 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1846 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1847 @option{-g} alone.
1848
1849 @need 2000
1850 @node Starting
1851 @section Starting your Program
1852 @cindex starting
1853 @cindex running
1854
1855 @table @code
1856 @kindex run
1857 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1858 @item run
1859 @itemx r
1860 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1861 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1862 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1863 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1864 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1865
1866 @end table
1867
1868 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1869 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1870 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1871 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1872 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1873 message like this one:
1874
1875 @smallexample
1876 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1877 Try "help target" or "continue".
1878 @end smallexample
1879
1880 @noindent
1881 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1882 first (@pxref{load}).
1883
1884 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1885 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1886 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1887 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1888 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1889 divided into four categories:
1890
1891 @table @asis
1892 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1893 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1894 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1895 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1896 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1897 the arguments.
1898 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1899 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1900 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1901
1902 @item The @emph{environment.}
1903 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1904 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1905 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1906 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1907
1908 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1909 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1910 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1911 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1912
1913 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1914 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1915 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1916 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1917 set a different device for your program.
1918 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1919
1920 @cindex pipes
1921 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1922 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1923 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1924 wrong program.
1925 @end table
1926
1927 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1928 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1929 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1930 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1931 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1932
1933 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1934 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1935 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1936 your current breakpoints.
1937
1938 @table @code
1939 @kindex start
1940 @item start
1941 @cindex run to main procedure
1942 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1943 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1944 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1945 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1946 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1947 procedure, depending on the language used.
1948
1949 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1950 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1951 the @samp{run} command.
1952
1953 @cindex elaboration phase
1954 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1955 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1956 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1957 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1958 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1959 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1960 will remain to halt execution.
1961
1962 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1963 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1964 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1965 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1966 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1967
1968 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1969 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1970 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1971 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1972 elaboration code before running your program.
1973
1974 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1975 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1976 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1977 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1978 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1979 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1980 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1981 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1982 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1983 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1984 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1985
1986 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1987 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1988 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1989 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1990
1991 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1992 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1993 environment:
1994
1995 @smallexample
1996 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1997 (@value{GDBP}) run
1998 @end smallexample
1999
2000 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2001 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2002
2003 @kindex set disable-randomization
2004 @item set disable-randomization
2005 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2006 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2007 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2008 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2009 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2010
2011 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2012 behavior using
2013
2014 @smallexample
2015 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2016 @end smallexample
2017
2018 @item set disable-randomization off
2019 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2020 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2021 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2022 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2023 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2024 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2025
2026 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2027 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2028 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2029 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2030 a code at its expected addresses.
2031
2032 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2033 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2034 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2035 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2036 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2037 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2038 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2039 a randomly chosen address.
2040
2041 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2042 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2043 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2044 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2045 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2046
2047 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2048 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2049
2050 @item show disable-randomization
2051 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2052 the virtual address space of the started program.
2053
2054 @end table
2055
2056 @node Arguments
2057 @section Your Program's Arguments
2058
2059 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2060 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2061 @code{run} command.
2062 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2063 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2064 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2065 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2066 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2067
2068 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2069 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2070 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2071 the program, not by the shell.
2072
2073 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2074 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2075
2076 @table @code
2077 @kindex set args
2078 @item set args
2079 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2080 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2081 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2082 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2083 it again without arguments.
2084
2085 @kindex show args
2086 @item show args
2087 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2088 @end table
2089
2090 @node Environment
2091 @section Your Program's Environment
2092
2093 @cindex environment (of your program)
2094 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2095 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2096 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2097 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2098 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2099 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2100 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2101
2102 @table @code
2103 @kindex path
2104 @item path @var{directory}
2105 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2106 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2107 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2108 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2109 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2110 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2111 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2112
2113 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2114 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2115 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2116 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2117 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2118 @var{directory} to the search path.
2119 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2120 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2121
2122 @kindex show paths
2123 @item show paths
2124 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2125 environment variable).
2126
2127 @kindex show environment
2128 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2129 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2130 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2131 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2132 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2133
2134 @kindex set environment
2135 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2136 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2137 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2138 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2139 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2140 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2141 null value.
2142 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2143 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2144
2145 For example, this command:
2146
2147 @smallexample
2148 set env USER = foo
2149 @end smallexample
2150
2151 @noindent
2152 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2153 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2154 are not actually required.)
2155
2156 @kindex unset environment
2157 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2158 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2159 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2160 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2161 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2162 @end table
2163
2164 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2165 the shell indicated
2166 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2167 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2168 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2169 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2170 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2171 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2172 @file{.profile}.
2173
2174 @node Working Directory
2175 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2176
2177 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2178 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2179 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2180 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2181 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2182 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2183
2184 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2185 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2186 Specify Files}.
2187
2188 @table @code
2189 @kindex cd
2190 @cindex change working directory
2191 @item cd @var{directory}
2192 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2193
2194 @kindex pwd
2195 @item pwd
2196 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2197 @end table
2198
2199 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2200 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2201 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2202 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2203 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2204 current working directory of the debuggee.
2205
2206 @node Input/Output
2207 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2208
2209 @cindex redirection
2210 @cindex i/o
2211 @cindex terminal
2212 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2213 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2214 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2215 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2216 running your program.
2217
2218 @table @code
2219 @kindex info terminal
2220 @item info terminal
2221 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2222 program is using.
2223 @end table
2224
2225 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2226 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2227
2228 @smallexample
2229 run > outfile
2230 @end smallexample
2231
2232 @noindent
2233 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2234
2235 @kindex tty
2236 @cindex controlling terminal
2237 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2238 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2239 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2240 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2241 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2242
2243 @smallexample
2244 tty /dev/ttyb
2245 @end smallexample
2246
2247 @noindent
2248 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2249 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2250 that as their controlling terminal.
2251
2252 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2253 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2254 terminal.
2255
2256 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2257 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2258 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2259 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2260
2261 @cindex inferior tty
2262 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2263 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2264 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2265 program.
2266
2267 @table @code
2268 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2269 @kindex set inferior-tty
2270 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2271
2272 @item show inferior-tty
2273 @kindex show inferior-tty
2274 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2275 @end table
2276
2277 @node Attach
2278 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2279 @kindex attach
2280 @cindex attach
2281
2282 @table @code
2283 @item attach @var{process-id}
2284 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2285 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2286 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2287 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2288 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2289
2290 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2291 executing the command.
2292 @end table
2293
2294 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2295 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2296 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2297 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2298
2299 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2300 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2301 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2302 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2303 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2304 Specify Files}.
2305
2306 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2307 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2308 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2309 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2310 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2311 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2312 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2313
2314 @table @code
2315 @kindex detach
2316 @item detach
2317 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2318 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2319 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2320 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2321 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2322 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2323 executing the command.
2324 @end table
2325
2326 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2327 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2328 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2329 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2330 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2331 Messages}).
2332
2333 @node Kill Process
2334 @section Killing the Child Process
2335
2336 @table @code
2337 @kindex kill
2338 @item kill
2339 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2340 @end table
2341
2342 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2343 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2344 is running.
2345
2346 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2347 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2348 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2349 outside the debugger.
2350
2351 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2352 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2353 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2354 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2355 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2356 breakpoint settings).
2357
2358 @node Inferiors
2359 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2360
2361 Some @value{GDBN} targets are able to run multiple processes created
2362 from a single executable. This can happen, for instance, with an
2363 embedded system reporting back several processes via the remote
2364 protocol.
2365
2366 @cindex inferior
2367 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2368 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2369 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2370 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2371 may (in future) be retained after a process exits. Each run of an
2372 executable creates a new inferior, as does each attachment to an
2373 existing process. Inferiors have unique identifiers that are
2374 different from process ids, and may optionally be named as well.
2375 Usually each inferior will also have its own distinct address space,
2376 although some embedded targets may have several inferiors running in
2377 different parts of a single space.
2378
2379 Each inferior may in turn have multiple threads running in it.
2380
2381 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @code{info inferiors}:
2382
2383 @table @code
2384 @kindex info inferiors
2385 @item info inferiors
2386 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2387
2388 @kindex set print inferior-events
2389 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2390 @item set print inferior-events
2391 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2392 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2393 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2394 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2395 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2396 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2397
2398 @kindex show print inferior-events
2399 @item show print inferior-events
2400 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2401 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2402 @end table
2403
2404 @node Threads
2405 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2406
2407 @cindex threads of execution
2408 @cindex multiple threads
2409 @cindex switching threads
2410 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2411 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2412 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2413 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2414 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2415 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2416 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2417
2418 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2419 programs:
2420
2421 @itemize @bullet
2422 @item automatic notification of new threads
2423 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2424 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2425 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2426 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2427 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2428 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2429 messages on thread start and exit.
2430 @end itemize
2431
2432 @quotation
2433 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2434 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2435 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2436 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2437 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2438 like this:
2439
2440 @smallexample
2441 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2442 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2443 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2444 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2445 @end smallexample
2446 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2447 @c doesn't support threads"?
2448 @end quotation
2449
2450 @cindex focus of debugging
2451 @cindex current thread
2452 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2453 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2454 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2455 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2456 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2457
2458 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2459 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2460 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2461 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2462 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2463 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2464 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2465 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2466 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2467 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2468
2469 @smallexample
2470 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2471 @end smallexample
2472
2473 @noindent
2474 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2475 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2476 further qualifier.
2477
2478 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2479 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2480 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2481 @c program?
2482 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2483 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2484 @c threads ab initio?
2485
2486 @cindex thread number
2487 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2488 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2489 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @kindex info threads
2493 @item info threads
2494 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2495 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2496
2497 @enumerate
2498 @item
2499 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2500
2501 @item
2502 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2503
2504 @item
2505 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2506 @end enumerate
2507
2508 @noindent
2509 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2510 indicates the current thread.
2511
2512 For example,
2513 @end table
2514 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2515
2516 @smallexample
2517 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2518 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2519 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2520 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2521 at threadtest.c:68
2522 @end smallexample
2523
2524 On HP-UX systems:
2525
2526 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2527 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2528 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2529 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2530 thread in your program.
2531
2532 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2533 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2534 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2535 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2536 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2537 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2538 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2539 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2540 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2541 HP-UX, you see
2542
2543 @smallexample
2544 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2545 @end smallexample
2546
2547 @noindent
2548 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2549
2550 @table @code
2551 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2552 @item info threads
2553 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2554 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2555
2556 @enumerate
2557 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2558
2559 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2560
2561 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2562 @end enumerate
2563
2564 @noindent
2565 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2566 indicates the current thread.
2567
2568 For example,
2569 @end table
2570 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2571
2572 @smallexample
2573 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2574 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2575 at quicksort.c:137
2576 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2577 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2578 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2579 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2580 @end smallexample
2581
2582 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2583 Solaris-specific command:
2584
2585 @table @code
2586 @item maint info sol-threads
2587 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2588 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2589 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2590 @end table
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2594 @item thread @var{threadno}
2595 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2596 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2597 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2598 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2599 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2600
2601 @smallexample
2602 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2603 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2604 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2605 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2606 @end smallexample
2607
2608 @noindent
2609 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2610 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2611 threads.
2612
2613 @kindex thread apply
2614 @cindex apply command to several threads
2615 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2616 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2617 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2618 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2619 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2620 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2621 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2622 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2623
2624 @kindex set print thread-events
2625 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2626 @item set print thread-events
2627 @itemx set print thread-events on
2628 @itemx set print thread-events off
2629 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2630 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2631 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2632 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2633 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2634
2635 @kindex show print thread-events
2636 @item show print thread-events
2637 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2638 have started and exited.
2639 @end table
2640
2641 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2642 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2643 programs with multiple threads.
2644
2645 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2646 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2647
2648 @node Processes
2649 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2650
2651 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2652 @cindex multiple processes
2653 @cindex processes, multiple
2654 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2655 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2656 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2657 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2658 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2659 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2660 will cause it to terminate.
2661
2662 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2663 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2664 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2665 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2666 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2667 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2668 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2669 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2670 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2671 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2672
2673 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2674 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2675 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2676 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2677
2678 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2679 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2680
2681 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2682 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2683
2684 @table @code
2685 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2686 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2687 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2688 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2689 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2690
2691 @table @code
2692 @item parent
2693 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2694 unimpeded. This is the default.
2695
2696 @item child
2697 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2698 unimpeded.
2699
2700 @end table
2701
2702 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2703 @item show follow-fork-mode
2704 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2705 @end table
2706
2707 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2708 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2709 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2710
2711 @table @code
2712 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2713 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2714 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2715 retain debugger control over them both.
2716
2717 @table @code
2718 @item on
2719 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2720 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2721 independently. This is the default.
2722
2723 @item off
2724 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2725 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2726 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2727 is held suspended.
2728
2729 @end table
2730
2731 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2732 @item show detach-on-fork
2733 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2734 @end table
2735
2736 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2737 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2738 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2739 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2740 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2741
2742 @table @code
2743 @kindex info forks
2744 @item info forks
2745 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2746 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2747 position (program counter) of the process.
2748
2749 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2750 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2751 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2752 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2753 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2754
2755 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2756 @item process @var{process-id}
2757 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2758 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2759 @samp{info forks}.
2760
2761 @end table
2762
2763 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2764 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2765 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2766 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2767
2768 @table @code
2769 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2770 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2771 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2772 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2773 allowed to run independently.
2774
2775 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2776 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2777 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2778 and remove it from the fork list.
2779
2780 @end table
2781
2782 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2783 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2784 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2785 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2786 the child process's @code{main}.
2787
2788 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2789 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2790
2791 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2792 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2793 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2794 argument.
2795
2796 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2797 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2798 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2799
2800 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2801 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2802
2803 @cindex checkpoint
2804 @cindex restart
2805 @cindex bookmark
2806 @cindex snapshot of a process
2807 @cindex rewind program state
2808
2809 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2810 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2811 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2812 later.
2813
2814 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2815 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2816 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2817 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2818 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2819
2820 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2821 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2822 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2823 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2824 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2825 start again from there.
2826
2827 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2828 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2829
2830 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2831
2832 @table @code
2833 @kindex checkpoint
2834 @item checkpoint
2835 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2836 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2837 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2838
2839 @kindex info checkpoints
2840 @item info checkpoints
2841 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2842 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2843 listed:
2844
2845 @table @code
2846 @item Checkpoint ID
2847 @item Process ID
2848 @item Code Address
2849 @item Source line, or label
2850 @end table
2851
2852 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2853 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2854 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2855 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2856 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2857 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2858 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2859
2860 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2861 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2862 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2863 the debugger.
2864
2865 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2866 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2867 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2868
2869 @end table
2870
2871 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2872 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2873 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2874 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2875 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2876 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2877 previously read data can be read again.
2878
2879 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2880 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2881 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2882 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2883 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2884 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2885
2886 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2887 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2888 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2889 different execution path this time.
2890
2891 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2892 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2893 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2894 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2895 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2896 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2897 potentially pose a problem.
2898
2899 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2900
2901 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2902 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2903 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2904 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2905 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2906 next.
2907
2908 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2909 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2910 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2911 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2912 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2913
2914 @node Stopping
2915 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2916
2917 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2918 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2919 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2920
2921 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2922 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2923 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2924 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2925 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2926 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2927 explicitly request this information at any time.
2928
2929 @table @code
2930 @kindex info program
2931 @item info program
2932 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2933 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2934 @end table
2935
2936 @menu
2937 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2938 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2939 * Signals:: Signals
2940 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2941 @end menu
2942
2943 @node Breakpoints
2944 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2945
2946 @cindex breakpoints
2947 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2948 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2949 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2950 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2951 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2952 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2953 program.
2954
2955 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2956 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2957 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2958 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2959 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2960 call).
2961
2962 @cindex watchpoints
2963 @cindex data breakpoints
2964 @cindex memory tracing
2965 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2966 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2967 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2968 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2969 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2970 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2971 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2972 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2973 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2974 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2975 same commands.
2976
2977 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2978 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2979 Automatic Display}.
2980
2981 @cindex catchpoints
2982 @cindex breakpoint on events
2983 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2984 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2985 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2986 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2987 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2988 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2989 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2990
2991 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2992 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2993 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2994 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2995 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2996 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2997 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2998 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2999 enable it again.
3000
3001 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3002 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3003 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3004 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3005 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3006 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3007 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3008
3009 @menu
3010 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3011 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3012 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3013 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3014 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3015 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3016 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3017 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3018 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3019 @end menu
3020
3021 @node Set Breaks
3022 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3023
3024 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3025 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3026 @c
3027 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3028
3029 @kindex break
3030 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3031 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3032 @cindex latest breakpoint
3033 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3034 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3035 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3036 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3037 convenience variables.
3038
3039 @table @code
3040 @item break @var{location}
3041 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3042 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3043 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3044 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3045 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3046
3047 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3048 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3049 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3050 that situation.
3051
3052 @item break
3053 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3054 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3055 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3056 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3057 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3058 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3059 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3060 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3061 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3062 inside loops.
3063
3064 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3065 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3066 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3067 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3068 existed when your program stopped.
3069
3070 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3071 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3072 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3073 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3074 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3075 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3076 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3077
3078 @kindex tbreak
3079 @item tbreak @var{args}
3080 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3081 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3082 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3083 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3084
3085 @kindex hbreak
3086 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3087 @item hbreak @var{args}
3088 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3089 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3090 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3091 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3092 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3093 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3094 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3095 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3096 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3097 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3098 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3099 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3100 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3101 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3102 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3103 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3104 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3105 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3106
3107 @kindex thbreak
3108 @item thbreak @var{args}
3109 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3110 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3111 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3112 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3113 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3114 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3115 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3116 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3117
3118 @kindex rbreak
3119 @cindex regular expression
3120 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3121 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3122 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3123 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3124 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3125 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3126 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3127 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3128 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3129
3130 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3131 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3132 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3133 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3134 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3135 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3136
3137 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3138 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3139 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3140 classes.
3141
3142 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3143 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3144 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3145
3146 @smallexample
3147 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3148 @end smallexample
3149
3150 @kindex info breakpoints
3151 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3152 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3153 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3154 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3155 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3156 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3157 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3158 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3159
3160 @table @emph
3161 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3162 @item Type
3163 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3164 @item Disposition
3165 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3166 @item Enabled or Disabled
3167 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3168 that are not enabled.
3169 @item Address
3170 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3171 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3172 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3173 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3174 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3175 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3176 @item What
3177 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3178 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3179 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3180 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3181 @end table
3182
3183 @noindent
3184 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3185 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3186 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3187 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3188 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3189 valid location.
3190
3191 @noindent
3192 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3193 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3194 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3195 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3196 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3197
3198 @noindent
3199 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3200 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3201 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3202 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3203 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3204 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3205 @end table
3206
3207 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3208 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3209 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3210 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3211
3212 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3213 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3214 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3215 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3216
3217 @itemize @bullet
3218 @item
3219 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3220 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3221
3222 @item
3223 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3224 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3225
3226 @item
3227 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3228 several places where that function is inlined.
3229 @end itemize
3230
3231 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3232 the relevant locations@footnote{
3233 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3234 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3235 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3236 info with line numbers for them.}.
3237
3238 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3239 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3240 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3241 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3242 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3243 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3244 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3245
3246 For example:
3247
3248 @smallexample
3249 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3250 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3251 stop only if i==1
3252 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3253 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3254 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3255 @end smallexample
3256
3257 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3258 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3259 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3260 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3261 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3262 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3263 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3264 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3265 that belong to that breakpoint.
3266
3267 @cindex pending breakpoints
3268 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3269 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3270 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3271 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3272 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3273 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3274 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3275 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3276 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3277 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3278 is not yet resolved.
3279
3280 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3281 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3282 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3283 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3284 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3285 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3286
3287 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3288 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3289 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3290 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3291
3292 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3293 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3294 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3295
3296 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3297 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3298 address specification to an address:
3299
3300 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3301 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3302 @table @code
3303 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3304 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3305 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3306
3307 @item set breakpoint pending on
3308 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3309 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3310
3311 @item set breakpoint pending off
3312 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3313 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3314 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3315
3316 @item show breakpoint pending
3317 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3318 @end table
3319
3320 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3321 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3322 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3323
3324 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3325 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3326 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3327 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3328 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3329 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3330 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3331 breakpoints.
3332
3333 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3334
3335 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3336 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3337 @table @code
3338 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3339 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3340 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3341 breakpoint must be used.
3342
3343 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3344 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3345 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3346 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3347 @end table
3348
3349 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3350 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3351 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3352 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3353 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3354 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3355 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3356 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3357 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3358
3359 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3360 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3361 @table @code
3362 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3363 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3364 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3365 removed from the target when it stops.
3366
3367 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3368 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3369 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3370 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3371 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3372
3373 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3374 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3375 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3376 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3377 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3378 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3379 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3380 @end table
3381
3382 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3383 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3384 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3385 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3386 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3387 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3388 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3389 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3390
3391
3392 @node Set Watchpoints
3393 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3394
3395 @cindex setting watchpoints
3396 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3397 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3398 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3399 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3400 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3401
3402 @itemize @bullet
3403 @item
3404 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3405
3406 @item
3407 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3408 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3409 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3410
3411 @item
3412 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3413 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3414 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3415 @end itemize
3416
3417 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3418 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3419 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3420 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3421 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3422 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3423 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3424 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3425 the expression changes.
3426
3427 @cindex software watchpoints
3428 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3429 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3430 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3431 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3432 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3433 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3434 culprit.)
3435
3436 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3437 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3438 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3439
3440 @table @code
3441 @kindex watch
3442 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3443 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3444 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3445 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3446 to watch the value of a single variable:
3447
3448 @smallexample
3449 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3450 @end smallexample
3451
3452 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3453 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3454 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3455 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3456 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3457 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3458
3459 @kindex rwatch
3460 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3461 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3462 by the program.
3463
3464 @kindex awatch
3465 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3466 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3467 or written into by the program.
3468
3469 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3470 @item info watchpoints
3471 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3472 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3473 @end table
3474
3475 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3476 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3477 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3478 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3479 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3480 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3481
3482 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3483 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3484 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3485 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3486 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3487 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3488 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3489 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3490
3491 @table @code
3492 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3493 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3494 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3495
3496 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3497 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3498 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3499 @end table
3500
3501 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3502 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3503 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3504
3505 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3506
3507 @smallexample
3508 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3509 @end smallexample
3510
3511 @noindent
3512 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3513
3514 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3515 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3516 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3517 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3518 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3519 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3520 will print a message like this:
3521
3522 @smallexample
3523 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3524 @end smallexample
3525
3526 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3527 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3528 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3529 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3530 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3531 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3532 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3533 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3534
3535 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3536 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3537 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3538 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3539 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3540 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3541
3542 @smallexample
3543 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3544 @end smallexample
3545
3546 @noindent
3547 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3548
3549 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3550 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3551 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3552 expression with separately allocated resources.
3553
3554 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3555 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3556 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3557
3558 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3559 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3560 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3561 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3562 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3563 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3564 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3565 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3566 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3567
3568 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3569 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3570 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3571 watched expression from every thread.
3572
3573 @quotation
3574 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3575 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3576 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3577 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3578 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3579 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3580 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3581 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3582 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3583 @end quotation
3584
3585 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3586
3587 @node Set Catchpoints
3588 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3589 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3590 @cindex exception handlers
3591 @cindex event handling
3592
3593 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3594 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3595 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3596
3597 @table @code
3598 @kindex catch
3599 @item catch @var{event}
3600 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3601 @table @code
3602 @item throw
3603 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3604 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3605
3606 @item catch
3607 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3608
3609 @item exception
3610 @cindex Ada exception catching
3611 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3612 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3613 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3614 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3615 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3616
3617 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3618 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3619 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3620 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3621 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3622 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3623 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3624 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3625
3626 @item exception unhandled
3627 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3628
3629 @item assert
3630 A failed Ada assertion.
3631
3632 @item exec
3633 @cindex break on fork/exec
3634 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3635 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3636
3637 @item fork
3638 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3639 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3640
3641 @item vfork
3642 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3643 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3644
3645 @item load
3646 @itemx load @var{libname}
3647 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3648 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3649 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3650
3651 @item unload
3652 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3653 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3654 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3655 @end table
3656
3657 @item tcatch @var{event}
3658 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3659 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3660
3661 @end table
3662
3663 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3664
3665 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3666 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3667
3668 @itemize @bullet
3669 @item
3670 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3671 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3672 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3673 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3674 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3675 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3676 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3677 disabled within interactive calls.
3678
3679 @item
3680 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3681
3682 @item
3683 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3684 @end itemize
3685
3686 @cindex raise exceptions
3687 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3688 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3689 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3690 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3691 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3692 out where the exception was raised.
3693
3694 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3695 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3696 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3697 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3698
3699 @smallexample
3700 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3701 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3702 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3703 @end smallexample
3704
3705 @noindent
3706 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3707 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3708 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3709
3710 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3711 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3712 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3713 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3714 raised.
3715
3716
3717 @node Delete Breaks
3718 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3719
3720 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3721 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3722 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3723 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3724 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3725 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3726
3727 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3728 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3729 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3730 their breakpoint numbers.
3731
3732 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3733 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3734 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3735
3736 @table @code
3737 @kindex clear
3738 @item clear
3739 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3740 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3741 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3742 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3743
3744 @item clear @var{location}
3745 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3746 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3747 most useful ones are listed below:
3748
3749 @table @code
3750 @item clear @var{function}
3751 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3752 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3753
3754 @item clear @var{linenum}
3755 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3756 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3757 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3758 @end table
3759
3760 @cindex delete breakpoints
3761 @kindex delete
3762 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3763 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3764 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3765 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3766 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3767 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3768 @end table
3769
3770 @node Disabling
3771 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3772
3773 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3774 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3775 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3776 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3777 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3778
3779 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3780 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3781 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3782 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3783 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3784
3785 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3786 affects all of its locations.
3787
3788 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3789 states of enablement:
3790
3791 @itemize @bullet
3792 @item
3793 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3794 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3795 @item
3796 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3797 @item
3798 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3799 disabled.
3800 @item
3801 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3802 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3803 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3804 @end itemize
3805
3806 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3807 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3808
3809 @table @code
3810 @kindex disable
3811 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3812 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3813 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3814 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3815 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3816 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3817 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3818
3819 @kindex enable
3820 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3821 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3822 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3823
3824 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3825 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3826 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3827
3828 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3829 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3830 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3831 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3832 @end table
3833
3834 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3835 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3836 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3837 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3838 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3839 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3840 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3841 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3842 Stepping}.)
3843
3844 @node Conditions
3845 @subsection Break Conditions
3846 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3847 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3848
3849 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3850 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3851 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3852 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3853 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3854 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3855 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3856 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3857
3858 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3859 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3860 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3861 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3862 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3863
3864 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3865 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3866 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3867 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3868 one.
3869
3870 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3871 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3872 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3873 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3874 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3875 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3876 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3877 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3878 conditions for the
3879 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3880 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3881
3882 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3883 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3884 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3885 with the @code{condition} command.
3886
3887 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3888 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3889 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3890 catchpoint.
3891
3892 @table @code
3893 @kindex condition
3894 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3895 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3896 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3897 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3898 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3899 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3900 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3901 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3902 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3903 prints an error message:
3904
3905 @smallexample
3906 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3907 @end smallexample
3908
3909 @noindent
3910 @value{GDBN} does
3911 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3912 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3913 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3914
3915 @item condition @var{bnum}
3916 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3917 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3918 @end table
3919
3920 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3921 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3922 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3923 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3924 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3925 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3926 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3927 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3928 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3929 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3930 your program reaches it.
3931
3932 @table @code
3933 @kindex ignore
3934 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3935 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3936 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3937 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3938 takes no action.
3939
3940 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3941 a count of zero.
3942
3943 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3944 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3945 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3946 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3947
3948 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3949 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3950 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3951
3952 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3953 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3954 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3955 Variables}.
3956 @end table
3957
3958 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3959
3960
3961 @node Break Commands
3962 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3963
3964 @cindex breakpoint commands
3965 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3966 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3967 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3968 enable other breakpoints.
3969
3970 @table @code
3971 @kindex commands
3972 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3973 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3974 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3975 @itemx end
3976 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3977 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3978 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3979
3980 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3981 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3982
3983 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3984 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3985 recently encountered).
3986 @end table
3987
3988 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3989 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3990
3991 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3992 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3993 that resumes execution.
3994
3995 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3996 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3997 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3998 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3999 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4000
4001 @kindex silent
4002 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4003 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4004 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4005 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4006 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4007 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4008
4009 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4010 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4011 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4012
4013 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4014 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4015
4016 @smallexample
4017 break foo if x>0
4018 commands
4019 silent
4020 printf "x is %d\n",x
4021 cont
4022 end
4023 @end smallexample
4024
4025 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4026 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4027 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4028 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4029 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4030 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4031 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4032
4033 @smallexample
4034 break 403
4035 commands
4036 silent
4037 set x = y + 4
4038 cont
4039 end
4040 @end smallexample
4041
4042 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4043 @node Error in Breakpoints
4044 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4045 @c
4046 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
4047 @c
4048 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
4049 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
4050 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
4051 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
4052
4053 @smallexample
4054 Cannot insert breakpoints.
4055 The same program may be running in another process.
4056 @end smallexample
4057
4058 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
4059
4060 @enumerate
4061 @item
4062 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
4063
4064 @item
4065 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
4066 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
4067 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
4068 Then start your program again.
4069
4070 @item
4071 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
4072 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
4073 to nonsharable executables.
4074 @end enumerate
4075 @c @end ifclear
4076
4077 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
4078 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
4079
4080 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4081 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4082 @smallexample
4083 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4084 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4085 @end smallexample
4086
4087 @noindent
4088 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4089 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4090 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4091
4092 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4093 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4094
4095 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4096 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4097 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4098
4099 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4100 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4101 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4102 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4103
4104 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4105 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4106 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4107 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4108 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4109 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4110 first in the bundle.
4111
4112 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4113 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4114 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4115 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4116 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4117 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4118 is hit.
4119
4120 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4121 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4122
4123 @smallexample
4124 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4125 @end smallexample
4126
4127 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4128 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4129 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4130 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4131 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4132 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4133 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4134 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4135
4136 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4137 adjusted breakpoints:
4138
4139 @smallexample
4140 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4141 to 0x00010410.
4142 @end smallexample
4143
4144 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4145 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4146 frequently than expected.
4147
4148 @node Continuing and Stepping
4149 @section Continuing and Stepping
4150
4151 @cindex stepping
4152 @cindex continuing
4153 @cindex resuming execution
4154 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4155 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4156 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4157 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4158 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4159 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4160 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4161 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4162
4163 @table @code
4164 @kindex continue
4165 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4166 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4167 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4168 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4169 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4170 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4171 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4172 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4173 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4174 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4175
4176 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4177 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4178 @code{continue} is ignored.
4179
4180 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4181 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4182 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4183 @code{continue}.
4184 @end table
4185
4186 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4187 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4188 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4189 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4190
4191 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4192 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4193 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4194 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4195 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4196 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4197
4198 @table @code
4199 @kindex step
4200 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4201 @item step
4202 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4203 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4204 abbreviated @code{s}.
4205
4206 @quotation
4207 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4208 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4209 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4210 @c distinction here.
4211 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4212 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4213 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4214 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4215 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4216 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4217 below.
4218 @end quotation
4219
4220 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4221 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4222 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4223 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4224 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4225 called within the line.
4226
4227 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4228 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4229 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4230 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4231 was any debugging information about the routine.
4232
4233 @item step @var{count}
4234 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4235 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4236 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4237
4238 @kindex next
4239 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4240 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4241 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4242 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4243 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4244 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4245 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4246 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4247
4248 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4249
4250
4251 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4252 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4253 @c
4254 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4255 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4256 @c function are executed without stopping.
4257
4258 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4259 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4260 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4261
4262 @kindex set step-mode
4263 @item set step-mode
4264 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4265 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4266 @itemx set step-mode on
4267 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4268 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4269 information rather than stepping over it.
4270
4271 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4272 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4273 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4274
4275 @item set step-mode off
4276 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4277 debug information. This is the default.
4278
4279 @item show step-mode
4280 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4281 source line debug information.
4282
4283 @kindex finish
4284 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4285 @item finish
4286 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4287 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4288 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4289
4290 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4291 ,Returning from a Function}).
4292
4293 @kindex until
4294 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4295 @cindex run until specified location
4296 @item until
4297 @itemx u
4298 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4299 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4300 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4301 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4302 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4303 than the address of the jump.
4304
4305 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4306 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4307 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4308 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4309 through the next iteration.
4310
4311 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4312 stack frame.
4313
4314 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4315 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4316 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4317 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4318 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4319
4320 @smallexample
4321 (@value{GDBP}) f
4322 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4323 206 expand_input();
4324 (@value{GDBP}) until
4325 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4326 @end smallexample
4327
4328 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4329 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4330 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4331 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4332 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4333 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4334 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4335
4336 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4337 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4338 argument.
4339
4340 @item until @var{location}
4341 @itemx u @var{location}
4342 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4343 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4344 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4345 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4346 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4347 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4348 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4349 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4350 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4351 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4352 invocations have returned.
4353
4354 @smallexample
4355 94 int factorial (int value)
4356 95 @{
4357 96 if (value > 1) @{
4358 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4359 98 @}
4360 99 return (value);
4361 100 @}
4362 @end smallexample
4363
4364
4365 @kindex advance @var{location}
4366 @itemx advance @var{location}
4367 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4368 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4369 @ref{Specify Location}.
4370 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4371 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4372 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4373 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4374
4375
4376 @kindex stepi
4377 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4378 @item stepi
4379 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4380 @itemx si
4381 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4382
4383 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4384 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4385 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4386 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4387
4388 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4389
4390 @need 750
4391 @kindex nexti
4392 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4393 @item nexti
4394 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4395 @itemx ni
4396 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4397 proceed until the function returns.
4398
4399 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4400 @end table
4401
4402 @node Signals
4403 @section Signals
4404 @cindex signals
4405
4406 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4407 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4408 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4409 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4410 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4411 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4412 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4413 requested an alarm).
4414
4415 @cindex fatal signals
4416 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4417 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4418 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4419 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4420 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4421 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4422
4423 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4424 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4425 signal.
4426
4427 @cindex handling signals
4428 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4429 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4430 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4431 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4432 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4433
4434 @table @code
4435 @kindex info signals
4436 @kindex info handle
4437 @item info signals
4438 @itemx info handle
4439 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4440 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4441 the defined types of signals.
4442
4443 @item info signals @var{sig}
4444 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4445
4446 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4447
4448 @kindex handle
4449 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4450 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4451 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4452 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4453 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4454 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4455 say what change to make.
4456 @end table
4457
4458 @c @group
4459 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4460 Their full names are:
4461
4462 @table @code
4463 @item nostop
4464 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4465 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4466
4467 @item stop
4468 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4469 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4470
4471 @item print
4472 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4473
4474 @item noprint
4475 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4476 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4477
4478 @item pass
4479 @itemx noignore
4480 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4481 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4482 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4483
4484 @item nopass
4485 @itemx ignore
4486 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4487 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4488 @end table
4489 @c @end group
4490
4491 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4492 program until you
4493 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4494 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4495 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4496 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4497 program sees that signal when you continue.
4498
4499 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4500 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4501 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4502 erroneous signals.
4503
4504 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4505 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4506 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4507 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4508 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4509 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4510 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4511 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4512 Program a Signal}.
4513
4514 @node Thread Stops
4515 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4516
4517 @cindex stopped threads
4518 @cindex threads, stopped
4519
4520 @cindex continuing threads
4521 @cindex threads, continuing
4522
4523 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4524 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4525 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4526 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4527 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4528 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4529 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4530 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4531 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4532
4533 @menu
4534 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4535 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4536 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4537 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4538 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4539 @end menu
4540
4541 @node All-Stop Mode
4542 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4543
4544 @cindex all-stop mode
4545
4546 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4547 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4548 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4549 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4550 underfoot.
4551
4552 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4553 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4554 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4555
4556 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4557 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4558 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4559 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4560 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4561 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4562 stops.
4563
4564 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4565 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4566 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4567 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4568
4569 @cindex automatic thread selection
4570 @cindex switching threads automatically
4571 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4572 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4573 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4574 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4575 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4576 thread.
4577
4578 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4579 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4580
4581 @table @code
4582 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4583 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4584 @cindex lock scheduler
4585 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4586 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4587 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4588 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4589 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4590 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4591 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4592 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4593 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4594 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4595 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4596 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4597
4598 @item show scheduler-locking
4599 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4600 @end table
4601
4602 @node Non-Stop Mode
4603 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
4604
4605 @cindex non-stop mode
4606
4607 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4608 @c with more details.
4609
4610 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4611 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4612 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4613 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4614 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4615 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4616
4617 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4618 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4619 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4620 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4621 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4622 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4623 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4624 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4625 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4626 independently and simultaneously.
4627
4628 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4629 or attach to your program:
4630
4631 @smallexample
4632 # Enable the async interface.
4633 set target-async 1
4634
4635 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4636 set pagination off
4637
4638 # Finally, turn it on!
4639 set non-stop on
4640 @end smallexample
4641
4642 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4643
4644 @table @code
4645 @kindex set non-stop
4646 @item set non-stop on
4647 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4648 @item set non-stop off
4649 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4650 @kindex show non-stop
4651 @item show non-stop
4652 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4653 @end table
4654
4655 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4656 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4657 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4658 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4659 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4660 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4661 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4662 default.
4663
4664 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4665 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4666 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4667
4668 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4669 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4670 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4671 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4672 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4673
4674 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4675 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4676 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4677 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4678 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4679
4680 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4681
4682 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4683 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4684 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4685 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4686 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4687 previously current thread.
4688
4689 @node Background Execution
4690 @subsection Background Execution
4691
4692 @cindex foreground execution
4693 @cindex background execution
4694 @cindex asynchronous execution
4695 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4696
4697 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4698 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4699 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4700 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4701 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4702 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4703
4704 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4705 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4706 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4707 are:
4708
4709 @table @code
4710 @kindex run&
4711 @item run
4712 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4713
4714 @item attach
4715 @kindex attach&
4716 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4717
4718 @item step
4719 @kindex step&
4720 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4721
4722 @item stepi
4723 @kindex stepi&
4724 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4725
4726 @item next
4727 @kindex next&
4728 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4729
4730 @item continue
4731 @kindex continue&
4732 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4733
4734 @item finish
4735 @kindex finish&
4736 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4737
4738 @item until
4739 @kindex until&
4740 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4741
4742 @end table
4743
4744 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4745 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4746 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4747 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4748 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4749 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4750
4751 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4752 using the @code{interrupt} command.
4753
4754 @table @code
4755 @kindex interrupt
4756 @item interrupt
4757 @itemx interrupt -a
4758
4759 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4760 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4761 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4762 use @code{interrupt -a}.
4763 @end table
4764
4765 You may need to explicitly enable async mode before you can use background
4766 execution commands, with the @code{set target-async 1} command. If the
4767 target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error message
4768 if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4769
4770 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4771 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4772
4773 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4774 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4775 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4776
4777 @table @code
4778 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4779 @cindex thread breakpoints
4780 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4781 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4782 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4783 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4784 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4785 specify some source line.
4786
4787 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4788 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4789 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4790 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4791 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4792
4793 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4794 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4795 program.
4796
4797 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4798 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4799 breakpoint condition, like this:
4800
4801 @smallexample
4802 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4803 @end smallexample
4804
4805 @end table
4806
4807 @node Interrupted System Calls
4808 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
4809
4810 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4811 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4812 @cindex premature return from system calls
4813 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4814 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4815 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4816 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4817 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4818 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4819 stop execution.
4820
4821 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4822 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4823 style anyways.
4824
4825 For example, do not write code like this:
4826
4827 @smallexample
4828 sleep (10);
4829 @end smallexample
4830
4831 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4832 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4833
4834 Instead, write this:
4835
4836 @smallexample
4837 int unslept = 10;
4838 while (unslept > 0)
4839 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4840 @end smallexample
4841
4842 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4843 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4844 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4845 @value{GDBN}.
4846
4847 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4848 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4849 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4850 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4851
4852
4853
4854 @node Stack
4855 @chapter Examining the Stack
4856
4857 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4858 stopped and how it got there.
4859
4860 @cindex call stack
4861 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4862 is generated.
4863 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4864 the arguments of the call,
4865 and the local variables of the function being called.
4866 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4867 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4868 stack}.
4869
4870 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4871 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4872
4873 @cindex selected frame
4874 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4875 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4876 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4877 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4878 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4879 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4880
4881 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4882 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4883 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4884
4885 @menu
4886 * Frames:: Stack frames
4887 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4888 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4889 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4890
4891 @end menu
4892
4893 @node Frames
4894 @section Stack Frames
4895
4896 @cindex frame, definition
4897 @cindex stack frame
4898 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4899 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4900 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4901 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4902 which the function is executing.
4903
4904 @cindex initial frame
4905 @cindex outermost frame
4906 @cindex innermost frame
4907 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4908 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4909 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4910 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4911 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4912 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4913 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4914 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4915
4916 @cindex frame pointer
4917 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4918 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4919 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4920 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4921 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4922 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4923
4924 @cindex frame number
4925 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4926 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4927 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4928 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4929 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4930
4931 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4932 @c underflow problems.
4933 @cindex frameless execution
4934 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4935 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4936 @smallexample
4937 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4938 @end smallexample
4939 generates functions without a frame.)
4940 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4941 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4942 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4943 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4944 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4945 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4946 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4947
4948 @table @code
4949 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4950 @cindex current stack frame
4951 @item frame @var{args}
4952 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4953 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4954 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4955 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4956
4957 @kindex select-frame
4958 @cindex selecting frame silently
4959 @item select-frame
4960 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4961 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4962 @code{frame}.
4963 @end table
4964
4965 @node Backtrace
4966 @section Backtraces
4967
4968 @cindex traceback
4969 @cindex call stack traces
4970 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4971 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4972 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4973 stack.
4974
4975 @table @code
4976 @kindex backtrace
4977 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4978 @item backtrace
4979 @itemx bt
4980 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4981 frames in the stack.
4982
4983 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4984 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4985
4986 @item backtrace @var{n}
4987 @itemx bt @var{n}
4988 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4989
4990 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4991 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4992 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4993
4994 @item backtrace full
4995 @itemx bt full
4996 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4997 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4998 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4999 number of frames to print, as described above.
5000 @end table
5001
5002 @kindex where
5003 @kindex info stack
5004 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5005 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5006
5007 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5008 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5009 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5010 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5011 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5012 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5013 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5014 multi-threaded program.
5015
5016 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5017 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5018 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5019 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5020 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5021 line number.
5022
5023 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5024 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5025
5026 @smallexample
5027 @group
5028 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5029 at builtin.c:993
5030 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
5031 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5032 at macro.c:71
5033 (More stack frames follow...)
5034 @end group
5035 @end smallexample
5036
5037 @noindent
5038 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5039 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5040 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5041
5042 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5043 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5044 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5045 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5046 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5047 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5048 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5049 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5050 such a backtrace might look like:
5051
5052 @smallexample
5053 @group
5054 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5055 at builtin.c:993
5056 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5057 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5058 at macro.c:71
5059 (More stack frames follow...)
5060 @end group
5061 @end smallexample
5062
5063 @noindent
5064 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5065 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5066
5067 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5068 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5069 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5070
5071 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5072 @cindex program entry point
5073 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5074 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5075 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5076 @code{main}@footnote{
5077 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5078 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5079 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5080 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5081 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5082 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5083
5084 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5085 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5086
5087 @table @code
5088 @item set backtrace past-main
5089 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5090 @kindex set backtrace
5091 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5092
5093 @item set backtrace past-main off
5094 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5095 default.
5096
5097 @item show backtrace past-main
5098 @kindex show backtrace
5099 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5100
5101 @item set backtrace past-entry
5102 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5103 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5104 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5105 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5106
5107 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5108 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5109 application. This is the default.
5110
5111 @item show backtrace past-entry
5112 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5113
5114 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5115 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5116 @cindex backtrace limit
5117 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5118 unlimited.
5119
5120 @item show backtrace limit
5121 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5122 @end table
5123
5124 @node Selection
5125 @section Selecting a Frame
5126
5127 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5128 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5129 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5130 of the stack frame just selected.
5131
5132 @table @code
5133 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5134 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5135 @item frame @var{n}
5136 @itemx f @var{n}
5137 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5138 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5139 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5140 @code{main}.
5141
5142 @item frame @var{addr}
5143 @itemx f @var{addr}
5144 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5145 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5146 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5147 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5148 switches between them.
5149
5150 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5151 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5152
5153 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5154 pointer and a program counter.
5155
5156 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5157 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5158
5159 @kindex up
5160 @item up @var{n}
5161 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5162 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5163 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5164
5165 @kindex down
5166 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5167 @item down @var{n}
5168 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5169 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5170 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5171 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5172 @end table
5173
5174 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5175 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5176 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5177 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5178
5179 @need 1000
5180 For example:
5181
5182 @smallexample
5183 @group
5184 (@value{GDBP}) up
5185 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5186 at env.c:10
5187 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5188 @end group
5189 @end smallexample
5190
5191 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5192 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5193 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5194 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5195 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5196 for details.
5197
5198 @table @code
5199 @kindex down-silently
5200 @kindex up-silently
5201 @item up-silently @var{n}
5202 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5203 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5204 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5205 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5206 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5207 distracting.
5208 @end table
5209
5210 @node Frame Info
5211 @section Information About a Frame
5212
5213 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5214 stack frame.
5215
5216 @table @code
5217 @item frame
5218 @itemx f
5219 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5220 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5221 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5222 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5223 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5224
5225 @kindex info frame
5226 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5227 @item info frame
5228 @itemx info f
5229 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5230 including:
5231
5232 @itemize @bullet
5233 @item
5234 the address of the frame
5235 @item
5236 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5237 @item
5238 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5239 @item
5240 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5241 @item
5242 the address of the frame's arguments
5243 @item
5244 the address of the frame's local variables
5245 @item
5246 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5247 @item
5248 which registers were saved in the frame
5249 @end itemize
5250
5251 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5252 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5253 the usual conventions.
5254
5255 @item info frame @var{addr}
5256 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5257 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5258 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5259 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5260 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5261 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5262
5263 @kindex info args
5264 @item info args
5265 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5266
5267 @item info locals
5268 @kindex info locals
5269 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5270 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5271 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5272
5273 @kindex info catch
5274 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5275 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5276 @item info catch
5277 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5278 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5279 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5280 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5281 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5282
5283 @end table
5284
5285
5286 @node Source
5287 @chapter Examining Source Files
5288
5289 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5290 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5291 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5292 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5293 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5294 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5295 source files by explicit command.
5296
5297 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5298 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5299 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5300
5301 @menu
5302 * List:: Printing source lines
5303 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5304 * Edit:: Editing source files
5305 * Search:: Searching source files
5306 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5307 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5308 @end menu
5309
5310 @node List
5311 @section Printing Source Lines
5312
5313 @kindex list
5314 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5315 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5316 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5317 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5318 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5319
5320 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5321
5322 @table @code
5323 @item list @var{linenum}
5324 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5325 current source file.
5326
5327 @item list @var{function}
5328 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5329 @var{function}.
5330
5331 @item list
5332 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5333 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5334 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5335 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5336 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5337
5338 @item list -
5339 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5340 @end table
5341
5342 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5343 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5344 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5345
5346 @table @code
5347 @kindex set listsize
5348 @item set listsize @var{count}
5349 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5350 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5351
5352 @kindex show listsize
5353 @item show listsize
5354 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5355 @end table
5356
5357 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5358 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5359 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5360 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5361 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5362
5363 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5364 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5365 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5366 to specify some source line.
5367
5368 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5369
5370 @table @code
5371 @item list @var{linespec}
5372 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5373
5374 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5375 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5376 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5377 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5378 the same source file as the first linespec.
5379
5380 @item list ,@var{last}
5381 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5382
5383 @item list @var{first},
5384 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5385
5386 @item list +
5387 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5388
5389 @item list -
5390 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5391
5392 @item list
5393 As described in the preceding table.
5394 @end table
5395
5396 @node Specify Location
5397 @section Specifying a Location
5398 @cindex specifying location
5399 @cindex linespec
5400
5401 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5402 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5403 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5404 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5405
5406 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5407 @value{GDBN} understands:
5408
5409 @table @code
5410 @item @var{linenum}
5411 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5412
5413 @item -@var{offset}
5414 @itemx +@var{offset}
5415 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5416 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5417 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5418 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5419 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5420 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5421 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5422 linespec.
5423
5424 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5425 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5426
5427 @item @var{function}
5428 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5429 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5430
5431 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5432 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5433 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5434 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5435 functions in different source files.
5436
5437 @item *@var{address}
5438 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5439 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5440 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5441 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5442 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5443 source files.
5444
5445 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5446 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5447 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5448 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5449 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5450 of @var{address}:
5451
5452 @table @code
5453 @item @var{expression}
5454 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5455
5456 @item @var{funcaddr}
5457 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5458 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5459 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5460 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5461 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5462 (although the Pascal form also works).
5463
5464 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5465 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5466
5467 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5468 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5469 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5470 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5471 functions with identical names in different source files.
5472 @end table
5473
5474 @end table
5475
5476
5477 @node Edit
5478 @section Editing Source Files
5479 @cindex editing source files
5480
5481 @kindex edit
5482 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5483 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5484 The editing program of your choice
5485 is invoked with the current line set to
5486 the active line in the program.
5487 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5488 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5489
5490 @table @code
5491 @item edit @var{location}
5492 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5493 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5494 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5495 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5496 command most commonly used:
5497
5498 @table @code
5499 @item edit @var{number}
5500 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5501
5502 @item edit @var{function}
5503 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5504 @end table
5505
5506 @end table
5507
5508 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5509 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5510 @footnote{
5511 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5512 following command-line syntax:
5513 @smallexample
5514 ex +@var{number} file
5515 @end smallexample
5516 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5517 the file where to start editing.}.
5518 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5519 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5520 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5521 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5522 @smallexample
5523 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5524 export EDITOR
5525 gdb @dots{}
5526 @end smallexample
5527 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5528 @smallexample
5529 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5530 gdb @dots{}
5531 @end smallexample
5532
5533 @node Search
5534 @section Searching Source Files
5535 @cindex searching source files
5536
5537 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5538 regular expression.
5539
5540 @table @code
5541 @kindex search
5542 @kindex forward-search
5543 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5544 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5545 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5546 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5547 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5548 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5549 @code{fo}.
5550
5551 @kindex reverse-search
5552 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5553 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5554 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5555 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5556 this command as @code{rev}.
5557 @end table
5558
5559 @node Source Path
5560 @section Specifying Source Directories
5561
5562 @cindex source path
5563 @cindex directories for source files
5564 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5565 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5566 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5567 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5568 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5569 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5570 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5571
5572 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5573 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5574 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5575 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5576 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5577 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5578 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5579 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5580 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5581 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5582 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5583
5584 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5585 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5586 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5587 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5588 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5589 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5590
5591 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5592 source files.
5593
5594 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5595 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5596 each line is in the file.
5597
5598 @kindex directory
5599 @kindex dir
5600 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5601 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5602 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5603
5604 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5605 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5606
5607 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5608 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5609 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5610 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5611 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5612 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5613 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5614 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5615 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5616 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5617 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5618 name to look up the sources.
5619
5620 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5621 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5622 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5623 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5624 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5625 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5626 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5627 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5628
5629 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5630 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5631 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5632 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5633 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5634 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5635 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5636
5637 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5638 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5639 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5640 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5641 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5642 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5643 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5644 command.
5645
5646 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5647 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5648 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5649 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5650 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5651 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5652 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5653
5654 @table @code
5655 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5656 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5657 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5658 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5659 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5660 part of absolute file names) or
5661 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5662 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5663
5664 @kindex cdir
5665 @kindex cwd
5666 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5667 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5668 @cindex compilation directory
5669 @cindex current directory
5670 @cindex working directory
5671 @cindex directory, current
5672 @cindex directory, compilation
5673 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5674 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5675 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5676 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5677 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5678 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5679
5680 @item directory
5681 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5682
5683 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5684 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5685
5686 @item show directories
5687 @kindex show directories
5688 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5689
5690 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5691 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5692 @kindex set substitute-path
5693 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5694 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5695 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5696
5697 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5698 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5699
5700 @smallexample
5701 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5702 @end smallexample
5703
5704 @noindent
5705 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5706 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5707 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5708
5709 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5710 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5711 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5712 the substitution.
5713
5714 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5715
5716 @smallexample
5717 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5718 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5719 @end smallexample
5720
5721 @noindent
5722 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5723 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5724 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5725 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5726
5727
5728 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5729 @kindex unset substitute-path
5730 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5731 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5732 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5733
5734 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5735
5736 @item show substitute-path [path]
5737 @kindex show substitute-path
5738 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5739 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5740
5741 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5742 rules.
5743
5744 @end table
5745
5746 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5747 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5748 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5749
5750 @enumerate
5751 @item
5752 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5753
5754 @item
5755 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5756 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5757 directories in one command.
5758 @end enumerate
5759
5760 @node Machine Code
5761 @section Source and Machine Code
5762 @cindex source line and its code address
5763
5764 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5765 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5766 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5767 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5768 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5769 well as hex.
5770
5771 @table @code
5772 @kindex info line
5773 @item info line @var{linespec}
5774 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5775 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5776 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5777 @end table
5778
5779 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5780 the object code for the first line of function
5781 @code{m4_changequote}:
5782
5783 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5784 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5785 @smallexample
5786 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5787 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5788 @end smallexample
5789
5790 @noindent
5791 @cindex code address and its source line
5792 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5793 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5794 @smallexample
5795 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5796 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5797 @end smallexample
5798
5799 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5800 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5801 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5802 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5803 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5804 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5805 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5806 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5807 Variables}).
5808
5809 @table @code
5810 @kindex disassemble
5811 @cindex assembly instructions
5812 @cindex instructions, assembly
5813 @cindex machine instructions
5814 @cindex listing machine instructions
5815 @item disassemble
5816 @itemx disassemble /m
5817 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5818 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5819 the @code{/m} modifier.
5820 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5821 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5822 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5823 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5824 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5825 @end table
5826
5827 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5828 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5829
5830 @smallexample
5831 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5832 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5833 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5834 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5835 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5836 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5837 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5838 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5839 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5840 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5841 End of assembler dump.
5842 @end smallexample
5843
5844 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
5845
5846 @smallexample
5847 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
5848 Dump of assembler code for function main:
5849 5 @{
5850 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
5851 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
5852 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
5853 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
5854 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
5855
5856 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
5857 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
5858 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
5859
5860 7 return 0;
5861 8 @}
5862 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
5863 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
5864 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
5865
5866 End of assembler dump.
5867 @end smallexample
5868
5869 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5870 mnemonics or other syntax.
5871
5872 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5873 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5874 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5875 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5876 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5877
5878 @table @code
5879 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5880 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5881 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5882 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5883 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5884 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5885
5886 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5887 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5888 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5889 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5890
5891 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5892 @item show disassembly-flavor
5893 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5894 @end table
5895
5896
5897 @node Data
5898 @chapter Examining Data
5899
5900 @cindex printing data
5901 @cindex examining data
5902 @kindex print
5903 @kindex inspect
5904 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5905 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5906 @c different window or something like that.
5907 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5908 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5909 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5910 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5911 Different Languages}).
5912
5913 @table @code
5914 @item print @var{expr}
5915 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5916 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5917 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5918 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5919 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5920 Formats}.
5921
5922 @item print
5923 @itemx print /@var{f}
5924 @cindex reprint the last value
5925 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5926 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5927 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5928 @end table
5929
5930 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5931 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5932 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5933
5934 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5935 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5936 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5937 Table}.
5938
5939 @menu
5940 * Expressions:: Expressions
5941 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
5942 * Variables:: Program variables
5943 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5944 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5945 * Memory:: Examining memory
5946 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5947 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5948 * Value History:: Value history
5949 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5950 * Registers:: Registers
5951 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5952 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5953 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5954 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5955 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5956 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5957 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5958 character set than GDB does
5959 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5960 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
5961 @end menu
5962
5963 @node Expressions
5964 @section Expressions
5965
5966 @cindex expressions
5967 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5968 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5969 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5970 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5971 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5972 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5973 @ref{Compilation}.
5974
5975 @cindex arrays in expressions
5976 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5977 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5978 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
5979 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
5980 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
5981 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5982
5983 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5984 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5985 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5986 languages.
5987
5988 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5989 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5990
5991 @cindex casts, in expressions
5992 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5993 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5994 at that address in memory.
5995 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5996
5997 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5998 to programming languages:
5999
6000 @table @code
6001 @item @@
6002 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6003 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6004
6005 @item ::
6006 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6007 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6008
6009 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6010 @cindex type casting memory
6011 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6012 @cindex casts, to view memory
6013 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6014 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6015 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6016 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6017 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6018 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6019 @end table
6020
6021 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6022 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6023 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6024
6025 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6026 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6027 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6028 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6029 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6030 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6031 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6032
6033 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6034 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6035 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6036 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6037 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6038 as well.
6039
6040 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6041 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6042 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6043 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6044 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6045 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6046 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6047 choices.
6048
6049 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6050 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6051 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6052
6053 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6054 @smallexample
6055 @group
6056 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6057 [0] cancel
6058 [1] all
6059 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6060 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6061 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6062 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6063 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6064 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6065 > 2 4 6
6066 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6067 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6068 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6069 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6070 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6071 breakpoints.
6072 (@value{GDBP})
6073 @end group
6074 @end smallexample
6075
6076 @table @code
6077 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6078 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6079 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6080
6081 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6082 is ambiguous.
6083
6084 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6085 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6086 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6087 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6088 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6089 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6090 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6091 in the use of the menu.
6092
6093 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6094 when an ambiguity is detected.
6095
6096 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6097 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6098
6099 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6100 @item show multiple-symbols
6101 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6102 @end table
6103
6104 @node Variables
6105 @section Program Variables
6106
6107 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6108 in your program.
6109
6110 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6111 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6112
6113 @itemize @bullet
6114 @item
6115 global (or file-static)
6116 @end itemize
6117
6118 @noindent or
6119
6120 @itemize @bullet
6121 @item
6122 visible according to the scope rules of the
6123 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6124 @end itemize
6125
6126 @noindent This means that in the function
6127
6128 @smallexample
6129 foo (a)
6130 int a;
6131 @{
6132 bar (a);
6133 @{
6134 int b = test ();
6135 bar (b);
6136 @}
6137 @}
6138 @end smallexample
6139
6140 @noindent
6141 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6142 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6143 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6144 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6145
6146 @cindex variable name conflict
6147 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6148 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6149 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6150 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6151 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6152 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6153 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6154
6155 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6156 @ifnotinfo
6157 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6158 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6159 @end ifnotinfo
6160 @smallexample
6161 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6162 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 @noindent
6166 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6167 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6168 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6169 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6170
6171 @smallexample
6172 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6173 @end smallexample
6174
6175 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6176 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6177 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6178 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6179 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6180 @c conflict?? --mew
6181
6182 @cindex wrong values
6183 @cindex variable values, wrong
6184 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6185 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6186 @quotation
6187 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6188 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6189 scope, and just before exit.
6190 @end quotation
6191 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6192 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6193 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6194 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6195 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6196 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6197 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6198 variable definitions may be gone.
6199
6200 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6201 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6202 when compiling.
6203
6204 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6205 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6206 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6207 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6208 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6209 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6210 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6211
6212 @smallexample
6213 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6214 @end smallexample
6215
6216 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6217 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6218 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6219 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6220 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6221 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6222 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6223 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6224 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6225 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6226 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6227
6228 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6229 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6230 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6231 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6232
6233 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6234 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6235 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6236 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6237 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6238 For program code
6239
6240 @smallexample
6241 char var0[] = "A";
6242 signed char var1[] = "A";
6243 @end smallexample
6244
6245 You get during debugging
6246 @smallexample
6247 (gdb) print var0
6248 $1 = "A"
6249 (gdb) print var1
6250 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6251 @end smallexample
6252
6253 @node Arrays
6254 @section Artificial Arrays
6255
6256 @cindex artificial array
6257 @cindex arrays
6258 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6259 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6260 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6261 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6262 program.
6263
6264 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6265 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6266 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6267 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6268 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6269 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6270 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6271 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6272 example. If a program says
6273
6274 @smallexample
6275 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6276 @end smallexample
6277
6278 @noindent
6279 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6280
6281 @smallexample
6282 p *array@@len
6283 @end smallexample
6284
6285 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6286 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6287 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6288 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6289 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6290
6291 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6292 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6293 The value need not be in memory:
6294 @smallexample
6295 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6296 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6297 @end smallexample
6298
6299 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6300 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6301 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6302 @smallexample
6303 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6304 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6305 @end smallexample
6306
6307 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6308 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6309 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6310 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6311 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6312 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6313 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6314 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6315 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6316 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6317
6318 @smallexample
6319 set $i = 0
6320 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6321 @key{RET}
6322 @key{RET}
6323 @dots{}
6324 @end smallexample
6325
6326 @node Output Formats
6327 @section Output Formats
6328
6329 @cindex formatted output
6330 @cindex output formats
6331 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6332 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6333 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6334 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6335 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6336
6337 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6338 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6339 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6340 letters supported are:
6341
6342 @table @code
6343 @item x
6344 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6345 hexadecimal.
6346
6347 @item d
6348 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6349
6350 @item u
6351 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6352
6353 @item o
6354 Print as integer in octal.
6355
6356 @item t
6357 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6358 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6359 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6360 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6361
6362 @item a
6363 @cindex unknown address, locating
6364 @cindex locate address
6365 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6366 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6367 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6368
6369 @smallexample
6370 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6371 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6372 @end smallexample
6373
6374 @noindent
6375 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6376 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6377
6378 @item c
6379 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6380 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6381 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6382 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6383
6384 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6385 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6386 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6387 data.
6388
6389 @item f
6390 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6391 using typical floating point syntax.
6392
6393 @item s
6394 @cindex printing strings
6395 @cindex printing byte arrays
6396 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6397 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6398 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6399 natural types.
6400
6401 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6402 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6403 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6404 array.
6405 @end table
6406
6407 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6408
6409 @smallexample
6410 p/x $pc
6411 @end smallexample
6412
6413 @noindent
6414 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6415 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6416
6417 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6418 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6419 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6420
6421 @node Memory
6422 @section Examining Memory
6423
6424 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6425 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6426
6427 @cindex examining memory
6428 @table @code
6429 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6430 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6431 @itemx x @var{addr}
6432 @itemx x
6433 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6434 @end table
6435
6436 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6437 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6438 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6439 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6440 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6441
6442 @table @r
6443 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6444 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6445 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6446 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6447 @c 4.1.2.
6448
6449 @item @var{f}, the display format
6450 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6451 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6452 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6453 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6454 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6455
6456 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6457 The unit size is any of
6458
6459 @table @code
6460 @item b
6461 Bytes.
6462 @item h
6463 Halfwords (two bytes).
6464 @item w
6465 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6466 @item g
6467 Giant words (eight bytes).
6468 @end table
6469
6470 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6471 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6472 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6473
6474 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6475 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6476 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6477 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6478 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6479 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6480 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6481 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6482 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6483 a value from memory).
6484 @end table
6485
6486 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6487 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6488 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6489 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6490 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6491
6492 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6493 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6494 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6495 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6496 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6497
6498 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6499 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6500 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6501 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6502 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6503 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6504 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6505 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6506 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6507
6508 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6509 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6510 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6511 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6512 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6513 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6514 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6515
6516 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6517 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6518 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6519 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6520 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6521 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6522 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6523 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6524 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6525
6526 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6527 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6528 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6529
6530 @cindex remote memory comparison
6531 @cindex verify remote memory image
6532 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6533 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6534 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6535 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6536 situations.
6537
6538 @table @code
6539 @kindex compare-sections
6540 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6541 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6542 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6543 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6544 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6545 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6546 remote request.
6547 @end table
6548
6549 @node Auto Display
6550 @section Automatic Display
6551 @cindex automatic display
6552 @cindex display of expressions
6553
6554 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6555 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6556 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6557 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6558 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6559 The automatic display looks like this:
6560
6561 @smallexample
6562 2: foo = 38
6563 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6564 @end smallexample
6565
6566 @noindent
6567 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6568 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6569 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6570 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6571 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6572 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6573
6574 @table @code
6575 @kindex display
6576 @item display @var{expr}
6577 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6578 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6579
6580 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6581
6582 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6583 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6584 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6585 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6586 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6587
6588 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6589 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6590 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6591 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6592 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6593 @end table
6594
6595 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6596 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6597 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6598
6599 @table @code
6600 @kindex delete display
6601 @kindex undisplay
6602 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6603 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6604 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6605
6606 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6607 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6608
6609 @kindex disable display
6610 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6611 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6612 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6613 enabled again later.
6614
6615 @kindex enable display
6616 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6617 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6618 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6619
6620 @item display
6621 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6622 done when your program stops.
6623
6624 @kindex info display
6625 @item info display
6626 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6627 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6628 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6629 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6630 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6631 @end table
6632
6633 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6634 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6635 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6636 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6637 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6638 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6639 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6640 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6641 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6642 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6643 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6644
6645 @node Print Settings
6646 @section Print Settings
6647
6648 @cindex format options
6649 @cindex print settings
6650 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6651 and symbols are printed.
6652
6653 @noindent
6654 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6655
6656 @table @code
6657 @kindex set print
6658 @item set print address
6659 @itemx set print address on
6660 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6661 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6662 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6663 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6664 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6665 @code{set print address on}:
6666
6667 @smallexample
6668 @group
6669 (@value{GDBP}) f
6670 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6671 at input.c:530
6672 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6673 @end group
6674 @end smallexample
6675
6676 @item set print address off
6677 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6678 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6679
6680 @smallexample
6681 @group
6682 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6683 (@value{GDBP}) f
6684 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6685 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6686 @end group
6687 @end smallexample
6688
6689 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6690 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6691 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6692 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6693
6694 @kindex show print
6695 @item show print address
6696 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6697 @end table
6698
6699 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6700 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6701 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6702 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6703 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6704 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6705 it prints a symbolic address:
6706
6707 @table @code
6708 @item set print symbol-filename on
6709 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6710 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6711 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6712 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6713
6714 @item set print symbol-filename off
6715 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6716 default.
6717
6718 @item show print symbol-filename
6719 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6720 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6721 @end table
6722
6723 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6724 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6725 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6726
6727 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6728 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6729
6730 @table @code
6731 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6732 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6733 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6734 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6735 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6736 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6737
6738 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6739 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6740 symbolic address.
6741 @end table
6742
6743 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6744 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6745 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6746 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6747 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6748 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6749 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6750 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6751
6752 @smallexample
6753 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6754 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6755 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6756 @end smallexample
6757
6758 @quotation
6759 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6760 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6761 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6762 @end quotation
6763
6764 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6765
6766 @table @code
6767 @item set print array
6768 @itemx set print array on
6769 @cindex pretty print arrays
6770 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6771 but uses more space. The default is off.
6772
6773 @item set print array off
6774 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6775
6776 @item show print array
6777 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6778 arrays.
6779
6780 @cindex print array indexes
6781 @item set print array-indexes
6782 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6783 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6784 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6785 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6786
6787 @item set print array-indexes off
6788 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6789
6790 @item show print array-indexes
6791 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6792 arrays.
6793
6794 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6795 @cindex number of array elements to print
6796 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6797 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6798 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6799 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6800 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6801 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6802 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6803
6804 @item show print elements
6805 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6806 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6807
6808 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6809 @cindex printing frame argument values
6810 @cindex print all frame argument values
6811 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6812 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6813 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6814 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6815 values are:
6816
6817 @table @code
6818 @item all
6819 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6820
6821 @item scalars
6822 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6823 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6824 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6825
6826 @smallexample
6827 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6828 at frame-args.c:23
6829 @end smallexample
6830
6831 @item none
6832 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6833 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6834
6835 @smallexample
6836 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6837 at frame-args.c:23
6838 @end smallexample
6839 @end table
6840
6841 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6842 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6843 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6844 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6845 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6846 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6847 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6848 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6849
6850 @item show print frame-arguments
6851 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6852
6853 @item set print repeats
6854 @cindex repeated array elements
6855 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6856 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6857 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6858 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6859 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6860 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6861 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6862
6863 @item show print repeats
6864 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6865 elements.
6866
6867 @item set print null-stop
6868 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6869 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6870 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6871 contain only short strings.
6872 The default is off.
6873
6874 @item show print null-stop
6875 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6876 @sc{null} character.
6877
6878 @item set print pretty on
6879 @cindex print structures in indented form
6880 @cindex indentation in structure display
6881 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6882 per line, like this:
6883
6884 @smallexample
6885 @group
6886 $1 = @{
6887 next = 0x0,
6888 flags = @{
6889 sweet = 1,
6890 sour = 1
6891 @},
6892 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6893 @}
6894 @end group
6895 @end smallexample
6896
6897 @item set print pretty off
6898 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6899
6900 @smallexample
6901 @group
6902 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6903 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6904 @end group
6905 @end smallexample
6906
6907 @noindent
6908 This is the default format.
6909
6910 @item show print pretty
6911 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6912
6913 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6914 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6915 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6916 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6917 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6918 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6919 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6920 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6921
6922 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6923 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6924 international character sets, and is the default.
6925
6926 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6927 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6928
6929 @item set print union on
6930 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6931 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6932 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6933
6934 @item set print union off
6935 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6936 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6937 instead.
6938
6939 @item show print union
6940 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6941 structures and other unions.
6942
6943 For example, given the declarations
6944
6945 @smallexample
6946 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6947 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6948 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6949 Bug_forms;
6950
6951 struct thing @{
6952 Species it;
6953 union @{
6954 Tree_forms tree;
6955 Bug_forms bug;
6956 @} form;
6957 @};
6958
6959 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6960 @end smallexample
6961
6962 @noindent
6963 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6964
6965 @smallexample
6966 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6967 @end smallexample
6968
6969 @noindent
6970 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6971
6972 @smallexample
6973 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6974 @end smallexample
6975
6976 @noindent
6977 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6978 and in Pascal.
6979 @end table
6980
6981 @need 1000
6982 @noindent
6983 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6984
6985 @table @code
6986 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6987 @item set print demangle
6988 @itemx set print demangle on
6989 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6990 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6991 linkage. The default is on.
6992
6993 @item show print demangle
6994 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6995
6996 @item set print asm-demangle
6997 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6998 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6999 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7000 The default is off.
7001
7002 @item show print asm-demangle
7003 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7004 or demangled form.
7005
7006 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7007 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7008 @kindex set demangle-style
7009 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7010 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7011 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7012
7013 @table @code
7014 @item auto
7015 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7016
7017 @item gnu
7018 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7019 This is the default.
7020
7021 @item hp
7022 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7023
7024 @item lucid
7025 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7026
7027 @item arm
7028 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7029 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7030 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7031 require further enhancement to permit that.
7032
7033 @end table
7034 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7035
7036 @item show demangle-style
7037 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7038
7039 @item set print object
7040 @itemx set print object on
7041 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7042 @cindex display derived types
7043 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7044 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7045 the virtual function table.
7046
7047 @item set print object off
7048 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7049 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7050
7051 @item show print object
7052 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7053
7054 @item set print static-members
7055 @itemx set print static-members on
7056 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7057 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7058
7059 @item set print static-members off
7060 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7061
7062 @item show print static-members
7063 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7064
7065 @item set print pascal_static-members
7066 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7067 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7068 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7069 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7070
7071 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7072 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7073
7074 @item show print pascal_static-members
7075 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7076
7077 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7078 @item set print vtbl
7079 @itemx set print vtbl on
7080 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7081 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7082 @cindex VTBL display
7083 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7084 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7085 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7086
7087 @item set print vtbl off
7088 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7089
7090 @item show print vtbl
7091 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7092 @end table
7093
7094 @node Value History
7095 @section Value History
7096
7097 @cindex value history
7098 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7099 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7100 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7101 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7102 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7103 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7104 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7105 symbol table.
7106
7107 @cindex @code{$}
7108 @cindex @code{$$}
7109 @cindex history number
7110 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7111 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7112 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7113 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7114 history number.
7115
7116 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7117 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7118 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7119 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7120 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7121 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7122 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7123
7124 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7125 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7126
7127 @smallexample
7128 p *$
7129 @end smallexample
7130
7131 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7132 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7133
7134 @smallexample
7135 p *$.next
7136 @end smallexample
7137
7138 @noindent
7139 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7140 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7141
7142 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7143 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7144
7145 @smallexample
7146 print x
7147 set x=5
7148 @end smallexample
7149
7150 @noindent
7151 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7152 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7153
7154 @table @code
7155 @kindex show values
7156 @item show values
7157 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7158 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7159 values} does not change the history.
7160
7161 @item show values @var{n}
7162 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7163
7164 @item show values +
7165 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7166 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7167 @end table
7168
7169 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7170 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7171
7172 @node Convenience Vars
7173 @section Convenience Variables
7174
7175 @cindex convenience variables
7176 @cindex user-defined variables
7177 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7178 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7179 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7180 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7181 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7182
7183 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7184 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7185 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7186 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7187 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7188
7189 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7190 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7191 For example:
7192
7193 @smallexample
7194 set $foo = *object_ptr
7195 @end smallexample
7196
7197 @noindent
7198 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7199 @code{object_ptr}.
7200
7201 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7202 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7203 value with another assignment at any time.
7204
7205 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7206 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7207 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7208 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7209
7210 @table @code
7211 @kindex show convenience
7212 @cindex show all user variables
7213 @item show convenience
7214 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7215 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7216
7217 @kindex init-if-undefined
7218 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7219 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7220 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7221 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7222 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7223 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7224 override default values used in a command script.
7225
7226 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7227 any side-effects do not occur.
7228 @end table
7229
7230 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7231 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7232 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7233
7234 @smallexample
7235 set $i = 0
7236 print bar[$i++]->contents
7237 @end smallexample
7238
7239 @noindent
7240 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7241
7242 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7243 values likely to be useful.
7244
7245 @table @code
7246 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7247 @item $_
7248 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7249 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7250 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7251 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7252 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7253 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7254 to the type of @code{$__}.
7255
7256 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7257 @item $__
7258 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7259 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7260 to match the format in which the data was printed.
7261
7262 @item $_exitcode
7263 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7264 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7265 the program being debugged terminates.
7266 @end table
7267
7268 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7269 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7270 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7271
7272 @node Registers
7273 @section Registers
7274
7275 @cindex registers
7276 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7277 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7278 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7279 your machine.
7280
7281 @table @code
7282 @kindex info registers
7283 @item info registers
7284 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7285 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7286
7287 @kindex info all-registers
7288 @cindex floating point registers
7289 @item info all-registers
7290 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7291 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7292
7293 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7294 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7295 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7296 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7297 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7298 @end table
7299
7300 @cindex stack pointer register
7301 @cindex program counter register
7302 @cindex process status register
7303 @cindex frame pointer register
7304 @cindex standard registers
7305 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7306 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7307 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7308 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7309 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7310 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7311 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7312 you could print the program counter in hex with
7313
7314 @smallexample
7315 p/x $pc
7316 @end smallexample
7317
7318 @noindent
7319 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7320
7321 @smallexample
7322 x/i $pc
7323 @end smallexample
7324
7325 @noindent
7326 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7327 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7328 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7329 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7330 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7331 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7332 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7333
7334 @smallexample
7335 set $sp += 4
7336 @end smallexample
7337
7338 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7339 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7340 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7341 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7342 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7343 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7344 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7345
7346 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7347 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7348 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7349 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7350 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7351 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7352 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7353
7354 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7355 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7356 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7357 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7358 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7359 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7360 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7361 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7362 prints the data in both formats.
7363
7364 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7365 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7366 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7367 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7368 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7369 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7370 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7371
7372 @smallexample
7373 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7374 $1 = @{
7375 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7376 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7377 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7378 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7379 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7380 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7381 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7382 @}
7383 @end smallexample
7384
7385 @noindent
7386 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7387 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7388 value to a @code{struct} member:
7389
7390 @smallexample
7391 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7392 @end smallexample
7393
7394 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7395 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7396 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7397 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7398 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7399 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7400
7401 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7402 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7403 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7404 frame makes no difference.
7405
7406 @node Floating Point Hardware
7407 @section Floating Point Hardware
7408 @cindex floating point
7409
7410 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7411 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7412
7413 @table @code
7414 @kindex info float
7415 @item info float
7416 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7417 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7418 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7419 the ARM and x86 machines.
7420 @end table
7421
7422 @node Vector Unit
7423 @section Vector Unit
7424 @cindex vector unit
7425
7426 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7427 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7428
7429 @table @code
7430 @kindex info vector
7431 @item info vector
7432 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7433 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7434 @end table
7435
7436 @node OS Information
7437 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7438 @cindex OS information
7439
7440 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7441 you debug your program.
7442
7443 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7444 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7445 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7446 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7447 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7448 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7449 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7450 structure.
7451
7452 @table @code
7453 @item info udot
7454 @kindex info udot
7455 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7456 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7457 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7458 the @code{examine} command.
7459 @end table
7460
7461 @cindex auxiliary vector
7462 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7463 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7464 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7465 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7466 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7467 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7468 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7469 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7470 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7471 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7472 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7473 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7474
7475 @table @code
7476 @kindex info auxv
7477 @item info auxv
7478 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7479 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7480 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7481 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7482 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7483 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7484 an unrecognized tag.
7485 @end table
7486
7487
7488 @node Memory Region Attributes
7489 @section Memory Region Attributes
7490 @cindex memory region attributes
7491
7492 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7493 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7494 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7495 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7496 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7497 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7498 user can override the fetched regions.
7499
7500 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7501 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7502 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7503 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7504 all memory.
7505
7506 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7507 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7508
7509 @table @code
7510 @kindex mem
7511 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7512 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7513 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7514 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7515 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7516 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7517
7518 @item mem auto
7519 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7520 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7521
7522 @kindex delete mem
7523 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7524 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7525 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7526
7527 @kindex disable mem
7528 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7529 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7530 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7531 It may be enabled again later.
7532
7533 @kindex enable mem
7534 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7535 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7536
7537 @kindex info mem
7538 @item info mem
7539 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7540 for each region:
7541
7542 @table @emph
7543 @item Memory Region Number
7544 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7545 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7546 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7547
7548 @item Lo Address
7549 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7550
7551 @item Hi Address
7552 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7553
7554 @item Attributes
7555 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7556 @end table
7557 @end table
7558
7559
7560 @subsection Attributes
7561
7562 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7563 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7564 write accesses to a memory region.
7565
7566 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7567 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7568 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7569
7570 @table @code
7571 @item ro
7572 Memory is read only.
7573 @item wo
7574 Memory is write only.
7575 @item rw
7576 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7577 @end table
7578
7579 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7580 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7581 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7582 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7583 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7584
7585 @table @code
7586 @item 8
7587 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7588 @item 16
7589 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7590 @item 32
7591 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7592 @item 64
7593 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7594 @end table
7595
7596 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7597 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7598 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7599 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7600 @c
7601 @c @table @code
7602 @c @item hwbreak
7603 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7604 @c @item swbreak (default)
7605 @c @end table
7606
7607 @subsubsection Data Cache
7608 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7609 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7610 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7611 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7612 registers.
7613
7614 @table @code
7615 @item cache
7616 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7617 @item nocache
7618 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7619 @end table
7620
7621 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7622 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7623 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7624 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7625 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7626
7627 @table @code
7628 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7629 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7630 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7631 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7632 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7633 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7634 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7635 The default value is @code{on}.
7636 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7637 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7638 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7639 @end table
7640
7641
7642 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7643 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7644 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7645 @c
7646 @c @table @code
7647 @c @item verify
7648 @c @item noverify (default)
7649 @c @end table
7650
7651 @node Dump/Restore Files
7652 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7653 @cindex dump/restore files
7654 @cindex append data to a file
7655 @cindex dump data to a file
7656 @cindex restore data from a file
7657
7658 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7659 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7660 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7661 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7662 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7663 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7664 files.
7665
7666 @table @code
7667
7668 @kindex dump
7669 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7670 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7671 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7672 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7673
7674 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7675 @table @code
7676 @item binary
7677 Raw binary form.
7678 @item ihex
7679 Intel hex format.
7680 @item srec
7681 Motorola S-record format.
7682 @item tekhex
7683 Tektronix Hex format.
7684 @end table
7685
7686 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7687 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7688 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7689 form.
7690
7691 @kindex append
7692 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7693 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7694 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7695 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7696 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7697
7698 @kindex restore
7699 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7700 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7701 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7702 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7703 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7704
7705 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7706 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7707 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7708 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7709 from that location.
7710
7711 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7712 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7713 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7714 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7715
7716 @end table
7717
7718 @node Core File Generation
7719 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7720 @cindex dump core from inferior
7721
7722 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7723 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7724 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7725 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7726 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7727 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7728 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7729
7730 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7731 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7732 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7733
7734 @table @code
7735 @kindex gcore
7736 @kindex generate-core-file
7737 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7738 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7739 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7740 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7741 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7742 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7743
7744 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7745 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7746 @end table
7747
7748 @node Character Sets
7749 @section Character Sets
7750 @cindex character sets
7751 @cindex charset
7752 @cindex translating between character sets
7753 @cindex host character set
7754 @cindex target character set
7755
7756 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7757 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7758 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7759 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7760 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7761 @dfn{target character set}.
7762
7763 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7764 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7765 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7766 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7767 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7768 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7769 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7770 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7771 character and string literals in expressions.
7772
7773 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7774 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7775 target-charset} command, described below.
7776
7777 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7778 support:
7779
7780 @table @code
7781 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7782 @kindex set target-charset
7783 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7784 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7785 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7786 list the target character sets it supports.
7787 @end table
7788
7789 @table @code
7790 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7791 @kindex set host-charset
7792 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7793
7794 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7795 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7796 @code{set host-charset} command.
7797
7798 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7799 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7800 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7801 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7802 list the host character sets it supports.
7803
7804 @item set charset @var{charset}
7805 @kindex set charset
7806 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7807 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7808 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7809 for both host and target.
7810
7811
7812 @item show charset
7813 @kindex show charset
7814 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7815
7816 @itemx show host-charset
7817 @kindex show host-charset
7818 Show the name of the current host charset.
7819
7820 @itemx show target-charset
7821 @kindex show target-charset
7822 Show the name of the current target charset.
7823
7824 @end table
7825
7826 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7827 sets:
7828
7829 @table @code
7830
7831 @item ASCII
7832 @cindex ASCII character set
7833 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7834 character set.
7835
7836 @item ISO-8859-1
7837 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7838 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7839 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7840 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7841 this as its host character set.
7842
7843 @item EBCDIC-US
7844 @itemx IBM1047
7845 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7846 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7847 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7848 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7849 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7850
7851 @end table
7852
7853 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7854 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7855 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7856
7857 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7858 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7859 @file{charset-test.c}:
7860
7861 @smallexample
7862 #include <stdio.h>
7863
7864 char ascii_hello[]
7865 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7866 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7867 char ibm1047_hello[]
7868 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7869 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7870
7871 main ()
7872 @{
7873 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7874 @}
7875 @end smallexample
7876
7877 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7878 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7879 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7880
7881 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7882
7883 @smallexample
7884 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7885 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7886 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7887 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7888 @dots{}
7889 (@value{GDBP})
7890 @end smallexample
7891
7892 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7893 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7894 strings:
7895
7896 @smallexample
7897 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7898 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7899 (@value{GDBP})
7900 @end smallexample
7901
7902 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7903 initial character set:
7904 @smallexample
7905 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7906 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7907 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7908 (@value{GDBP})
7909 @end smallexample
7910
7911 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7912 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7913 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7914 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7915 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7916
7917 @smallexample
7918 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7919 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7920 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7921 $2 = 72 'H'
7922 (@value{GDBP})
7923 @end smallexample
7924
7925 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7926 literals you use in expressions:
7927
7928 @smallexample
7929 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7930 $3 = 43 '+'
7931 (@value{GDBP})
7932 @end smallexample
7933
7934 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7935 character.
7936
7937 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7938 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7939 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7940
7941 @smallexample
7942 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7943 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7944 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7945 $5 = 200 '\310'
7946 (@value{GDBP})
7947 @end smallexample
7948
7949 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7950 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7951
7952 @smallexample
7953 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7954 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7955 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7956 @end smallexample
7957
7958 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7959 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7960 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7961 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7962 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7963
7964 @smallexample
7965 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7966 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7967 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7968 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7969 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7970 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7971 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7972 $7 = 72 '\110'
7973 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7974 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7975 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7976 $9 = 200 'H'
7977 (@value{GDBP})
7978 @end smallexample
7979
7980 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7981 string literals you use in expressions:
7982
7983 @smallexample
7984 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7985 $10 = 78 '+'
7986 (@value{GDBP})
7987 @end smallexample
7988
7989 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7990 character.
7991
7992 @node Caching Remote Data
7993 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7994 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7995
7996 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7997 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7998 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7999 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
8000 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
8001 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
8002 volatile registers are in use.
8003
8004 @table @code
8005 @kindex set remotecache
8006 @item set remotecache on
8007 @itemx set remotecache off
8008 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
8009 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
8010
8011 @kindex show remotecache
8012 @item show remotecache
8013 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
8014
8015 @kindex info dcache
8016 @item info dcache
8017 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8018 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
8019 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
8020 state (invalid, dirty, valid). This command is useful for debugging
8021 the data cache operation.
8022 @end table
8023
8024 @node Searching Memory
8025 @section Search Memory
8026 @cindex searching memory
8027
8028 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8029 @code{find} command.
8030
8031 @table @code
8032 @kindex find
8033 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8034 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8035 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8036 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8037 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8038 @end table
8039
8040 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8041 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8042
8043 @table @r
8044 @item @var{s}, search query size
8045 The size of each search query value.
8046
8047 @table @code
8048 @item b
8049 bytes
8050 @item h
8051 halfwords (two bytes)
8052 @item w
8053 words (four bytes)
8054 @item g
8055 giant words (eight bytes)
8056 @end table
8057
8058 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8059 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8060 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8061
8062 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8063 value's type in the current language.
8064 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8065 pattern as a mixture of types.
8066 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8067 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8068 which is typically four bytes.
8069
8070 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8071 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8072 @end table
8073
8074 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8075 (@code{"}).
8076 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8077 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8078
8079 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8080 number of matches found.
8081
8082 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8083 @samp{$_}.
8084 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8085
8086 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8087
8088 @smallexample
8089 void
8090 hello ()
8091 @{
8092 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8093 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8094 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8095 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8096 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8097 @}
8098 @end smallexample
8099
8100 @noindent
8101 you get during debugging:
8102
8103 @smallexample
8104 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8105 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8106 1 pattern found
8107 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8108 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8109 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8110 2 patterns found
8111 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8112 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8113 1 pattern found
8114 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8115 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8116 1 pattern found
8117 (gdb) print $numfound
8118 $1 = 1
8119 (gdb) print $_
8120 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8121 @end smallexample
8122
8123 @node Macros
8124 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8125
8126 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8127 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8128 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8129 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8130 where it was defined.
8131
8132 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8133 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8134 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8135 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8136
8137 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8138 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8139 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8140 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8141 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8142 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8143 see @ref{List}.
8144
8145 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8146 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8147 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8148
8149 @table @code
8150
8151 @kindex macro expand
8152 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8153 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8154 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8155 @item macro expand @var{expression}
8156 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8157 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8158 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8159 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8160 it can be any string of tokens.
8161
8162 @kindex macro exp1
8163 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8164 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8165 @cindex expand macro once
8166 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8167 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8168 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8169 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8170 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8171 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8172 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8173 can be any string of tokens.
8174
8175 @kindex info macro
8176 @cindex macro definition, showing
8177 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
8178 @item info macro @var{macro}
8179 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8180 source location where that definition was established.
8181
8182 @kindex macro define
8183 @cindex user-defined macros
8184 @cindex defining macros interactively
8185 @cindex macros, user-defined
8186 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8187 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8188 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8189 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8190 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8191 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8192 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8193 @var{arglist}.
8194
8195 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8196 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8197 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8198 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8199 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8200
8201 @kindex macro undef
8202 @item macro undef @var{macro}
8203 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8204 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8205 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8206 in the program being debugged.
8207
8208 @kindex macro list
8209 @item macro list
8210 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8211 @end table
8212
8213 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
8214 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8215 show our source files:
8216
8217 @smallexample
8218 $ cat sample.c
8219 #include <stdio.h>
8220 #include "sample.h"
8221
8222 #define M 42
8223 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8224
8225 main ()
8226 @{
8227 #define N 28
8228 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8229 #undef N
8230 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8231 #define N 1729
8232 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8233 @}
8234 $ cat sample.h
8235 #define Q <
8236 $
8237 @end smallexample
8238
8239 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8240 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8241 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8242 information.
8243
8244 @smallexample
8245 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8246 $
8247 @end smallexample
8248
8249 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8250
8251 @smallexample
8252 $ gdb -nw sample
8253 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8254 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8255 GDB is free software, @dots{}
8256 (@value{GDBP})
8257 @end smallexample
8258
8259 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8260 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8261 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8262
8263 @smallexample
8264 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8265 3
8266 4 #define M 42
8267 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8268 6
8269 7 main ()
8270 8 @{
8271 9 #define N 28
8272 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8273 11 #undef N
8274 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8275 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8276 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8277 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8278 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8279 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8280 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8281 #define Q <
8282 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8283 expands to: (42 + 1)
8284 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8285 expands to: once (M + 1)
8286 (@value{GDBP})
8287 @end smallexample
8288
8289 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8290 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8291 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8292 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8293
8294 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8295 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8296
8297 @smallexample
8298 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8299 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8300 (@value{GDBP}) run
8301 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8302
8303 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8304 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8305 (@value{GDBP})
8306 @end smallexample
8307
8308 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8309
8310 @smallexample
8311 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8312 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8313 #define N 28
8314 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8315 expands to: 28 < 42
8316 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8317 $1 = 1
8318 (@value{GDBP})
8319 @end smallexample
8320
8321 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8322 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8323 thereof) in force at each point:
8324
8325 @smallexample
8326 (@value{GDBP}) next
8327 Hello, world!
8328 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8329 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8330 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8331 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8332 (@value{GDBP}) next
8333 We're so creative.
8334 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8335 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8336 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8337 #define N 1729
8338 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8339 expands to: 1729 < 42
8340 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8341 $2 = 0
8342 (@value{GDBP})
8343 @end smallexample
8344
8345
8346 @node Tracepoints
8347 @chapter Tracepoints
8348 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8349 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8350
8351 @cindex tracepoints
8352 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8353 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8354 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8355 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8356 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8357 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8358 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8359
8360 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8361 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8362 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8363 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8364 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8365 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8366 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8367 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8368 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8369 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8370 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8371
8372 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8373 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8374 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8375 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8376 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8377 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8378 Packets}.
8379
8380 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8381
8382 @menu
8383 * Set Tracepoints::
8384 * Analyze Collected Data::
8385 * Tracepoint Variables::
8386 @end menu
8387
8388 @node Set Tracepoints
8389 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8390
8391 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8392 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
8393 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
8394 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
8395 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
8396 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
8397 work on.
8398
8399 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8400 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8401 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8402 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8403 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8404 tracepoint was hit.
8405
8406 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8407 conditions and actions.
8408
8409 @menu
8410 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8411 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8412 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8413 * Tracepoint Actions::
8414 * Listing Tracepoints::
8415 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8416 @end menu
8417
8418 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8419 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8420
8421 @table @code
8422 @cindex set tracepoint
8423 @kindex trace
8424 @item trace
8425 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8426 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
8427 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
8428 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
8429 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
8430 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
8431 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
8432 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
8433 running.
8434
8435 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8436
8437 @smallexample
8438 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8439
8440 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8441
8442 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8443
8444 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8445
8446 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8447 @end smallexample
8448
8449 @noindent
8450 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8451
8452 @vindex $tpnum
8453 @cindex last tracepoint number
8454 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8455 @cindex tracepoint number
8456 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8457 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8458
8459 @kindex delete tracepoint
8460 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8461 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8462 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8463 default is to delete all tracepoints.
8464
8465 Examples:
8466
8467 @smallexample
8468 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8469
8470 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8471 @end smallexample
8472
8473 @noindent
8474 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8475 @end table
8476
8477 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8478 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8479
8480 @table @code
8481 @kindex disable tracepoint
8482 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8483 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8484 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8485 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8486 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8487
8488 @kindex enable tracepoint
8489 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8490 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8491 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8492 run.
8493 @end table
8494
8495 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8496 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8497
8498 @table @code
8499 @kindex passcount
8500 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8501 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8502 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8503 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8504 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8505 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8506 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8507 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8508 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8509 user.
8510
8511 Examples:
8512
8513 @smallexample
8514 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8515 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8516
8517 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8518 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8519 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8520 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8521 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8522 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8523 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8524 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8525 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8526 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8527 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8528 @end smallexample
8529 @end table
8530
8531 @node Tracepoint Actions
8532 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8533
8534 @table @code
8535 @kindex actions
8536 @cindex tracepoint actions
8537 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8538 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8539 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8540 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8541 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8542 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8543 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8544 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8545 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8546 @code{while-stepping}.
8547
8548 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8549 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8550 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8551
8552 @smallexample
8553 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8554
8555 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8556
8557 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8558 @end smallexample
8559
8560 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8561 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8562 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8563 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8564 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8565 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8566 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8567 @code{end} command.
8568
8569 @smallexample
8570 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8571 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8572 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8573 > collect bar,baz
8574 > collect $regs
8575 > while-stepping 12
8576 > collect $fp, $sp
8577 > end
8578 end
8579 @end smallexample
8580
8581 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8582 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8583 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8584 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8585 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8586 special arguments are supported:
8587
8588 @table @code
8589 @item $regs
8590 collect all registers
8591
8592 @item $args
8593 collect all function arguments
8594
8595 @item $locals
8596 collect all local variables.
8597 @end table
8598
8599 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8600 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8601 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8602
8603 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8604 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8605
8606 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8607 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8608 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8609 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8610 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8611 its own @code{end} command):
8612
8613 @smallexample
8614 > while-stepping 12
8615 > collect $regs, myglobal
8616 > end
8617 >
8618 @end smallexample
8619
8620 @noindent
8621 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8622 @code{stepping}.
8623 @end table
8624
8625 @node Listing Tracepoints
8626 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8627
8628 @table @code
8629 @kindex info tracepoints
8630 @kindex info tp
8631 @cindex information about tracepoints
8632 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8633 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8634 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8635 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8636 shown:
8637
8638 @itemize @bullet
8639 @item
8640 its number
8641 @item
8642 whether it is enabled or disabled
8643 @item
8644 its address
8645 @item
8646 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8647 @item
8648 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8649 @item
8650 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8651 @item
8652 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8653 @end itemize
8654
8655 @smallexample
8656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8657 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8658 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8659 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8660 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8661 (@value{GDBP})
8662 @end smallexample
8663
8664 @noindent
8665 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8666 @end table
8667
8668 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8669 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8670
8671 @table @code
8672 @kindex tstart
8673 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8674 @cindex collected data discarded
8675 @item tstart
8676 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8677 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8678 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8679 experiment.
8680
8681 @kindex tstop
8682 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8683 @item tstop
8684 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8685 stops collecting data.
8686
8687 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8688 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8689 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8690
8691 @kindex tstatus
8692 @cindex status of trace data collection
8693 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8694 @item tstatus
8695 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8696 collection.
8697 @end table
8698
8699 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8700
8701 @smallexample
8702 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8704 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8705 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8706 > while-stepping 11
8707 > collect $regs
8708 > end
8709 > end
8710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8711 [time passes @dots{}]
8712 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8713 @end smallexample
8714
8715
8716 @node Analyze Collected Data
8717 @section Using the Collected Data
8718
8719 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8720 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8721 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8722 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8723 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8724 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8725 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8726 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8727 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8728 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8729 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8730 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8731 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8732 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8733 the buffer will fail.
8734
8735 @menu
8736 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8737 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8738 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8739 @end menu
8740
8741 @node tfind
8742 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8743
8744 @kindex tfind
8745 @cindex select trace snapshot
8746 @cindex find trace snapshot
8747 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8748 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8749 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8750 snapshot is selected.
8751
8752 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8753
8754 @table @code
8755 @item tfind start
8756 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8757 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8758
8759 @item tfind none
8760 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8761
8762 @item tfind end
8763 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8764
8765 @item tfind
8766 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8767
8768 @item tfind -
8769 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8770 retracing earlier steps.
8771
8772 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8773 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8774 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8775 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8776 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8777
8778 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8779 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8780 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8781 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8782 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8783
8784 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8785 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8786 addresses.
8787
8788 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8789 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8790 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8791
8792 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8793 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8794 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8795 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8796 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8797 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8798 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8799 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8800 @end table
8801
8802 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8803 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8804 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8805 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8806 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8807 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8808 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8809 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8810 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8811 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8812 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8813 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8814 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8815 tracepoint as the current one.
8816
8817 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8818 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8819 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8820 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8821 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8822
8823 @smallexample
8824 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8825 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8826 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8827 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8828 > tfind
8829 > end
8830
8831 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8832 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8833 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8834 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8835 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8836 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8837 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8838 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8839 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8840 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8841 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8842 @end smallexample
8843
8844 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8845 the buffer:
8846
8847 @smallexample
8848 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8849 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8850 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8851 > tfind line
8852 > end
8853
8854 Frame 0, X = 1
8855 Frame 7, X = 2
8856 Frame 13, X = 255
8857 @end smallexample
8858
8859 @node tdump
8860 @subsection @code{tdump}
8861 @kindex tdump
8862 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8863 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8864
8865 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8866 the current trace snapshot.
8867
8868 @smallexample
8869 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8870 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8871 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8872 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8873 > end
8874
8875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8876
8877 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8878 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8879 at gdb_test.c:444
8880 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8881
8882 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8883 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8884 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8885 d1 0x18 24
8886 d2 0x80 128
8887 d3 0x33 51
8888 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8889 d5 0x22 34
8890 d6 0xe0 224
8891 d7 0x380035 3670069
8892 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8893 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8894 a2 0x100 256
8895 a3 0x322000 3284992
8896 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8897 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8898 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8899 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8900 ps 0x0 0
8901 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8902 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8903 fpstatus 0x0 0
8904 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8905 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8906 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8907 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8908 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8909 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8910 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8911 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8912 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8913
8914 (@value{GDBP})
8915 @end smallexample
8916
8917 @node save-tracepoints
8918 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8919 @kindex save-tracepoints
8920 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8921
8922 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8923 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8924 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8925 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8926 Files}).
8927
8928 @node Tracepoint Variables
8929 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8930 @cindex tracepoint variables
8931 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8932
8933 @table @code
8934 @vindex $trace_frame
8935 @item (int) $trace_frame
8936 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8937 snapshot is selected.
8938
8939 @vindex $tracepoint
8940 @item (int) $tracepoint
8941 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8942
8943 @vindex $trace_line
8944 @item (int) $trace_line
8945 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8946
8947 @vindex $trace_file
8948 @item (char []) $trace_file
8949 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8950
8951 @vindex $trace_func
8952 @item (char []) $trace_func
8953 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8954 @end table
8955
8956 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8957 use @code{output} instead.
8958
8959 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8960 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8961 data.
8962
8963 @smallexample
8964 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8965
8966 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8967 > output $trace_file
8968 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8969 > tfind
8970 > end
8971 @end smallexample
8972
8973 @node Overlays
8974 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8975 @cindex overlays
8976
8977 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8978 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8979 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8980 use overlays.
8981
8982 @menu
8983 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8984 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8985 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8986 mapped by asking the inferior.
8987 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8988 @end menu
8989
8990 @node How Overlays Work
8991 @section How Overlays Work
8992 @cindex mapped overlays
8993 @cindex unmapped overlays
8994 @cindex load address, overlay's
8995 @cindex mapped address
8996 @cindex overlay area
8997
8998 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8999 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
9000 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
9001 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
9002 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
9003
9004 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
9005 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
9006 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
9007 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
9008 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
9009 largest overlay as well.
9010
9011 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
9012 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
9013 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
9014 there.
9015
9016 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
9017 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
9018 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
9019
9020 @smallexample
9021 @group
9022 Data Instruction Larger
9023 Address Space Address Space Address Space
9024 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
9025 | | | | | |
9026 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
9027 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
9028 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
9029 | and heap | | | | | |
9030 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
9031 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
9032 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
9033 | | | | | |
9034 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
9035 address | | | | | |
9036 | overlay | <-' | | |
9037 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
9038 | | <---. | | load address
9039 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
9040 | | | |
9041 +-----------+ | |
9042 +-----------+
9043 | |
9044 +-----------+
9045
9046 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
9047 @end group
9048 @end smallexample
9049
9050 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
9051 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9052 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9053 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9054 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9055 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9056 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9057 program and the overlay area.
9058
9059 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9060 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9061 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9062 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9063 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9064 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9065 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9066
9067 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9068 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9069 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9070
9071 @itemize @bullet
9072
9073 @item
9074 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9075 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9076 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9077 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9078
9079 @item
9080 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9081 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9082 your program's performance.
9083
9084 @item
9085 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9086 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9087 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9088 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9089 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9090 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9091 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9092
9093 @item
9094 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9095 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9096 instruction and data spaces.
9097
9098 @end itemize
9099
9100 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9101 improved in many ways:
9102
9103 @itemize @bullet
9104
9105 @item
9106 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9107 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9108 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9109 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9110 area in the usual way.
9111
9112 @item
9113 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9114 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9115
9116 @item
9117 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9118 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9119 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9120 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9121 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9122 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9123 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9124
9125 @end itemize
9126
9127
9128 @node Overlay Commands
9129 @section Overlay Commands
9130
9131 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9132 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9133 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9134 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9135 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9136 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9137
9138 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9139 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9140
9141 @table @code
9142 @item overlay off
9143 @kindex overlay
9144 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9145 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9146 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9147 overlay support is disabled.
9148
9149 @item overlay manual
9150 @cindex manual overlay debugging
9151 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9152 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9153 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9154 commands described below.
9155
9156 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9157 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9158 @cindex map an overlay
9159 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9160 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9161 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9162 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9163 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9164 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9165
9166 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9167 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9168 @cindex unmap an overlay
9169 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9170 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9171 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9172 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9173
9174 @item overlay auto
9175 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9176 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9177 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9178 Overlay Debugging}.
9179
9180 @item overlay load-target
9181 @itemx overlay load
9182 @cindex reloading the overlay table
9183 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9184 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9185 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9186 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9187 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9188
9189 @item overlay list-overlays
9190 @itemx overlay list
9191 @cindex listing mapped overlays
9192 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9193 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9194
9195 @end table
9196
9197 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9198 of the function the address falls in:
9199
9200 @smallexample
9201 (@value{GDBP}) print main
9202 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9203 @end smallexample
9204 @noindent
9205 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9206 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9207 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9208 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9209
9210 @smallexample
9211 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9212 No sections are mapped.
9213 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9214 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9215 @end smallexample
9216 @noindent
9217 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9218 name normally:
9219
9220 @smallexample
9221 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9222 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9223 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9224 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9225 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9226 @end smallexample
9227
9228 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9229 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9230 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9231 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9232 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9233
9234 @itemize @bullet
9235 @item
9236 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
9237 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9238 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9239 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9240 @item
9241 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9242 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9243 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9244 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9245 breakpoints properly.
9246 @end itemize
9247
9248
9249 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9250 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9251 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
9252
9253 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9254 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9255 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9256 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9257 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9258 current state of the overlays.
9259
9260 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9261 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9262
9263 @table @asis
9264
9265 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9266 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9267
9268 @smallexample
9269 struct
9270 @{
9271 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9272 unsigned long vma;
9273
9274 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9275 unsigned long size;
9276
9277 /* The overlay's load address. */
9278 unsigned long lma;
9279
9280 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9281 zero otherwise. */
9282 unsigned long mapped;
9283 @}
9284 @end smallexample
9285
9286 @item @code{_novlys}:
9287 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9288 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9289
9290 @end table
9291
9292 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9293 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9294 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9295 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9296 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9297 currently mapped.
9298
9299 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9300 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9301 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9302 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9303 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9304 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9305 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9306 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9307 are not being executed.
9308
9309 @node Overlay Sample Program
9310 @section Overlay Sample Program
9311 @cindex overlay example program
9312
9313 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9314 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9315 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9316 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9317 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9318 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9319 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9320
9321 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9322 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9323 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9324 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9325
9326 @table @file
9327 @item overlays.c
9328 The main program file.
9329 @item ovlymgr.c
9330 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9331 @item foo.c
9332 @itemx bar.c
9333 @itemx baz.c
9334 @itemx grbx.c
9335 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9336 @item d10v.ld
9337 @itemx m32r.ld
9338 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9339 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9340 @end table
9341
9342 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9343 cross-compiler like this:
9344
9345 @smallexample
9346 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9347 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9348 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9349 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9350 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9351 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9352 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9353 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9354 @end smallexample
9355
9356 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9357 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9358 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9359
9360
9361 @node Languages
9362 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9363 @cindex languages
9364
9365 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9366 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9367 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9368 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9369 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9370 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9371
9372 @cindex working language
9373 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9374 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9375 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9376 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9377 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9378 language}.
9379
9380 @menu
9381 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9382 * Show:: Displaying the language
9383 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9384 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9385 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9386 @end menu
9387
9388 @node Setting
9389 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9390
9391 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9392 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9393 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9394 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9395 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9396 are printed, etc.
9397
9398 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9399 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9400 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9401 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9402 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9403 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9404 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9405 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9406 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9407 Displaying the Language}.
9408
9409 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9410 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9411 another language. In that case, make the
9412 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9413 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9414 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9415
9416 @menu
9417 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9418 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9419 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9420 @end menu
9421
9422 @node Filenames
9423 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9424
9425 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9426 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9427
9428 @table @file
9429 @item .ada
9430 @itemx .ads
9431 @itemx .adb
9432 @itemx .a
9433 Ada source file.
9434
9435 @item .c
9436 C source file
9437
9438 @item .C
9439 @itemx .cc
9440 @itemx .cp
9441 @itemx .cpp
9442 @itemx .cxx
9443 @itemx .c++
9444 C@t{++} source file
9445
9446 @item .m
9447 Objective-C source file
9448
9449 @item .f
9450 @itemx .F
9451 Fortran source file
9452
9453 @item .mod
9454 Modula-2 source file
9455
9456 @item .s
9457 @itemx .S
9458 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9459 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9460 @end table
9461
9462 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9463 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9464
9465 @node Manually
9466 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9467
9468 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9469 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9470 your program.
9471
9472 @kindex set language
9473 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9474 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9475 a language, such as
9476 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9477 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9478
9479 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9480 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9481 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9482 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9483 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9484 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9485 command such as:
9486
9487 @smallexample
9488 print a = b + c
9489 @end smallexample
9490
9491 @noindent
9492 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9493 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9494 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9495 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9496
9497 @node Automatically
9498 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9499
9500 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9501 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9502 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9503 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9504 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9505 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9506 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9507 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9508 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9509
9510 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9511 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9512 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9513 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9514 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9515
9516 @node Show
9517 @section Displaying the Language
9518
9519 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9520 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9521
9522 @table @code
9523 @item show language
9524 @kindex show language
9525 Display the current working language. This is the
9526 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9527 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9528
9529 @item info frame
9530 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9531 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9532 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9533 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9534 information listed here.
9535
9536 @item info source
9537 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9538 Display the source language of this source file.
9539 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9540 information listed here.
9541 @end table
9542
9543 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9544 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9545 with a language explicitly:
9546
9547 @table @code
9548 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9549 @kindex set extension-language
9550 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9551 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9552
9553 @item info extensions
9554 @kindex info extensions
9555 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9556 @end table
9557
9558 @node Checks
9559 @section Type and Range Checking
9560
9561 @quotation
9562 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9563 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9564 section documents the intended facilities.
9565 @end quotation
9566 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9567
9568 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9569 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9570 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9571 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9572 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9573 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9574 errors when your program is running.
9575
9576 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9577 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9578 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9579 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9580 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9581 automatically based on your program's source language.
9582 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9583 settings of supported languages.
9584
9585 @menu
9586 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9587 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9588 @end menu
9589
9590 @cindex type checking
9591 @cindex checks, type
9592 @node Type Checking
9593 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9594
9595 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9596 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9597 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9598 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9599
9600 @smallexample
9601 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9602 @exdent but
9603 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9604 @end smallexample
9605
9606 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9607 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9608
9609 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9610 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9611 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9612 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9613 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9614 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9615 also issues a warning.
9616
9617 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9618 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9619 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9620 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9621 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9622 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9623
9624 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9625 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9626 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9627 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9628 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9629 details on specific languages.
9630
9631 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9632
9633 @kindex set check type
9634 @kindex show check type
9635 @table @code
9636 @item set check type auto
9637 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9638 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9639 each language.
9640
9641 @item set check type on
9642 @itemx set check type off
9643 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9644 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9645 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9646 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9647 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9648
9649 @item set check type warn
9650 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9651 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9652 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9653 numbers and structures.
9654
9655 @item show type
9656 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9657 is setting it automatically.
9658 @end table
9659
9660 @cindex range checking
9661 @cindex checks, range
9662 @node Range Checking
9663 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9664
9665 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9666 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9667 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9668 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9669 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9670
9671 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9672 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9673 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9674 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9675
9676 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9677 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9678 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9679 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9680 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9681 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9682
9683 @smallexample
9684 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9685 @end smallexample
9686
9687 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9688 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9689 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9690
9691 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9692
9693 @kindex set check range
9694 @kindex show check range
9695 @table @code
9696 @item set check range auto
9697 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9698 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9699 each language.
9700
9701 @item set check range on
9702 @itemx set check range off
9703 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9704 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9705 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9706 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9707
9708 @item set check range warn
9709 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9710 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9711 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9712 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9713 systems).
9714
9715 @item show range
9716 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9717 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9718 @end table
9719
9720 @node Supported Languages
9721 @section Supported Languages
9722
9723 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9724 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9725 @c This is false ...
9726 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9727 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9728 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9729 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9730 language.
9731
9732 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9733 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9734 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9735 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9736 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9737 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9738 language reference or tutorial.
9739
9740 @menu
9741 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9742 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9743 * Fortran:: Fortran
9744 * Pascal:: Pascal
9745 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9746 * Ada:: Ada
9747 @end menu
9748
9749 @node C
9750 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9751
9752 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9753 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9754
9755 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9756 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9757 together.
9758
9759 @cindex C@t{++}
9760 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9761 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9762 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9763 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9764 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9765 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9766 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9767
9768 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9769 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9770 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9771 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9772 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9773 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9774
9775 @menu
9776 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9777 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9778 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9779 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9780 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9781 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9782 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9783 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9784 @end menu
9785
9786 @node C Operators
9787 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9788
9789 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9790
9791 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9792 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9793 often defined on groups of types.
9794
9795 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9796
9797 @itemize @bullet
9798
9799 @item
9800 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9801 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9802
9803 @item
9804 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9805 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9806
9807 @item
9808 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9809
9810 @item
9811 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9812
9813 @end itemize
9814
9815 @noindent
9816 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9817 in order of increasing precedence:
9818
9819 @table @code
9820 @item ,
9821 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9822 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9823 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9824
9825 @item =
9826 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9827 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9828
9829 @item @var{op}=
9830 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9831 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9832 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9833 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9834 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9835
9836 @item ?:
9837 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9838 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9839 integral type.
9840
9841 @item ||
9842 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9843
9844 @item &&
9845 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9846
9847 @item |
9848 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9849
9850 @item ^
9851 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9852
9853 @item &
9854 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9855
9856 @item ==@r{, }!=
9857 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9858 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9859
9860 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9861 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9862 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9863 and non-zero for true.
9864
9865 @item <<@r{, }>>
9866 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9867
9868 @item @@
9869 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9870
9871 @item +@r{, }-
9872 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9873 pointer types.
9874
9875 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9876 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9877 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9878 integral types.
9879
9880 @item ++@r{, }--
9881 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9882 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9883 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9884 operation takes place.
9885
9886 @item *
9887 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9888 @code{++}.
9889
9890 @item &
9891 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9892
9893 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9894 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9895 to examine the address
9896 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9897 stored.
9898
9899 @item -
9900 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9901 precedence as @code{++}.
9902
9903 @item !
9904 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9905 @code{++}.
9906
9907 @item ~
9908 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9909 @code{++}.
9910
9911
9912 @item .@r{, }->
9913 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9914 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9915 pointer based on the stored type information.
9916 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9917
9918 @item .*@r{, }->*
9919 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9920
9921 @item []
9922 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9923 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9924
9925 @item ()
9926 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9927
9928 @item ::
9929 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9930 and @code{class} types.
9931
9932 @item ::
9933 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9934 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9935 above.
9936 @end table
9937
9938 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9939 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9940 predefined meaning.
9941
9942 @node C Constants
9943 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9944
9945 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9946
9947 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9948 following ways:
9949
9950 @itemize @bullet
9951 @item
9952 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9953 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9954 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9955 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9956 @code{long} value.
9957
9958 @item
9959 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9960 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9961 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9962 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9963 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9964 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9965 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9966 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9967 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9968 constant.
9969
9970 @item
9971 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9972 integral equivalents.
9973
9974 @item
9975 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9976 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9977 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9978 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9979 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9980 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9981 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9982 @samp{\n} for newline.
9983
9984 @item
9985 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9986 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9987 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9988 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9989 characters.
9990
9991 @item
9992 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9993 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9994
9995 @item
9996 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9997 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9998 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9999 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
10000 @end itemize
10001
10002 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
10003 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
10004
10005 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
10006 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
10007
10008 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
10009 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
10010 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
10011 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
10012 @quotation
10013 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
10014 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
10015 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
10016 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
10017 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
10018 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
10019 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
10020 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
10021 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
10022 C@t{++} code.
10023 @end quotation
10024
10025 @enumerate
10026
10027 @cindex member functions
10028 @item
10029 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
10030
10031 @smallexample
10032 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
10033 @end smallexample
10034
10035 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
10036 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
10037 @item
10038 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
10039 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
10040 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
10041 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
10042
10043 @cindex call overloaded functions
10044 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
10045 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
10046 @item
10047 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
10048 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
10049 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
10050 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
10051 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10052 default arguments.
10053
10054 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10055 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10056 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10057 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10058 number of function arguments.
10059
10060 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10061 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10062 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10063
10064 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10065 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10066 @smallexample
10067 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10068 @end smallexample
10069
10070 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10071 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10072
10073 @cindex reference declarations
10074 @item
10075 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10076 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10077 dereferenced.
10078
10079 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10080 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10081 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10082 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10083 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10084
10085 @item
10086 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10087 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10088 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10089 necessary, for example in an expression like
10090 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10091 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10092 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10093 @end enumerate
10094
10095 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10096 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10097 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10098 invoking user-defined operators.
10099
10100 @node C Defaults
10101 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10102
10103 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10104
10105 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10106 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10107 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10108 selects the working language.
10109
10110 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10111 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10112 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10113 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10114 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10115 for further details.
10116
10117 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10118 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10119 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10120
10121 @node C Checks
10122 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10123
10124 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10125
10126 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10127 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10128 considers two variables type equivalent if:
10129
10130 @itemize @bullet
10131 @item
10132 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10133 enumerated tag.
10134
10135 @item
10136 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10137 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10138
10139 @ignore
10140 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10141 @c FIXME--beers?
10142 @item
10143 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10144 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10145 compilers.)
10146 @end ignore
10147 @end itemize
10148
10149 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10150 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10151 that is not itself an array.
10152
10153 @node Debugging C
10154 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10155
10156 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10157 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10158 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10159 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10160
10161 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10162 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10163 ,Expressions}.
10164
10165 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
10166 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10167
10168 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
10169
10170 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10171 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10172
10173 @table @code
10174 @cindex break in overloaded functions
10175 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
10176 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10177 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10178 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10179 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10180
10181 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10182 @item rbreak @var{regex}
10183 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10184 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10185 classes.
10186 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10187
10188 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10189 @item catch throw
10190 @itemx catch catch
10191 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10192 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10193
10194 @cindex inheritance
10195 @item ptype @var{typename}
10196 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10197 @var{typename}.
10198 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10199
10200 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10201 @item set print demangle
10202 @itemx show print demangle
10203 @itemx set print asm-demangle
10204 @itemx show print asm-demangle
10205 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10206 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10207 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10208
10209 @item set print object
10210 @itemx show print object
10211 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10212 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10213
10214 @item set print vtbl
10215 @itemx show print vtbl
10216 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10217 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10218 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10219 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10220
10221 @kindex set overload-resolution
10222 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10223 @item set overload-resolution on
10224 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10225 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10226 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10227 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10228 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10229 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10230
10231 @item set overload-resolution off
10232 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10233 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10234 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10235 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10236 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10237 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10238 argument types.
10239
10240 @kindex show overload-resolution
10241 @item show overload-resolution
10242 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10243
10244 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10245 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10246 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10247 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10248 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10249 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10250 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10251 @end table
10252
10253 @node Decimal Floating Point
10254 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10255 @cindex decimal floating point format
10256
10257 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10258 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10259 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10260 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10261
10262 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10263 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10264 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10265 target.
10266
10267 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10268 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10269 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10270
10271 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10272 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10273 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10274
10275 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10276 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10277 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10278
10279 @node Objective-C
10280 @subsection Objective-C
10281
10282 @cindex Objective-C
10283 This section provides information about some commands and command
10284 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10285 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10286 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10287
10288 @menu
10289 * Method Names in Commands::
10290 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10291 @end menu
10292
10293 @node Method Names in Commands
10294 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10295
10296 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10297 names as line specifications:
10298
10299 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10300 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10301 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10302 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10303 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10304 @itemize
10305 @item @code{clear}
10306 @item @code{break}
10307 @item @code{info line}
10308 @item @code{jump}
10309 @item @code{list}
10310 @end itemize
10311
10312 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10313
10314 @smallexample
10315 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10316 @end smallexample
10317
10318 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10319 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10320 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10321 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10322 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10323 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10324 debugged, enter:
10325
10326 @smallexample
10327 break -[Fruit create]
10328 @end smallexample
10329
10330 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10331 enter:
10332
10333 @smallexample
10334 list +[NSText initialize]
10335 @end smallexample
10336
10337 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10338 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10339 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10340 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10341
10342 @smallexample
10343 break create
10344 @end smallexample
10345
10346 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10347 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10348 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10349 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10350 none apply.
10351
10352 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10353 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10354
10355 @smallexample
10356 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10357 @end smallexample
10358
10359 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10360 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10361 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10362 @kindex print-object
10363 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10364
10365 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10366
10367 @smallexample
10368 print -[@var{object} hash]
10369 @end smallexample
10370
10371 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10372 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10373 @noindent
10374 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10375 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10376 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10377 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10378 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10379 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10380
10381 @node Fortran
10382 @subsection Fortran
10383 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10384
10385 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10386 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10387
10388 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10389 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10390 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10391 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10392 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10393 underscore.
10394
10395 @menu
10396 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10397 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10398 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10399 @end menu
10400
10401 @node Fortran Operators
10402 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10403
10404 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10405
10406 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10407 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10408 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10409
10410 @table @code
10411 @item **
10412 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10413 of the second one.
10414
10415 @item :
10416 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10417 represent a section of array.
10418
10419 @item %
10420 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10421 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10422 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10423 union type.
10424 @end table
10425
10426 @node Fortran Defaults
10427 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10428
10429 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10430
10431 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10432 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10433 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10434 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10435
10436 @node Special Fortran Commands
10437 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10438
10439 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10440
10441 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10442 such as displaying common blocks.
10443
10444 @table @code
10445 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10446 @kindex info common
10447 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10448 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10449 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10450 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10451 printed.
10452 @end table
10453
10454 @node Pascal
10455 @subsection Pascal
10456
10457 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10458 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10459 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10460 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10461 syntax.
10462
10463 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10464 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10465 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10466
10467 @node Modula-2
10468 @subsection Modula-2
10469
10470 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10471
10472 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10473 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10474 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10475 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10476 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10477 table.
10478
10479 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10480 @menu
10481 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10482 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10483 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10484 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10485 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10486 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10487 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10488 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10489 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10490 @end menu
10491
10492 @node M2 Operators
10493 @subsubsection Operators
10494 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10495
10496 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10497 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10498 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10499 following definitions hold:
10500
10501 @itemize @bullet
10502
10503 @item
10504 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10505 their subranges.
10506
10507 @item
10508 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10509
10510 @item
10511 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10512
10513 @item
10514 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10515 @var{type}}.
10516
10517 @item
10518 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10519
10520 @item
10521 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10522
10523 @item
10524 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10525 @end itemize
10526
10527 @noindent
10528 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10529 increasing precedence:
10530
10531 @table @code
10532 @item ,
10533 Function argument or array index separator.
10534
10535 @item :=
10536 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10537 @var{value}.
10538
10539 @item <@r{, }>
10540 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10541 types.
10542
10543 @item <=@r{, }>=
10544 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10545 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10546 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10547
10548 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10549 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10550 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10551 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10552 comment character.
10553
10554 @item IN
10555 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10556 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10557
10558 @item OR
10559 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10560
10561 @item AND@r{, }&
10562 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10563
10564 @item @@
10565 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10566
10567 @item +@r{, }-
10568 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10569 and difference on set types.
10570
10571 @item *
10572 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10573 on set types.
10574
10575 @item /
10576 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10577 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10578
10579 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10580 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10581 precedence as @code{*}.
10582
10583 @item -
10584 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10585
10586 @item ^
10587 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10588
10589 @item NOT
10590 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10591 @code{^}.
10592
10593 @item .
10594 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10595 precedence as @code{^}.
10596
10597 @item []
10598 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10599
10600 @item ()
10601 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10602 as @code{^}.
10603
10604 @item ::@r{, }.
10605 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10606 @end table
10607
10608 @quotation
10609 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10610 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10611 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10612 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10613 @end quotation
10614
10615
10616 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10617 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10618 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10619
10620 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10621 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10622
10623 @table @var
10624
10625 @item a
10626 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10627
10628 @item c
10629 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10630
10631 @item i
10632 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10633
10634 @item m
10635 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10636 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10637 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10638
10639 @item n
10640 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10641
10642 @item r
10643 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10644
10645 @item t
10646 represents a type.
10647
10648 @item v
10649 represents a variable.
10650
10651 @item x
10652 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10653 explanation of the function for details.
10654 @end table
10655
10656 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10657
10658 @table @code
10659 @item ABS(@var{n})
10660 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10661
10662 @item CAP(@var{c})
10663 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10664 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10665
10666 @item CHR(@var{i})
10667 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10668
10669 @item DEC(@var{v})
10670 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10671
10672 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10673 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10674 new value.
10675
10676 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10677 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10678 set.
10679
10680 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10681 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10682
10683 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10684 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10685
10686 @item INC(@var{v})
10687 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10688
10689 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10690 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10691 new value.
10692
10693 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10694 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10695 there. Returns the new set.
10696
10697 @item MAX(@var{t})
10698 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10699
10700 @item MIN(@var{t})
10701 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10702
10703 @item ODD(@var{i})
10704 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10705
10706 @item ORD(@var{x})
10707 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10708 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10709 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10710 integral, character and enumerated types.
10711
10712 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10713 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10714
10715 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10716 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10717
10718 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10719 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10720
10721 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10722 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10723 @end table
10724
10725 @quotation
10726 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10727 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10728 an error.
10729 @end quotation
10730
10731 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10732 @node M2 Constants
10733 @subsubsection Constants
10734
10735 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10736 ways:
10737
10738 @itemize @bullet
10739
10740 @item
10741 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10742 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10743 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10744 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10745
10746 @item
10747 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10748 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10749 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10750 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10751 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10752 digits.
10753
10754 @item
10755 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10756 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10757 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10758 followed by a @samp{C}.
10759
10760 @item
10761 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10762 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10763 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10764 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10765 sequences.
10766
10767 @item
10768 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10769
10770 @item
10771 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10772 @code{FALSE}.
10773
10774 @item
10775 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10776
10777 @item
10778 Set constants are not yet supported.
10779 @end itemize
10780
10781 @node M2 Types
10782 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10783 @cindex Modula-2 types
10784
10785 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10786 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10787 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10788 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10789 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10790 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10791
10792 The first example contains the following section of code:
10793
10794 @smallexample
10795 VAR
10796 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10797 r: [20..40] ;
10798 @end smallexample
10799
10800 @noindent
10801 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10802 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10803
10804 @smallexample
10805 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10806 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10807 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10808 SET OF CHAR
10809 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10810 21
10811 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10812 [20..40]
10813 @end smallexample
10814
10815 @noindent
10816 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10817
10818 @smallexample
10819 VAR
10820 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10821 @end smallexample
10822
10823 @noindent
10824 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10825
10826 @smallexample
10827 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10828 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10829 @end smallexample
10830
10831 @noindent
10832 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10833 expressions using the debugger.
10834
10835 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10836 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10837
10838 @smallexample
10839 VAR
10840 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10841 @end smallexample
10842
10843 @smallexample
10844 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10845 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10846 @end smallexample
10847
10848 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10849 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10850 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10851 above.
10852
10853 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10854
10855 @smallexample
10856 TYPE
10857 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10858 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10859 VAR
10860 s: t ;
10861 BEGIN
10862 s := blue ;
10863 @end smallexample
10864
10865 @noindent
10866 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10867 and value of a variable.
10868
10869 @smallexample
10870 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10871 $1 = blue
10872 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10873 type = [blue..yellow]
10874 @end smallexample
10875
10876 @noindent
10877 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10878 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10879 their @code{C} counterparts.
10880
10881 @smallexample
10882 VAR
10883 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10884 BEGIN
10885 s[1] := 1 ;
10886 @end smallexample
10887
10888 @smallexample
10889 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10890 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10891 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10892 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10893 @end smallexample
10894
10895 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10896 pointer types as shown in this example:
10897
10898 @smallexample
10899 VAR
10900 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10901 BEGIN
10902 NEW(s) ;
10903 s^[1] := 1 ;
10904 @end smallexample
10905
10906 @noindent
10907 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10908
10909 @smallexample
10910 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10911 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10912 @end smallexample
10913
10914 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10915 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10916 types:
10917
10918 @smallexample
10919 TYPE
10920 foo = RECORD
10921 f1: CARDINAL ;
10922 f2: CHAR ;
10923 f3: myarray ;
10924 END ;
10925
10926 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10927 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10928 VAR
10929 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10930 @end smallexample
10931
10932 @noindent
10933 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10934 below.
10935
10936 @smallexample
10937 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10938 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10939 f1 : CARDINAL;
10940 f2 : CHAR;
10941 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10942 END
10943 @end smallexample
10944
10945 @node M2 Defaults
10946 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10947 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10948
10949 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10950 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10951 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10952 selected the working language.
10953
10954 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10955 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10956 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10957 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10958
10959 @node Deviations
10960 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10961 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10962
10963 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10964 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10965
10966 @itemize @bullet
10967 @item
10968 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10969 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10970 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10971 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10972 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10973 returned a pointer.)
10974
10975 @item
10976 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10977 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10978 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10979 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10980
10981 @item
10982 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10983 argument.
10984
10985 @item
10986 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10987 @end itemize
10988
10989 @node M2 Checks
10990 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10991 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10992
10993 @quotation
10994 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10995 range checking.
10996 @end quotation
10997 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10998
10999 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
11000
11001 @itemize @bullet
11002 @item
11003 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
11004 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
11005
11006 @item
11007 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
11008 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
11009 @end itemize
11010
11011 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
11012 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
11013
11014 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
11015 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
11016
11017 @node M2 Scope
11018 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11019 @cindex scope
11020 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
11021 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
11022 @ifinfo
11023 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
11024 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
11025 @end ifinfo
11026 @iftex
11027 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
11028 @end iftex
11029
11030 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
11031 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
11032 similar syntax:
11033
11034 @smallexample
11035
11036 @var{module} . @var{id}
11037 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
11038 @end smallexample
11039
11040 @noindent
11041 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
11042 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
11043 identifier within your program, except another module.
11044
11045 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
11046 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
11047 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
11048 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
11049
11050 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
11051 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11052 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11053 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11054 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11055 @var{module}.
11056
11057 @node GDB/M2
11058 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11059
11060 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11061 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11062 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11063 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11064 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11065 analogue in Modula-2.
11066
11067 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11068 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11069 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11070 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11071 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11072 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11073
11074 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11075 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11076 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11077
11078 @node Ada
11079 @subsection Ada
11080 @cindex Ada
11081
11082 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11083 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11084 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11085 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11086 to be difficult.
11087
11088
11089 @cindex expressions in Ada
11090 @menu
11091 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11092 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11093 in @value{GDBN}.
11094 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11095 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11096 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11097 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11098 @end menu
11099
11100 @node Ada Mode Intro
11101 @subsubsection Introduction
11102 @cindex Ada mode, general
11103
11104 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11105 syntax, with some extensions.
11106 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11107
11108 @itemize @bullet
11109 @item
11110 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11111 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11112 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11113 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11114
11115 @item
11116 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11117 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11118
11119 @item
11120 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11121 @end itemize
11122
11123 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
11124 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
11125 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
11126 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
11127 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11128
11129 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11130 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11131 was translated from an Ada source file.
11132
11133 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11134 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11135 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11136 middle (to allow based literals).
11137
11138 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11139 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11140 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11141 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11142 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11143 functions to procedures elsewhere.
11144
11145 @node Omissions from Ada
11146 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11147 @cindex Ada, omissions from
11148
11149 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11150
11151 @itemize @bullet
11152 @item
11153 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11154
11155 @itemize @minus
11156 @item
11157 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11158 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11159
11160 @item
11161 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11162
11163 @item
11164 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11165
11166 @item
11167 @t{'Tag}.
11168
11169 @item
11170 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11171 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11172
11173 @item
11174 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11175 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11176
11177 @item
11178 @t{'Address}.
11179 @end itemize
11180
11181 @item
11182 The names in
11183 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11184 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11185 not currently available.
11186
11187 @item
11188 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11189 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11190 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11191 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11192 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11193 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11194 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11195 indeterminate values.
11196
11197 @item
11198 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11199 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11200 are not implemented.
11201
11202 @item
11203 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11204 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11205 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
11206 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11207 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11208
11209 @smallexample
11210 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11211 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11212 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11213 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11214 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11215 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11216 @end smallexample
11217
11218 Changing a
11219 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11220 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11221 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11222 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11223 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11224 declared to have a type such as:
11225
11226 @smallexample
11227 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11228 Id : Integer;
11229 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11230 end record;
11231 @end smallexample
11232
11233 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11234 assignments:
11235
11236 @smallexample
11237 set A_Rec.Len := 4
11238 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11239 @end smallexample
11240
11241 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11242 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11243 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11244 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11245 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11246 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11247 redundant component associations, although which component values are
11248 assigned in such cases is not defined.
11249
11250 @item
11251 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11252
11253 @item
11254 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11255 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11256 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11257 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11258 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11259 the proper resolution.
11260
11261 @item
11262 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11263
11264 @item
11265 Entry calls are not implemented.
11266
11267 @item
11268 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11269 formats are not supported.
11270
11271 @item
11272 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11273
11274 @item
11275 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
11276 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
11277 context.
11278 Should your program
11279 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
11280 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
11281 @end itemize
11282
11283 @node Additions to Ada
11284 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11285 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11286
11287 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11288 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11289
11290 @itemize @bullet
11291 @item
11292 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11293 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11294 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11295 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11296 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11297 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11298 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11299 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11300
11301 @item
11302 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11303 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11304 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11305
11306 @item
11307 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11308 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11309
11310 @item
11311 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11312 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11313 @end itemize
11314
11315 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11316 additions specific to Ada:
11317
11318 @itemize @bullet
11319 @item
11320 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11321 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11322
11323 @smallexample
11324 set x := y + 3
11325 print A(tmp := y + 1)
11326 @end smallexample
11327
11328 @item
11329 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11330 the value of its right-hand operand.
11331 This allows, for example,
11332 complex conditional breaks:
11333
11334 @smallexample
11335 break f
11336 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11337 @end smallexample
11338
11339 @item
11340 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11341 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11342 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11343 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11344 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11345 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11346 in strings. For example,
11347 @smallexample
11348 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11349 @end smallexample
11350 @noindent
11351 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11352 after each period.
11353
11354 @item
11355 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11356 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11357 to write
11358
11359 @smallexample
11360 print 'max(x, y)
11361 @end smallexample
11362
11363 @item
11364 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11365 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11366 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11367 of 3 might print as
11368
11369 @smallexample
11370 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11371 @end smallexample
11372
11373 @noindent
11374 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11375 clause.
11376
11377 @item
11378 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11379 multi-character subsequence of
11380 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11381 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11382 in place of @t{a'length}.
11383
11384 @item
11385 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11386 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11387 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11388 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11389 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11390 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11391 For example,
11392 @smallexample
11393 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11394 @end smallexample
11395
11396 @item
11397 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11398 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11399 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11400 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11401 object.
11402
11403 @end itemize
11404
11405 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11406 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11407
11408 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11409 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11410 before reaching the main procedure.
11411 As defined in the Ada Reference
11412 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11413 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11414 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11415 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11416
11417 @node Ada Glitches
11418 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11419 @cindex Ada, problems
11420
11421 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11422 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11423 @value{GDBN},
11424 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11425 and the GNU Ada compiler.
11426
11427 @itemize @bullet
11428 @item
11429 Currently, the debugger
11430 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11431 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11432 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11433 to get it printed properly.
11434
11435 @item
11436 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11437 storage are invisible to the debugger.
11438
11439 @item
11440 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11441 argument lists are treated as positional).
11442
11443 @item
11444 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11445
11446 @item
11447 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11448 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11449 the host machine.
11450
11451 @item
11452 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
11453
11454 @item
11455 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11456 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11457 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11458 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11459 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11460 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11461 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11462 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11463 you can usually resolve the confusion
11464 by qualifying the problematic names with package
11465 @code{Standard} explicitly.
11466 @end itemize
11467
11468 @node Unsupported Languages
11469 @section Unsupported Languages
11470
11471 @cindex unsupported languages
11472 @cindex minimal language
11473 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11474 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11475 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11476 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11477 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11478 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11479
11480 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11481 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11482 language.
11483
11484 @node Symbols
11485 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11486
11487 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11488 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11489 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11490 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11491 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11492 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11493 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11494
11495 @cindex symbol names
11496 @cindex names of symbols
11497 @cindex quoting names
11498 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11499 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11500 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11501 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11502 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11503 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11504 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11505 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11506
11507 @smallexample
11508 p 'foo.c'::x
11509 @end smallexample
11510
11511 @noindent
11512 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11513
11514 @table @code
11515 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11516 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11517 @kindex set case-sensitive
11518 @item set case-sensitive on
11519 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11520 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11521 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11522 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11523 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11524 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11525 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11526 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11527 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11528 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11529 case-insensitive matches.
11530
11531 @kindex show case-sensitive
11532 @item show case-sensitive
11533 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11534 lookups.
11535
11536 @kindex info address
11537 @cindex address of a symbol
11538 @item info address @var{symbol}
11539 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11540 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11541 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11542 is always stored.
11543
11544 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11545 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11546 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11547
11548 @kindex info symbol
11549 @cindex symbol from address
11550 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11551 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11552 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11553 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11554 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11555
11556 @smallexample
11557 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11558 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11559 @end smallexample
11560
11561 @noindent
11562 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11563 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11564
11565 @kindex whatis
11566 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
11567 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11568 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11569 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11570 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11571 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11572 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11573 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11574 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11575 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11576 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11577
11578 @kindex ptype
11579 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11580 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11581 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11582 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11583
11584 For example, for this variable declaration:
11585
11586 @smallexample
11587 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11588 @end smallexample
11589
11590 @noindent
11591 the two commands give this output:
11592
11593 @smallexample
11594 @group
11595 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11596 type = struct complex
11597 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11598 type = struct complex @{
11599 double real;
11600 double imag;
11601 @}
11602 @end group
11603 @end smallexample
11604
11605 @noindent
11606 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11607 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11608
11609 @cindex incomplete type
11610 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11611 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11612 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11613 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11614 given these declarations:
11615
11616 @smallexample
11617 struct foo;
11618 struct foo *fooptr;
11619 @end smallexample
11620
11621 @noindent
11622 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11623
11624 @smallexample
11625 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11626 $1 = <incomplete type>
11627 @end smallexample
11628
11629 @noindent
11630 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11631 completely specified.
11632
11633 @kindex info types
11634 @item info types @var{regexp}
11635 @itemx info types
11636 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11637 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11638 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11639 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11640 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11641 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11642 name is @code{value}.
11643
11644 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11645 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11646 lists all source files where a type is defined.
11647
11648 @kindex info scope
11649 @cindex local variables
11650 @item info scope @var{location}
11651 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11652 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11653 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11654 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11655 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11656
11657 @smallexample
11658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11659 Scope for command_line_handler:
11660 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11661 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11662 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11663 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11664 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11665 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11666 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11667 @end smallexample
11668
11669 @noindent
11670 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11671 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11672 collect}.
11673
11674 @kindex info source
11675 @item info source
11676 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11677 the function containing the current point of execution:
11678 @itemize @bullet
11679 @item
11680 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11681 @item
11682 the directory it was compiled in,
11683 @item
11684 its length, in lines,
11685 @item
11686 which programming language it is written in,
11687 @item
11688 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11689 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11690 @item
11691 whether the debugging information includes information about
11692 preprocessor macros.
11693 @end itemize
11694
11695
11696 @kindex info sources
11697 @item info sources
11698 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11699 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11700 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11701
11702 @kindex info functions
11703 @item info functions
11704 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11705
11706 @item info functions @var{regexp}
11707 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11708 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11709 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11710 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11711 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11712 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11713 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11714
11715 @kindex info variables
11716 @item info variables
11717 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11718 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11719
11720 @item info variables @var{regexp}
11721 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11722 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11723 @var{regexp}.
11724
11725 @kindex info classes
11726 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11727 @item info classes
11728 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11729 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11730 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11731 expression.
11732
11733 @kindex info selectors
11734 @item info selectors
11735 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11736 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11737 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11738 expression.
11739
11740 @ignore
11741 This was never implemented.
11742 @kindex info methods
11743 @item info methods
11744 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11745 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11746 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11747 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11748 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11749 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11750 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11751 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11752 @end ignore
11753
11754 @cindex reloading symbols
11755 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11756 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11757 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11758 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11759 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11760
11761 @table @code
11762 @kindex set symbol-reloading
11763 @item set symbol-reloading on
11764 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11765 object file with a particular name is seen again.
11766
11767 @item set symbol-reloading off
11768 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11769 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11770 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11771 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11772 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11773 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11774 name.
11775
11776 @kindex show symbol-reloading
11777 @item show symbol-reloading
11778 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11779 @end table
11780
11781 @cindex opaque data types
11782 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11783 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
11784 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11785 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11786 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11787 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11788 another source file. The default is on.
11789
11790 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11791 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11792
11793 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
11794 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11795 is printed as follows:
11796 @smallexample
11797 @{<no data fields>@}
11798 @end smallexample
11799
11800 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11801 @item show opaque-type-resolution
11802 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11803
11804 @kindex set print symbol-loading
11805 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
11806 @item set print symbol-loading
11807 @itemx set print symbol-loading on
11808 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
11809 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
11810 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
11811 By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
11812 you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
11813 with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
11814 annoying than useful.
11815
11816 @kindex show print symbol-loading
11817 @item show print symbol-loading
11818 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
11819
11820 @kindex maint print symbols
11821 @cindex symbol dump
11822 @kindex maint print psymbols
11823 @cindex partial symbol dump
11824 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11825 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11826 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11827 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11828 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11829 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11830 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11831 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11832 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11833 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11834 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11835 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11836 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11837 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11838 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11839 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11840 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11841
11842 @kindex maint info symtabs
11843 @kindex maint info psymtabs
11844 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11845 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11846 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11847 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11848 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11849 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11850
11851 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11852 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11853 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11854 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11855 structure in more detail. For example:
11856
11857 @smallexample
11858 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11859 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11860 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11861 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11862 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11863 readin no
11864 fullname (null)
11865 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11866 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11867 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11868 dependencies (none)
11869 @}
11870 @}
11871 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11872 (@value{GDBP})
11873 @end smallexample
11874 @noindent
11875 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11876 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11877 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11878 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11879 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11880
11881 @smallexample
11882 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11883 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11884 line 1574.
11885 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11886 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11887 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11888 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11889 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11890 dirname (null)
11891 fullname (null)
11892 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11893 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11894 debugformat DWARF 2
11895 @}
11896 @}
11897 (@value{GDBP})
11898 @end smallexample
11899 @end table
11900
11901
11902 @node Altering
11903 @chapter Altering Execution
11904
11905 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11906 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11907 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11908 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11909 program.
11910
11911 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11912 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11913 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11914
11915 @menu
11916 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11917 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11918 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11919 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11920 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11921 * Patching:: Patching your program
11922 @end menu
11923
11924 @node Assignment
11925 @section Assignment to Variables
11926
11927 @cindex assignment
11928 @cindex setting variables
11929 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11930 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11931
11932 @smallexample
11933 print x=4
11934 @end smallexample
11935
11936 @noindent
11937 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11938 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11939 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11940 information on operators in supported languages.
11941
11942 @kindex set variable
11943 @cindex variables, setting
11944 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11945 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11946 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11947 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11948 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11949
11950 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11951 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11952 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11953 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11954 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11955 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11956 command @code{set width}:
11957
11958 @smallexample
11959 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11960 type = double
11961 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11962 $4 = 13
11963 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11964 Invalid syntax in expression.
11965 @end smallexample
11966
11967 @noindent
11968 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11969 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11970
11971 @smallexample
11972 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11973 @end smallexample
11974
11975 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11976 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11977 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11978 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11979 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11980 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11981
11982 @smallexample
11983 @group
11984 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11985 type = double
11986 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11987 $1 = 1
11988 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11989 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11990 $2 = 1
11991 (@value{GDBP}) r
11992 The program being debugged has been started already.
11993 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11994 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11995 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11996 Invalid bfd target.
11997 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11998 The current BFD target is "=4".
11999 @end group
12000 @end smallexample
12001
12002 @noindent
12003 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
12004 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
12005 @code{g}, use
12006
12007 @smallexample
12008 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
12009 @end smallexample
12010
12011 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
12012 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
12013 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
12014 same length or shorter.
12015 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
12016 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
12017
12018 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
12019 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
12020 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
12021 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
12022 and representation in memory), and
12023
12024 @smallexample
12025 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
12026 @end smallexample
12027
12028 @noindent
12029 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
12030
12031 @node Jumping
12032 @section Continuing at a Different Address
12033
12034 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
12035 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
12036 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
12037
12038 @table @code
12039 @kindex jump
12040 @item jump @var{linespec}
12041 @itemx jump @var{location}
12042 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
12043 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
12044 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
12045 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
12046 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
12047 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12048
12049 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
12050 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
12051 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
12052 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
12053 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
12054 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
12055 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
12056 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
12057 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
12058 @end table
12059
12060 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12061 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12062 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12063 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12064 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12065 example,
12066
12067 @smallexample
12068 set $pc = 0x485
12069 @end smallexample
12070
12071 @noindent
12072 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12073 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12074 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12075
12076 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12077 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12078 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12079 detail.
12080
12081 @c @group
12082 @node Signaling
12083 @section Giving your Program a Signal
12084 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
12085
12086 @table @code
12087 @kindex signal
12088 @item signal @var{signal}
12089 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12090 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12091 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12092 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12093
12094 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12095 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12096 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12097 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12098 signal.
12099
12100 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12101 after executing the command.
12102 @end table
12103 @c @end group
12104
12105 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12106 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12107 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12108 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12109 passes the signal directly to your program.
12110
12111
12112 @node Returning
12113 @section Returning from a Function
12114
12115 @table @code
12116 @cindex returning from a function
12117 @kindex return
12118 @item return
12119 @itemx return @var{expression}
12120 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12121 command. If you give an
12122 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12123 value.
12124 @end table
12125
12126 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12127 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12128 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12129 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12130
12131 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12132 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12133 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12134 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12135 of functions.
12136
12137 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12138 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12139 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12140 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12141 selected stack frame returns naturally.
12142
12143 @node Calling
12144 @section Calling Program Functions
12145
12146 @table @code
12147 @cindex calling functions
12148 @cindex inferior functions, calling
12149 @item print @var{expr}
12150 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
12151 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
12152 debugged.
12153
12154 @kindex call
12155 @item call @var{expr}
12156 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
12157 returned values.
12158
12159 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
12160 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
12161 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
12162 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
12163 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
12164 value history.
12165 @end table
12166
12167 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
12168 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
12169 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
12170 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
12171
12172 @table @code
12173 @item set unwindonsignal
12174 @kindex set unwindonsignal
12175 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
12176 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
12177 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
12178 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
12179 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
12180 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
12181 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
12182 received.
12183
12184 @item show unwindonsignal
12185 @kindex show unwindonsignal
12186 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
12187 @value{GDBN}.
12188 @end table
12189
12190 @cindex weak alias functions
12191 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
12192 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
12193 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
12194 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
12195 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
12196 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
12197 function instead.
12198
12199 @node Patching
12200 @section Patching Programs
12201
12202 @cindex patching binaries
12203 @cindex writing into executables
12204 @cindex writing into corefiles
12205
12206 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
12207 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
12208 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
12209 patching your program's binary.
12210
12211 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
12212 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
12213 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
12214 repairs.
12215
12216 @table @code
12217 @kindex set write
12218 @item set write on
12219 @itemx set write off
12220 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
12221 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
12222 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
12223
12224 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
12225 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
12226 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
12227
12228 @item show write
12229 @kindex show write
12230 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
12231 as well as reading.
12232 @end table
12233
12234 @node GDB Files
12235 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
12236
12237 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
12238 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
12239 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
12240 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
12241
12242 @menu
12243 * Files:: Commands to specify files
12244 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
12245 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
12246 @end menu
12247
12248 @node Files
12249 @section Commands to Specify Files
12250
12251 @cindex symbol table
12252 @cindex core dump file
12253
12254 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
12255 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
12256 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
12257 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
12258
12259 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
12260 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
12261 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
12262 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
12263 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
12264 new files are useful.
12265
12266 @table @code
12267 @cindex executable file
12268 @kindex file
12269 @item file @var{filename}
12270 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12271 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12272 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12273 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12274 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12275 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12276 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12277 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12278
12279 @cindex unlinked object files
12280 @cindex patching object files
12281 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12282 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12283 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12284 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12285 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12286 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12287 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12288 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12289
12290 @item file
12291 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12292 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12293
12294 @kindex exec-file
12295 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12296 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12297 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12298 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12299 discard information on the executable file.
12300
12301 @kindex symbol-file
12302 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12303 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12304 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12305 table and program to run from the same file.
12306
12307 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12308 program's symbol table.
12309
12310 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
12311 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
12312 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
12313 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
12314 @value{GDBN}.
12315
12316 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
12317 executing it once.
12318
12319 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
12320 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
12321 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
12322 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
12323 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
12324 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
12325 optimized code.
12326
12327 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
12328 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
12329 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
12330 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
12331 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
12332
12333 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
12334 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
12335 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
12336 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
12337 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
12338 Warnings and Messages}.)
12339
12340 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
12341 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
12342 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
12343 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
12344 in stabs format.
12345
12346 @kindex readnow
12347 @cindex reading symbols immediately
12348 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
12349 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12350 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12351 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
12352 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
12353 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
12354 entire symbol table available.
12355
12356 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
12357 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
12358 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
12359 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
12360 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
12361 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
12362 @c files.
12363
12364 @kindex core-file
12365 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
12366 @itemx core
12367 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
12368 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
12369 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
12370 executable file itself for other parts.
12371
12372 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
12373 to be used.
12374
12375 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
12376 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
12377 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
12378 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
12379 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
12380
12381 @kindex add-symbol-file
12382 @cindex dynamic linking
12383 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12384 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12385 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12386 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12387 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12388 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12389 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12390 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12391 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12392 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12393 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12394 @var{address} as an expression.
12395
12396 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12397 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12398 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12399 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12400 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12401
12402 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12403 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12404 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12405 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12406 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12407 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12408 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12409 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12410 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12411
12412 @itemize @bullet
12413 @item
12414 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12415 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12416 @item
12417 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12418 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12419 @item
12420 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12421 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12422 @end itemize
12423
12424 @noindent
12425 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12426 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12427 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12428 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12429 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12430 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12431 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12432 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12433 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12434 way.
12435
12436 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12437
12438 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12439 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12440 @cindex load symbols from memory
12441 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12442 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12443 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12444 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12445 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12446 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12447 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12448 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12449 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12450
12451 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12452 @kindex assf
12453 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12454 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
12455 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12456 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12457 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12458 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12459 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12460 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12461 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12462 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12463
12464 @kindex section
12465 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12466 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12467 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12468 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12469 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12470 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12471 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12472 their addresses.
12473
12474 @kindex info files
12475 @kindex info target
12476 @item info files
12477 @itemx info target
12478 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12479 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12480 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12481 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12482 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12483 current ones.
12484
12485 @kindex maint info sections
12486 @item maint info sections
12487 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12488 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12489 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12490 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12491 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12492 may be arbitrarily combined):
12493
12494 @table @code
12495 @item ALLOBJ
12496 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12497 @item @var{sections}
12498 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12499 @item @var{section-flags}
12500 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12501 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12502 @table @code
12503 @item ALLOC
12504 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12505 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12506 @item LOAD
12507 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
12508 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
12509 @item RELOC
12510 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
12511 @item READONLY
12512 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12513 @item CODE
12514 Section contains executable code only.
12515 @item DATA
12516 Section contains data only (no executable code).
12517 @item ROM
12518 Section will reside in ROM.
12519 @item CONSTRUCTOR
12520 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12521 @item HAS_CONTENTS
12522 Section is not empty.
12523 @item NEVER_LOAD
12524 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12525 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12526 A notification to the linker that the section contains
12527 COFF shared library information.
12528 @item IS_COMMON
12529 Section contains common symbols.
12530 @end table
12531 @end table
12532 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12533 @cindex read-only sections
12534 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
12535 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12536 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12537 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12538 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12539 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12540 enhancement to debugging performance.
12541
12542 The default is off.
12543
12544 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
12545 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12546 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12547 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12548
12549 @item show trust-readonly-sections
12550 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12551 @end table
12552
12553 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12554 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12555 name and remembers it that way.
12556
12557 @cindex shared libraries
12558 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
12559 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12560 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12561
12562 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12563 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12564
12565 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12566 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12567 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12568 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12569 debugging a core file).
12570
12571 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12572 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12573
12574 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12575 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12576 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12577
12578 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12579 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12580 particularly large or there are many of them.
12581
12582 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12583 commands:
12584
12585 @table @code
12586 @kindex set auto-solib-add
12587 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
12588 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
12589 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
12590 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
12591 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
12592 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
12593 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
12594
12595 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
12596 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
12597 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
12598 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
12599 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
12600 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
12601 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
12602 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
12603 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
12604
12605 @kindex show auto-solib-add
12606 @item show auto-solib-add
12607 Display the current autoloading mode.
12608 @end table
12609
12610 @cindex load shared library
12611 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
12612 command:
12613
12614 @table @code
12615 @kindex info sharedlibrary
12616 @kindex info share
12617 @item info share
12618 @itemx info sharedlibrary
12619 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
12620
12621 @kindex sharedlibrary
12622 @kindex share
12623 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
12624 @itemx share @var{regex}
12625 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
12626 Unix regular expression.
12627 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
12628 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
12629 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
12630 loaded.
12631
12632 @item nosharedlibrary
12633 @kindex nosharedlibrary
12634 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
12635 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12636 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12637 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12638 discarded.
12639 @end table
12640
12641 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12642 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12643 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12644
12645 @table @code
12646 @item set stop-on-solib-events
12647 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12648 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12649 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12650 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12651 shared library.
12652
12653 @item show stop-on-solib-events
12654 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12655 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12656 library events happen.
12657 @end table
12658
12659 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12660 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
12661 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
12662 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
12663 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
12664 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12665 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12666 not.
12667
12668 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
12669 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12670 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12671 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12672 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12673
12674 @table @code
12675 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
12676 @cindex system root, alternate
12677 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12678 @kindex set sysroot
12679 @item set sysroot @var{path}
12680 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12681 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12682 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12683 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12684 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12685 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12686 under @var{path}.
12687
12688 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
12689 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
12690 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
12691 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
12692 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
12693 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
12694 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
12695 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
12696 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
12697
12698 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12699 sysroot}.
12700
12701 @cindex default system root
12702 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12703 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12704 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12705 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12706 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12707 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12708 location.
12709
12710 @kindex show sysroot
12711 @item show sysroot
12712 Display the current shared library prefix.
12713
12714 @kindex set solib-search-path
12715 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12716 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12717 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12718 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12719 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12720 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12721 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12722 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12723 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12724 of shared library symbols.
12725
12726 @kindex show solib-search-path
12727 @item show solib-search-path
12728 Display the current shared library search path.
12729 @end table
12730
12731
12732 @node Separate Debug Files
12733 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12734 @cindex separate debugging information files
12735 @cindex debugging information in separate files
12736 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12737 @cindex debugging information directory, global
12738 @cindex global debugging information directory
12739 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12740 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12741
12742 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12743 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12744 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12745 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12746 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12747 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12748 install only when they need to debug a problem.
12749
12750 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12751 file:
12752
12753 @itemize @bullet
12754 @item
12755 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12756 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12757 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12758 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12759 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12760 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12761 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12762 came from the same build.
12763
12764 @item
12765 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12766 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12767 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12768 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12769 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12770 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12771 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12772 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12773 below.
12774 @end itemize
12775
12776 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12777 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12778
12779 @itemize @bullet
12780 @item
12781 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12782 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12783 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12784 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12785 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12786
12787 @item
12788 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12789 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12790 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12791 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12792 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12793 hex characters, not 10.)
12794 @end itemize
12795
12796 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12797 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12798 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12799 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12800 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12801 debug information files, in the indicated order:
12802
12803 @itemize @minus
12804 @item
12805 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12806 @item
12807 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12808 @item
12809 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12810 @item
12811 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12812 @end itemize
12813
12814 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12815 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12816
12817 @table @code
12818
12819 @kindex set debug-file-directory
12820 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12821 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12822 information files to @var{directory}.
12823
12824 @kindex show debug-file-directory
12825 @item show debug-file-directory
12826 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12827 information files.
12828
12829 @end table
12830
12831 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12832 @cindex debug link sections
12833 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12834 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12835
12836 @itemize
12837 @item
12838 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12839 a zero byte,
12840 @item
12841 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12842 boundary within the section, and
12843 @item
12844 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12845 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12846 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12847 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12848 @end itemize
12849
12850 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12851 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12852 described above.
12853
12854 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12855 @cindex build ID sections
12856 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12857 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12858 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12859 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12860 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12861 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12862 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12863 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12864 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12865
12866 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12867 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12868 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12869 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12870 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12871 in an ordinary executable.
12872
12873 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12874 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12875 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12876 following commands:
12877
12878 @smallexample
12879 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12880 @kbd{strip -g foo}
12881 @end smallexample
12882
12883 @noindent
12884 These commands remove the debugging
12885 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12886 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12887 two files:
12888
12889 @itemize @bullet
12890 @item
12891 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12892 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12893
12894 @smallexample
12895 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12896 @end smallexample
12897
12898 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12899 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12900 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12901 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12902
12903 @item
12904 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12905 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12906 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12907 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12908 @end itemize
12909
12910 @noindent
12911
12912 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12913 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12914 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12915 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12916
12917 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12918 @smallexample
12919 unsigned long
12920 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12921 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12922 @{
12923 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12924 @{
12925 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12926 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12927 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12928 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12929 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12930 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12931 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12932 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12933 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12934 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12935 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12936 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12937 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12938 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12939 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12940 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12941 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12942 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12943 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12944 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12945 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12946 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12947 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12948 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12949 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12950 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12951 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12952 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12953 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12954 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12955 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12956 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12957 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12958 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12959 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12960 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12961 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12962 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12963 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12964 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12965 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12966 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12967 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12968 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12969 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12970 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12971 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12972 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12973 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12974 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12975 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12976 0x2d02ef8d
12977 @};
12978 unsigned char *end;
12979
12980 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12981 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12982 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12983 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12984 @}
12985 @end smallexample
12986
12987 @noindent
12988 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12989
12990
12991 @node Symbol Errors
12992 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12993
12994 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12995 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12996 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12997 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12998 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12999 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
13000 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
13001 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
13002 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
13003 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13004 Messages}).
13005
13006 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
13007
13008 @table @code
13009 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
13010
13011 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
13012 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
13013 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
13014 in its outer scope blocks.
13015
13016 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
13017 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
13018 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
13019 function.
13020
13021 @item block at @var{address} out of order
13022
13023 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
13024 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
13025 do so.
13026
13027 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
13028 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
13029 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
13030 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13031 Messages}.)
13032
13033 @item bad block start address patched
13034
13035 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
13036 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
13037 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
13038
13039 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
13040 starting on the previous source line.
13041
13042 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
13043
13044 @cindex foo
13045 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
13046 larger than the size of the string table.
13047
13048 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
13049 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
13050 with this name.
13051
13052 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
13053
13054 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
13055 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
13056 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
13057
13058 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
13059 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
13060 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
13061 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
13062 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
13063 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
13064
13065 @item stub type has NULL name
13066
13067 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
13068
13069 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
13070 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
13071 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
13072 it.
13073
13074 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
13075
13076 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
13077
13078 @end table
13079
13080 @node Targets
13081 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
13082
13083 @cindex debugging target
13084 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
13085
13086 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
13087 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
13088 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
13089 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
13090 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
13091 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
13092 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
13093 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
13094
13095 @cindex target architecture
13096 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
13097 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
13098 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
13099 command.
13100
13101 @table @code
13102 @kindex set architecture
13103 @kindex show architecture
13104 @item set architecture @var{arch}
13105 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
13106 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
13107 supported architectures.
13108
13109 @item show architecture
13110 Show the current target architecture.
13111
13112 @item set processor
13113 @itemx processor
13114 @kindex set processor
13115 @kindex show processor
13116 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
13117 and @code{show architecture}.
13118 @end table
13119
13120 @menu
13121 * Active Targets:: Active targets
13122 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
13123 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
13124 @end menu
13125
13126 @node Active Targets
13127 @section Active Targets
13128
13129 @cindex stacking targets
13130 @cindex active targets
13131 @cindex multiple targets
13132
13133 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
13134 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
13135 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
13136 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
13137 a core file.
13138
13139 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
13140 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
13141 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
13142 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
13143 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
13144 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
13145 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
13146 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
13147 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
13148
13149 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
13150 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
13151 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
13152 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
13153 process target is active.
13154
13155 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
13156 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
13157 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
13158 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
13159 Process}).
13160
13161 @node Target Commands
13162 @section Commands for Managing Targets
13163
13164 @table @code
13165 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
13166 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
13167 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
13168 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
13169 protocol of the target machine.
13170
13171 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
13172 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
13173 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
13174
13175 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
13176 after executing the command.
13177
13178 @kindex help target
13179 @item help target
13180 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
13181 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
13182 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13183
13184 @item help target @var{name}
13185 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
13186 select it.
13187
13188 @kindex set gnutarget
13189 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
13190 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
13191 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
13192 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
13193 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
13194 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
13195
13196 @quotation
13197 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
13198 you must know the actual BFD name.
13199 @end quotation
13200
13201 @noindent
13202 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
13203
13204 @kindex show gnutarget
13205 @item show gnutarget
13206 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
13207 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
13208 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
13209 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
13210 @end table
13211
13212 @cindex common targets
13213 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
13214 configuration):
13215
13216 @table @code
13217 @kindex target
13218 @item target exec @var{program}
13219 @cindex executable file target
13220 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
13221 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
13222
13223 @item target core @var{filename}
13224 @cindex core dump file target
13225 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
13226 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
13227
13228 @item target remote @var{medium}
13229 @cindex remote target
13230 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
13231 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
13232 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
13233
13234 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
13235 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
13236
13237 @smallexample
13238 target remote /dev/ttya
13239 @end smallexample
13240
13241 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
13242 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
13243 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
13244 clobbered by the download.
13245
13246 @item target sim
13247 @cindex built-in simulator target
13248 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
13249 In general,
13250 @smallexample
13251 target sim
13252 load
13253 run
13254 @end smallexample
13255 @noindent
13256 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
13257 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
13258 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
13259 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
13260 Processors}.
13261
13262 @end table
13263
13264 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
13265
13266 @table @code
13267
13268 @item target nrom @var{dev}
13269 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
13270 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
13271
13272 @end table
13273
13274 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
13275 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
13276
13277 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
13278 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
13279 various aspects of this process.
13280
13281 @table @code
13282
13283 @item set hash
13284 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13285 @cindex hash mark while downloading
13286 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
13287 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
13288 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
13289 monitor.
13290
13291 @item show hash
13292 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13293 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
13294
13295 @item set debug monitor
13296 @kindex set debug monitor
13297 @cindex display remote monitor communications
13298 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
13299 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13300
13301 @item show debug monitor
13302 @kindex show debug monitor
13303 Show the current status of displaying communications between
13304 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13305 @end table
13306
13307 @table @code
13308
13309 @kindex load @var{filename}
13310 @item load @var{filename}
13311 @anchor{load}
13312 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
13313 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
13314 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
13315 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
13316 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
13317 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13318
13319 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
13320 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
13321 target is @dots{}}''
13322
13323 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
13324 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
13325 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
13326 specifies a fixed address.
13327 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
13328
13329 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
13330 load programs into flash memory.
13331
13332 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
13333 @end table
13334
13335 @node Byte Order
13336 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
13337
13338 @cindex choosing target byte order
13339 @cindex target byte order
13340
13341 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
13342 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
13343 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
13344 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
13345 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
13346 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
13347
13348 @table @code
13349 @kindex set endian
13350 @item set endian big
13351 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
13352
13353 @item set endian little
13354 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
13355
13356 @item set endian auto
13357 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
13358 executable.
13359
13360 @item show endian
13361 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
13362
13363 @end table
13364
13365 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
13366 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
13367 target system.
13368
13369
13370 @node Remote Debugging
13371 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
13372 @cindex remote debugging
13373
13374 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
13375 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
13376 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
13377 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
13378 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
13379
13380 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
13381 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
13382 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
13383 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
13384 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
13385 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
13386
13387 Other remote targets may be available in your
13388 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
13389
13390 @menu
13391 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
13392 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
13393 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
13394 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
13395 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13396 @end menu
13397
13398 @node Connecting
13399 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
13400
13401 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13402 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13403 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13404 program as the first argument.
13405
13406 @cindex @code{target remote}
13407 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13408 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13409 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13410 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13411 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13412 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13413
13414 @table @code
13415
13416 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
13417 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13418 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13419 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13420
13421 @smallexample
13422 target remote /dev/ttyb
13423 @end smallexample
13424
13425 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13426 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13427 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13428 @code{target} command.
13429
13430 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13431 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13432 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13433 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13434 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13435 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13436 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13437 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13438 target.
13439
13440 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13441 @code{manyfarms}:
13442
13443 @smallexample
13444 target remote manyfarms:2828
13445 @end smallexample
13446
13447 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13448 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13449 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13450 port 1234 on your local machine:
13451
13452 @smallexample
13453 target remote :1234
13454 @end smallexample
13455 @noindent
13456
13457 Note that the colon is still required here.
13458
13459 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13460 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13461 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13462 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13463
13464 @smallexample
13465 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13466 @end smallexample
13467
13468 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13469 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13470 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13471 cause havoc with your debugging session.
13472
13473 @item target remote | @var{command}
13474 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13475 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13476 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13477 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13478 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13479 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13480 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13481 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13482
13483 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13484 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13485 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13486
13487 @end table
13488
13489 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13490 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13491 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13492 need to use @kbd{run}.
13493
13494 @cindex interrupting remote programs
13495 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
13496 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13497 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13498 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13499 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13500 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13501
13502 @smallexample
13503 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13504 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13505 @end smallexample
13506
13507 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
13508 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
13509 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
13510 goes back to waiting.
13511
13512 @table @code
13513 @kindex detach (remote)
13514 @item detach
13515 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
13516 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
13517 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
13518 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
13519 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
13520
13521 @kindex disconnect
13522 @item disconnect
13523 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
13524 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13525 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13526 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13527 another target.
13528
13529 @cindex send command to remote monitor
13530 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13531 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
13532 @kindex monitor
13533 @item monitor @var{cmd}
13534 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13535 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13536 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13537 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13538 and implement.
13539 @end table
13540
13541 @node File Transfer
13542 @section Sending files to a remote system
13543 @cindex remote target, file transfer
13544 @cindex file transfer
13545 @cindex sending files to remote systems
13546
13547 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13548 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13549 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13550 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13551 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13552 the only way to upload or download files.
13553
13554 Not all remote targets support these commands.
13555
13556 @table @code
13557 @kindex remote put
13558 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13559 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13560 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13561
13562 @kindex remote get
13563 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13564 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13565 on the host system.
13566
13567 @kindex remote delete
13568 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13569 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13570
13571 @end table
13572
13573 @node Server
13574 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13575
13576 @kindex gdbserver
13577 @cindex remote connection without stubs
13578 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13579 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13580 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13581
13582 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13583 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
13584 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
13585 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
13586 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
13587 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
13588 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
13589 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
13590 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
13591 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
13592 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
13593 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
13594 choice for debugging.
13595
13596 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
13597 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
13598 protocol.
13599
13600 @quotation
13601 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
13602 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
13603 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
13604 target system with the same privileges as the user running
13605 @code{gdbserver}.
13606 @end quotation
13607
13608 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
13609 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
13610
13611 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
13612 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
13613 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
13614 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
13615 system does all the symbol handling.
13616
13617 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
13618 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
13619 syntax is:
13620
13621 @smallexample
13622 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
13623 @end smallexample
13624
13625 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
13626 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
13627 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
13628 @file{/dev/com1}:
13629
13630 @smallexample
13631 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
13632 @end smallexample
13633
13634 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
13635 with it.
13636
13637 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
13638
13639 @smallexample
13640 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
13641 @end smallexample
13642
13643 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
13644 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
13645 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
13646 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
13647 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
13648 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
13649 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
13650 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
13651 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
13652 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
13653 @code{target remote} command.
13654
13655 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
13656
13657 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
13658 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
13659
13660 @smallexample
13661 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
13662 @end smallexample
13663
13664 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13665 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13666
13667 @pindex pidof
13668 @cindex attach to a program by name
13669 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13670 @code{pidof} utility:
13671
13672 @smallexample
13673 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
13674 @end smallexample
13675
13676 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13677 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13678 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13679
13680 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
13681 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
13682 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
13683
13684 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
13685 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
13686 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
13687 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
13688
13689 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
13690 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
13691 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
13692 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
13693 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
13694 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
13695 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
13696 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
13697 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
13698
13699 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
13700 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
13701 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
13702 the program you want to debug.
13703
13704 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
13705 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
13706 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
13707
13708 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
13709
13710 You can include @option{--debug} on the @code{gdbserver} command line.
13711 @code{gdbserver} will display extra status information about the debugging
13712 process. This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and
13713 for bug reports to the developers.
13714
13715 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
13716 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
13717 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
13718 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
13719
13720 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
13721 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
13722 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
13723 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
13724
13725 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
13726 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
13727 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
13728 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
13729
13730 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
13731 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
13732 environment:
13733
13734 @smallexample
13735 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
13736 @end smallexample
13737
13738 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
13739
13740 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
13741
13742 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13743 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13744 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13745 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
13746
13747 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13748 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13749 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13750 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13751 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13752 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13753 programs.
13754
13755 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13756 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13757 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13758 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13759 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
13760 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13761 already on the target.
13762
13763 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13764 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13765 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
13766
13767 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13768 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13769 Here are the available commands.
13770
13771 @table @code
13772 @item monitor help
13773 List the available monitor commands.
13774
13775 @item monitor set debug 0
13776 @itemx monitor set debug 1
13777 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13778
13779 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
13780 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13781 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13782 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13783
13784 @item monitor exit
13785 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
13786 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
13787 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
13788 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
13789 of a multi-process mode debug session.
13790
13791 @end table
13792
13793 @node Remote Configuration
13794 @section Remote Configuration
13795
13796 @kindex set remote
13797 @kindex show remote
13798 This section documents the configuration options available when
13799 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13800 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13801 system-call-allowed}.
13802
13803 @table @code
13804 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13805 @cindex address size for remote targets
13806 @cindex bits in remote address
13807 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13808 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13809 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13810 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13811
13812 @item show remoteaddresssize
13813 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13814
13815 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
13816 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
13817 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13818 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13819 remote targets.
13820
13821 @item show remotebaud
13822 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13823
13824 @item set remotebreak
13825 @cindex interrupt remote programs
13826 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13827 @anchor{set remotebreak}
13828 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13829 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13830 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13831 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13832 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13833
13834 @item show remotebreak
13835 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13836 interrupt the remote program.
13837
13838 @item set remoteflow on
13839 @itemx set remoteflow off
13840 @kindex set remoteflow
13841 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13842 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13843
13844 @item show remoteflow
13845 @kindex show remoteflow
13846 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13847
13848 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13849 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13850 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13851 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13852 @code{ascii}.
13853
13854 @item show remotelogbase
13855 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13856 protocol.
13857
13858 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13859 @cindex record serial communications on file
13860 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13861 default is not to record at all.
13862
13863 @item show remotelogfile.
13864 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13865 serial communications.
13866
13867 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13868 @cindex timeout for serial communications
13869 @cindex remote timeout
13870 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13871 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13872
13873 @item show remotetimeout
13874 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13875 responses.
13876
13877 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13878 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13879 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13880 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13881 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13882 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13883 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13884 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13885
13886 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
13887 @itemx show remote exec-file
13888 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
13889 @cindex executable file, for remote target
13890 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
13891 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
13892 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
13893 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
13894 @end table
13895
13896 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13897 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13898 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13899 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13900 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13901 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13902 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13903 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13904 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13905
13906 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13907 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13908 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13909 @value{GDBN} developers.
13910
13911 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13912 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13913 are:
13914
13915 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13916 @item Command Name
13917 @tab Remote Packet
13918 @tab Related Features
13919
13920 @item @code{fetch-register}
13921 @tab @code{p}
13922 @tab @code{info registers}
13923
13924 @item @code{set-register}
13925 @tab @code{P}
13926 @tab @code{set}
13927
13928 @item @code{binary-download}
13929 @tab @code{X}
13930 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13931
13932 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
13933 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13934 @tab @code{info auxv}
13935
13936 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
13937 @tab @code{qSymbol}
13938 @tab Detecting multiple threads
13939
13940 @item @code{attach}
13941 @tab @code{vAttach}
13942 @tab @code{attach}
13943
13944 @item @code{verbose-resume}
13945 @tab @code{vCont}
13946 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13947
13948 @item @code{run}
13949 @tab @code{vRun}
13950 @tab @code{run}
13951
13952 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
13953 @tab @code{Z0}
13954 @tab @code{break}
13955
13956 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13957 @tab @code{Z1}
13958 @tab @code{hbreak}
13959
13960 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
13961 @tab @code{Z2}
13962 @tab @code{watch}
13963
13964 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
13965 @tab @code{Z3}
13966 @tab @code{rwatch}
13967
13968 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
13969 @tab @code{Z4}
13970 @tab @code{awatch}
13971
13972 @item @code{target-features}
13973 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13974 @tab @code{set architecture}
13975
13976 @item @code{library-info}
13977 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13978 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13979
13980 @item @code{memory-map}
13981 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13982 @tab @code{info mem}
13983
13984 @item @code{read-spu-object}
13985 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13986 @tab @code{info spu}
13987
13988 @item @code{write-spu-object}
13989 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13990 @tab @code{info spu}
13991
13992 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13993 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13994 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13995
13996 @item @code{search-memory}
13997 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
13998 @tab @code{find}
13999
14000 @item @code{supported-packets}
14001 @tab @code{qSupported}
14002 @tab Remote communications parameters
14003
14004 @item @code{pass-signals}
14005 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
14006 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
14007
14008 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
14009 @tab @code{vFile:close}
14010 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14011
14012 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
14013 @tab @code{vFile:open}
14014 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14015
14016 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
14017 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
14018 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14019
14020 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
14021 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
14022 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14023
14024 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
14025 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
14026 @tab @code{remote delete}
14027
14028 @item @code{noack-packet}
14029 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
14030 @tab Packet acknowledgment
14031 @end multitable
14032
14033 @node Remote Stub
14034 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
14035
14036 @cindex debugging stub, example
14037 @cindex remote stub, example
14038 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
14039 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
14040 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
14041 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
14042 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
14043 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
14044 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
14045 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
14046
14047 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
14048 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
14049 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
14050 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
14051 program, you need:
14052
14053 @enumerate
14054 @item
14055 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
14056 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
14057 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
14058
14059 @item
14060 A C subroutine library to support your program's
14061 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
14062
14063 @item
14064 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
14065 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
14066 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
14067 documentation.
14068 @end enumerate
14069
14070 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
14071 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
14072 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
14073
14074 @table @emph
14075 @item On the host,
14076 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
14077 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
14078 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14079
14080 @item On the target,
14081 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
14082 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
14083 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
14084
14085 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
14086 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
14087 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
14088 @end table
14089
14090 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
14091 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
14092 @sc{sparc} boards.
14093
14094 @cindex remote serial stub list
14095 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
14096
14097 @table @code
14098
14099 @item i386-stub.c
14100 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
14101 @cindex Intel
14102 @cindex i386
14103 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
14104
14105 @item m68k-stub.c
14106 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
14107 @cindex Motorola 680x0
14108 @cindex m680x0
14109 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
14110
14111 @item sh-stub.c
14112 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
14113 @cindex Renesas
14114 @cindex SH
14115 For Renesas SH architectures.
14116
14117 @item sparc-stub.c
14118 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
14119 @cindex Sparc
14120 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
14121
14122 @item sparcl-stub.c
14123 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
14124 @cindex Fujitsu
14125 @cindex SparcLite
14126 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
14127
14128 @end table
14129
14130 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
14131 recently added stubs.
14132
14133 @menu
14134 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
14135 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
14136 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
14137 @end menu
14138
14139 @node Stub Contents
14140 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
14141
14142 @cindex remote serial stub
14143 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
14144 subroutines:
14145
14146 @table @code
14147 @item set_debug_traps
14148 @findex set_debug_traps
14149 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
14150 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
14151 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
14152 beginning of your program.
14153
14154 @item handle_exception
14155 @findex handle_exception
14156 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
14157 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
14158 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
14159 run when a trap is triggered.
14160
14161 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
14162 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
14163 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
14164 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
14165 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
14166 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
14167 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
14168 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
14169 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
14170 machine.
14171
14172 @item breakpoint
14173 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
14174 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
14175 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
14176 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
14177 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
14178 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
14179 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
14180 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
14181 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
14182 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
14183 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
14184
14185 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
14186 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
14187 start of your debugging session.
14188 @end table
14189
14190 @node Bootstrapping
14191 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
14192
14193 @cindex remote stub, support routines
14194 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
14195 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
14196 debugging target machine.
14197
14198 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
14199 serial port.
14200
14201 @table @code
14202 @item int getDebugChar()
14203 @findex getDebugChar
14204 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
14205 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
14206 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14207
14208 @item void putDebugChar(int)
14209 @findex putDebugChar
14210 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
14211 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
14212 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14213 @end table
14214
14215 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
14216 @cindex interrupting remote targets
14217 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
14218 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
14219 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
14220 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
14221 remote system to stop.
14222
14223 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
14224 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
14225 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
14226 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
14227
14228 Other routines you need to supply are:
14229
14230 @table @code
14231 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
14232 @findex exceptionHandler
14233 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
14234 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
14235 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
14236 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
14237 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
14238 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
14239 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
14240 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
14241 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
14242 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
14243 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
14244 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
14245 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
14246
14247 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
14248 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
14249 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
14250 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
14251 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
14252
14253 @item void flush_i_cache()
14254 @findex flush_i_cache
14255 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
14256 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
14257 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
14258
14259 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
14260 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
14261 @end table
14262
14263 @noindent
14264 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
14265
14266 @table @code
14267 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
14268 @findex memset
14269 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
14270 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
14271 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
14272 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
14273 @end table
14274
14275 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
14276 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
14277 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
14278 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
14279
14280
14281 @node Debug Session
14282 @subsection Putting it All Together
14283
14284 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
14285 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
14286 steps.
14287
14288 @enumerate
14289 @item
14290 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
14291 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
14292 @display
14293 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
14294 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
14295 @end display
14296
14297 @item
14298 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
14299
14300 @smallexample
14301 set_debug_traps();
14302 breakpoint();
14303 @end smallexample
14304
14305 @item
14306 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
14307 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
14308
14309 @smallexample
14310 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
14311 @end smallexample
14312
14313 @noindent
14314 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
14315 function in your program, that function is called when
14316 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
14317 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
14318 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
14319
14320 @item
14321 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
14322 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
14323
14324 @item
14325 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
14326 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
14327
14328 @item
14329 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
14330 @c document that. FIXME.
14331 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
14332 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
14333
14334 @item
14335 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
14336 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14337
14338 @end enumerate
14339
14340 @node Configurations
14341 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
14342
14343 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
14344 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
14345 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
14346
14347 There are three major categories of configurations: native
14348 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
14349 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
14350 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
14351 are quite different from each other.
14352
14353 @menu
14354 * Native::
14355 * Embedded OS::
14356 * Embedded Processors::
14357 * Architectures::
14358 @end menu
14359
14360 @node Native
14361 @section Native
14362
14363 This section describes details specific to particular native
14364 configurations.
14365
14366 @menu
14367 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
14368 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
14369 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
14370 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
14371 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
14372 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
14373 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
14374 @end menu
14375
14376 @node HP-UX
14377 @subsection HP-UX
14378
14379 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
14380 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
14381 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
14382
14383
14384 @node BSD libkvm Interface
14385 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
14386
14387 @cindex libkvm
14388 @cindex kernel memory image
14389 @cindex kernel crash dump
14390
14391 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
14392 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
14393 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
14394 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
14395 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
14396 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
14397 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
14398 @code{kvm} target:
14399
14400 @smallexample
14401 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14402 @end smallexample
14403
14404 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14405 argument:
14406
14407 @smallexample
14408 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14409 @end smallexample
14410
14411 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14412 available:
14413
14414 @table @code
14415 @kindex kvm
14416 @item kvm pcb
14417 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14418
14419 @item kvm proc
14420 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14421 modern FreeBSD systems.
14422 @end table
14423
14424 @node SVR4 Process Information
14425 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
14426 @cindex /proc
14427 @cindex examine process image
14428 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14429
14430 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14431 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14432 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14433 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14434 proc} is available to report information about the process running
14435 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14436 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14437 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14438 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14439
14440 @table @code
14441 @kindex info proc
14442 @cindex process ID
14443 @item info proc
14444 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14445 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14446 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14447 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14448 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14449 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14450 executable file's absolute file name.
14451
14452 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14453 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14454 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14455 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14456 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14457 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14458
14459 @item info proc mappings
14460 @cindex memory address space mappings
14461 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
14462 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
14463 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
14464 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
14465 memory access rights to that range.
14466
14467 @item info proc stat
14468 @itemx info proc status
14469 @cindex process detailed status information
14470 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
14471 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
14472 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
14473 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
14474 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
14475 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
14476 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
14477
14478 @item info proc all
14479 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
14480 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
14481
14482 @ignore
14483 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
14484 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
14485 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
14486 @kindex info proc times
14487 @item info proc times
14488 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
14489 its children.
14490
14491 @kindex info proc id
14492 @item info proc id
14493 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
14494 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
14495 @end ignore
14496
14497 @item set procfs-trace
14498 @kindex set procfs-trace
14499 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
14500 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
14501
14502 @item show procfs-trace
14503 @kindex show procfs-trace
14504 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
14505
14506 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
14507 @kindex set procfs-file
14508 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
14509 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
14510 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
14511 standard output.
14512
14513 @item show procfs-file
14514 @kindex show procfs-file
14515 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
14516
14517 @item proc-trace-entry
14518 @itemx proc-trace-exit
14519 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
14520 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
14521 @kindex proc-trace-entry
14522 @kindex proc-trace-exit
14523 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
14524 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
14525 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
14526 from the @code{syscall} interface.
14527
14528 @item info pidlist
14529 @kindex info pidlist
14530 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
14531 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
14532 processes and all the threads within each process.
14533
14534 @item info meminfo
14535 @kindex info meminfo
14536 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
14537 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
14538 @end table
14539
14540 @node DJGPP Native
14541 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
14542 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
14543 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
14544 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
14545
14546 @cindex DPMI
14547 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
14548 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
14549 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
14550 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
14551
14552 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
14553 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
14554 subsection describes those commands.
14555
14556 @table @code
14557 @kindex info dos
14558 @item info dos
14559 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
14560 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14561
14562 @kindex sysinfo
14563 @cindex MS-DOS system info
14564 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
14565 @item info dos sysinfo
14566 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
14567 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
14568 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
14569
14570 @cindex GDT
14571 @cindex LDT
14572 @cindex IDT
14573 @cindex segment descriptor tables
14574 @cindex descriptor tables display
14575 @item info dos gdt
14576 @itemx info dos ldt
14577 @itemx info dos idt
14578 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
14579 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
14580 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
14581 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
14582 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
14583 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
14584 rights.
14585
14586 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
14587 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
14588 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
14589 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
14590 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
14591
14592 @cindex garbled pointers
14593 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
14594 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
14595 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
14596 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
14597 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
14598 debugged program's data segment:
14599
14600 @smallexample
14601 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
14602 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
14603 @end smallexample
14604
14605 @noindent
14606 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
14607 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
14608
14609 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
14610 @item info dos pde
14611 @itemx info dos pte
14612 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
14613 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
14614 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
14615 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
14616 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
14617 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
14618 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
14619 that is currently in use.
14620
14621 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
14622 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
14623 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
14624 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
14625 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
14626 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
14627 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
14628
14629 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
14630 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
14631 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
14632 controller.
14633
14634 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
14635
14636 @cindex physical address from linear address
14637 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
14638 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
14639 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
14640 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
14641 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
14642 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
14643 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
14644
14645 @smallexample
14646 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
14647 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
14648 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
14649 @end smallexample
14650
14651 @noindent
14652 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
14653 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
14654 attributes of that page.
14655
14656 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
14657 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
14658 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
14659 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
14660 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
14661 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
14662
14663 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
14664 transfer buffer:
14665
14666 @smallexample
14667 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
14668 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
14669 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
14670 @end smallexample
14671
14672 @noindent
14673 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
14674 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
14675 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
14676 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
14677 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
14678
14679 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
14680 @end table
14681
14682 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
14683 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
14684 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
14685 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
14686
14687 @table @code
14688 @kindex set com1base
14689 @kindex set com1irq
14690 @kindex set com2base
14691 @kindex set com2irq
14692 @kindex set com3base
14693 @kindex set com3irq
14694 @kindex set com4base
14695 @kindex set com4irq
14696 @item set com1base @var{addr}
14697 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
14698 port.
14699
14700 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
14701 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
14702 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
14703
14704 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
14705 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
14706 other 3 COM ports.
14707
14708 @kindex show com1base
14709 @kindex show com1irq
14710 @kindex show com2base
14711 @kindex show com2irq
14712 @kindex show com3base
14713 @kindex show com3irq
14714 @kindex show com4base
14715 @kindex show com4irq
14716 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
14717 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
14718 lines used by the COM ports.
14719
14720 @item info serial
14721 @kindex info serial
14722 @cindex DOS serial port status
14723 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
14724 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
14725 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
14726 counts of various errors encountered so far.
14727 @end table
14728
14729
14730 @node Cygwin Native
14731 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
14732 @cindex MS Windows debugging
14733 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
14734 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
14735
14736 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
14737 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
14738 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
14739 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
14740 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
14741
14742 @table @code
14743 @kindex info w32
14744 @item info w32
14745 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
14746 information about the target system and important OS structures.
14747
14748 @item info w32 selector
14749 This command displays information returned by
14750 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
14751 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
14752 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
14753 Without argument, this command displays information
14754 about the six segment registers.
14755
14756 @kindex info dll
14757 @item info dll
14758 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14759
14760 @kindex dll-symbols
14761 @item dll-symbols
14762 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14763 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14764
14765 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14766 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14767 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14768 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14769 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14770 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14771 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14772 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14773 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14774 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14775 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14776
14777 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14778 @item show cygwin-exceptions
14779 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14780 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14781
14782 @kindex set new-console
14783 @item set new-console @var{mode}
14784 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14785 be started in a new console on next start.
14786 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14787 be started in the same console as the debugger.
14788
14789 @kindex show new-console
14790 @item show new-console
14791 Displays whether a new console is used
14792 when the debuggee is started.
14793
14794 @kindex set new-group
14795 @item set new-group @var{mode}
14796 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14797 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14798 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14799 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
14800
14801 @kindex show new-group
14802 @item show new-group
14803 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14804
14805 @kindex set debugevents
14806 @item set debugevents
14807 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14808 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14809 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14810 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14811 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14812
14813 @kindex set debugexec
14814 @item set debugexec
14815 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14816 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14817
14818 @kindex set debugexceptions
14819 @item set debugexceptions
14820 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14821 debuggee seen by the debugger.
14822
14823 @kindex set debugmemory
14824 @item set debugmemory
14825 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14826 and writes by the debugger.
14827
14828 @kindex set shell
14829 @item set shell
14830 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14831 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14832
14833 @kindex show shell
14834 @item show shell
14835 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14836
14837 @end table
14838
14839 @menu
14840 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14841 @end menu
14842
14843 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14844 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14845 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14846 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14847
14848 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14849 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14850 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14851 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14852 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14853 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14854 ``minimal symbols''.
14855
14856 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14857 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14858 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14859 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14860 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14861 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14862 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14863 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14864 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14865 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14866
14867 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14868
14869 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14870 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14871 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14872 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14873 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14874 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14875 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14876 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14877 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14878
14879 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14880 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14881 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14882 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14883 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14884 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14885
14886 @smallexample
14887 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14888 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14889
14890 Non-debugging symbols:
14891 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
14892 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14893 @end smallexample
14894
14895 @smallexample
14896 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
14897 All functions matching regular expression "!":
14898
14899 Non-debugging symbols:
14900 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
14901 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
14902 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14903 [etc...]
14904 @end smallexample
14905
14906 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14907
14908 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14909 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14910 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14911 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14912 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14913 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14914 a function within a DLL without a running program.
14915
14916 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14917 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14918 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14919 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14920 problem:
14921
14922 @smallexample
14923 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14924 $1 = 268572168
14925 @end smallexample
14926
14927 @smallexample
14928 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
14929 0x10021610: "\230y\""
14930 @end smallexample
14931
14932 And two possible solutions:
14933
14934 @smallexample
14935 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14936 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14937 @end smallexample
14938
14939 @smallexample
14940 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
14941 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14942 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
14943 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14944 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
14945 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14946 @end smallexample
14947
14948 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14949 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14950 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14951 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14952 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14953
14954 @smallexample
14955 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14956 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14957 @end smallexample
14958
14959 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14960 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14961 safe.
14962
14963 @node Hurd Native
14964 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14965 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14966
14967 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14968 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14969
14970 @table @code
14971 @item set signals
14972 @itemx set sigs
14973 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14974 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14975 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14976 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14977 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14978 @code{signals}.
14979
14980 @item show signals
14981 @itemx show sigs
14982 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14983 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14984 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14985
14986 @item set signal-thread
14987 @itemx set sigthread
14988 @kindex set signal-thread
14989 @kindex set sigthread
14990 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14991 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14992 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14993 signal-thread}.
14994
14995 @item show signal-thread
14996 @itemx show sigthread
14997 @kindex show signal-thread
14998 @kindex show sigthread
14999 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
15000 delivered a signal.
15001
15002 @item set stopped
15003 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15004 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
15005 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
15006 continued by delivering a signal to it.
15007
15008 @item show stopped
15009 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15010 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
15011 stopped.
15012
15013 @item set exceptions
15014 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15015 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
15016 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
15017 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
15018 trapping on.
15019
15020 @item show exceptions
15021 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15022 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
15023
15024 @item set task pause
15025 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
15026 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15027 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15028 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
15029 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
15030 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
15031 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
15032 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
15033 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
15034
15035 @item show task pause
15036 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
15037 Show the current state of task suspension.
15038
15039 @item set task detach-suspend-count
15040 @cindex task suspend count
15041 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15042 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
15043 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
15044
15045 @item show task detach-suspend-count
15046 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
15047
15048 @item set task exception-port
15049 @itemx set task excp
15050 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15051 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
15052 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
15053 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
15054
15055 @item set noninvasive
15056 @cindex noninvasive task options
15057 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
15058 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
15059 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
15060 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
15061
15062 @item info send-rights
15063 @itemx info receive-rights
15064 @itemx info port-rights
15065 @itemx info port-sets
15066 @itemx info dead-names
15067 @itemx info ports
15068 @itemx info psets
15069 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15070 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15071 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15072 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15073 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15074 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
15075 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
15076 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
15077 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
15078
15079 @item set thread pause
15080 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
15081 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15082 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15083 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
15084 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
15085 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
15086 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
15087 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
15088 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
15089 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
15090 only the current thread.
15091
15092 @item show thread pause
15093 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
15094 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
15095
15096 @item set thread run
15097 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15098
15099 @item show thread run
15100 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15101
15102 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
15103 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15104 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15105 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
15106 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
15107 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
15108 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
15109
15110 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
15111 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
15112 detaching.
15113
15114 @item set thread exception-port
15115 @itemx set thread excp
15116 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
15117 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
15118 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
15119
15120 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
15121 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
15122 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
15123 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
15124
15125 @item set thread default
15126 @itemx show thread default
15127 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15128 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
15129 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
15130 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
15131 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
15132 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
15133 the non-default commands.
15134 @end table
15135
15136
15137 @node Neutrino
15138 @subsection QNX Neutrino
15139 @cindex QNX Neutrino
15140
15141 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
15142 Neutrino target:
15143
15144 @table @code
15145 @item set debug nto-debug
15146 @kindex set debug nto-debug
15147 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
15148 Neutrino support.
15149
15150 @item show debug nto-debug
15151 @kindex show debug nto-debug
15152 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
15153 @end table
15154
15155
15156 @node Embedded OS
15157 @section Embedded Operating Systems
15158
15159 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
15160 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
15161 architectures.
15162
15163 @menu
15164 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15165 @end menu
15166
15167 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
15168 various real-time operating systems.
15169
15170 @node VxWorks
15171 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15172
15173 @cindex VxWorks
15174
15175 @table @code
15176
15177 @kindex target vxworks
15178 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
15179 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
15180 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
15181
15182 @end table
15183
15184 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
15185 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
15186
15187 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
15188 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
15189 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15190 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
15191 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
15192 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
15193 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
15194
15195 @table @code
15196 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
15197 @kindex vxworks-timeout
15198 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
15199 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15200 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
15201 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
15202 of a thin network line.
15203 @end table
15204
15205 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
15206 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
15207 procedures.
15208
15209 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
15210 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
15211 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
15212 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
15213 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
15214 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
15215 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
15216 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
15217 manual.
15218 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
15219
15220 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
15221 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15222 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
15223 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
15224
15225 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15226
15227 @smallexample
15228 (vxgdb)
15229 @end smallexample
15230
15231 @menu
15232 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
15233 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
15234 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
15235 @end menu
15236
15237 @node VxWorks Connection
15238 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
15239
15240 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
15241 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
15242
15243 @smallexample
15244 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
15245 @end smallexample
15246
15247 @need 750
15248 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15249
15250 @smallexample
15251 Attaching remote machine across net...
15252 Connected to tt.
15253 @end smallexample
15254
15255 @need 1000
15256 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
15257 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
15258 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
15259 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
15260 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
15261
15262 @smallexample
15263 prog.o: No such file or directory.
15264 @end smallexample
15265
15266 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
15267 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
15268 command again.
15269
15270 @node VxWorks Download
15271 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
15272
15273 @cindex download to VxWorks
15274 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
15275 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
15276 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
15277 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
15278 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
15279 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
15280 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
15281 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
15282 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
15283 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
15284 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
15285 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
15286 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
15287 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
15288 program, type this on VxWorks:
15289
15290 @smallexample
15291 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
15292 @end smallexample
15293
15294 @noindent
15295 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15296
15297 @smallexample
15298 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
15299 (vxgdb) load prog.o
15300 @end smallexample
15301
15302 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
15303
15304 @smallexample
15305 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
15306 @end smallexample
15307
15308 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
15309 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
15310 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
15311 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
15312 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
15313 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
15314 table.)
15315
15316 @node VxWorks Attach
15317 @subsubsection Running Tasks
15318
15319 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
15320 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
15321 follows:
15322
15323 @smallexample
15324 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
15325 @end smallexample
15326
15327 @noindent
15328 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
15329 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
15330 the time of attachment.
15331
15332 @node Embedded Processors
15333 @section Embedded Processors
15334
15335 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
15336 configurations.
15337
15338 @cindex send command to simulator
15339 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
15340 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
15341
15342 @table @code
15343 @item sim @var{command}
15344 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
15345 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
15346 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
15347 acceptable commands.
15348 @end table
15349
15350
15351 @menu
15352 * ARM:: ARM RDI
15353 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
15354 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
15355 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
15356 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
15357 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
15358 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
15359 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
15360 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
15361 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
15362 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
15363 * CRIS:: CRIS
15364 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
15365 @end menu
15366
15367 @node ARM
15368 @subsection ARM
15369 @cindex ARM RDI
15370
15371 @table @code
15372 @kindex target rdi
15373 @item target rdi @var{dev}
15374 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
15375 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
15376 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
15377
15378 @kindex target rdp
15379 @item target rdp @var{dev}
15380 ARM Demon monitor.
15381
15382 @end table
15383
15384 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
15385
15386 @table @code
15387 @item set arm disassembler
15388 @kindex set arm
15389 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
15390 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
15391
15392 @item show arm disassembler
15393 @kindex show arm
15394 Show the current disassembly style.
15395
15396 @item set arm apcs32
15397 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
15398 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
15399
15400 @item show arm apcs32
15401 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15402
15403 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15404 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15405 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15406
15407 @table @code
15408 @item auto
15409 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15410 @item softfpa
15411 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15412 processors.
15413 @item fpa
15414 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15415 @item softvfp
15416 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15417 @item vfp
15418 VFP co-processor.
15419 @end table
15420
15421 @item show arm fpu
15422 Show the current type of the FPU.
15423
15424 @item set arm abi
15425 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
15426
15427 @item show arm abi
15428 Show the currently used ABI.
15429
15430 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15431 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
15432 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
15433 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
15434 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
15435 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
15436 register).
15437
15438 @item show arm fallback-mode
15439 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
15440
15441 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15442 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
15443 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
15444 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
15445 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
15446
15447 @item show arm force-mode
15448 Show the current forced instruction mode.
15449
15450 @item set debug arm
15451 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
15452 target support subsystem.
15453
15454 @item show debug arm
15455 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
15456 @end table
15457
15458 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
15459 using the RDI interface:
15460
15461 @table @code
15462 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15463 @kindex rdilogfile
15464 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
15465 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
15466 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
15467 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
15468 @file{rdi.log}.
15469
15470 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
15471 @kindex rdilogenable
15472 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
15473 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
15474 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
15475 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
15476 are logged to a file.
15477
15478 @item set rdiromatzero
15479 @kindex set rdiromatzero
15480 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
15481 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
15482 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
15483 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
15484 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
15485
15486 @item show rdiromatzero
15487 @kindex show rdiromatzero
15488 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
15489
15490 @item set rdiheartbeat
15491 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
15492 @cindex RDI heartbeat
15493 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
15494 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
15495 well as the Angel monitor.
15496
15497 @item show rdiheartbeat
15498 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
15499 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
15500 @end table
15501
15502
15503 @node M32R/D
15504 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
15505
15506 @table @code
15507 @kindex target m32r
15508 @item target m32r @var{dev}
15509 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
15510
15511 @kindex target m32rsdi
15512 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
15513 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
15514 @end table
15515
15516 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
15517
15518 @table @code
15519 @item set download-path @var{path}
15520 @kindex set download-path
15521 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
15522 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15523
15524 @item show download-path
15525 @kindex show download-path
15526 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
15527
15528 @item set board-address @var{addr}
15529 @kindex set board-address
15530 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
15531 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
15532
15533 @item show board-address
15534 @kindex show board-address
15535 Show the current IP address of the target board.
15536
15537 @item set server-address @var{addr}
15538 @kindex set server-address
15539 @cindex download server address (M32R)
15540 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
15541 host machine.
15542
15543 @item show server-address
15544 @kindex show server-address
15545 Display the IP address of the download server.
15546
15547 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15548 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
15549 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
15550 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
15551 executable file is uploaded.
15552
15553 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15554 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
15555 Test the @code{upload} command.
15556 @end table
15557
15558 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
15559
15560 @table @code
15561 @item sdireset
15562 @kindex sdireset
15563 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
15564 This command resets the SDI connection.
15565
15566 @item sdistatus
15567 @kindex sdistatus
15568 This command shows the SDI connection status.
15569
15570 @item debug_chaos
15571 @kindex debug_chaos
15572 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
15573 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
15574
15575 @item use_debug_dma
15576 @kindex use_debug_dma
15577 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
15578
15579 @item use_mon_code
15580 @kindex use_mon_code
15581 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
15582
15583 @item use_ib_break
15584 @kindex use_ib_break
15585 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
15586
15587 @item use_dbt_break
15588 @kindex use_dbt_break
15589 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
15590 @end table
15591
15592 @node M68K
15593 @subsection M68k
15594
15595 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
15596 target command for the following ROM monitor.
15597
15598 @table @code
15599
15600 @kindex target dbug
15601 @item target dbug @var{dev}
15602 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
15603
15604 @end table
15605
15606 @node MIPS Embedded
15607 @subsection MIPS Embedded
15608
15609 @cindex MIPS boards
15610 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
15611 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
15612 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
15613
15614 @need 1000
15615 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
15616
15617 @table @code
15618 @item target mips @var{port}
15619 @kindex target mips @var{port}
15620 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
15621 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
15622 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
15623 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
15624 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
15625 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
15626
15627 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
15628 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
15629 debugger:
15630
15631 @smallexample
15632 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
15633 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
15634 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
15635 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
15636 (@value{GDBP}) run
15637 @end smallexample
15638
15639 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
15640 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
15641 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
15642 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
15643 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15644
15645 @item target pmon @var{port}
15646 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
15647 PMON ROM monitor.
15648
15649 @item target ddb @var{port}
15650 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
15651 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
15652
15653 @item target lsi @var{port}
15654 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
15655 LSI variant of PMON.
15656
15657 @kindex target r3900
15658 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
15659 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
15660
15661 @kindex target array
15662 @item target array @var{dev}
15663 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
15664
15665 @end table
15666
15667
15668 @noindent
15669 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
15670
15671 @table @code
15672 @item set mipsfpu double
15673 @itemx set mipsfpu single
15674 @itemx set mipsfpu none
15675 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
15676 @itemx show mipsfpu
15677 @kindex set mipsfpu
15678 @kindex show mipsfpu
15679 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
15680 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
15681 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
15682 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
15683 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
15684 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
15685 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
15686 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
15687 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
15688 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
15689 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
15690 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
15691 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
15692
15693 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
15694 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
15695 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
15696
15697 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
15698 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
15699
15700 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
15701 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
15702 @itemx show timeout
15703 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
15704 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
15705 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
15706 @kindex set timeout
15707 @kindex show timeout
15708 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
15709 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
15710 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
15711 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
15712 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
15713 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
15714 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
15715 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
15716 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
15717 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
15718
15719 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
15720 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
15721 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
15722 to run before stopping.
15723
15724 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
15725 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15726 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
15727 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
15728 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
15729 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
15730
15731 @item show syn-garbage-limit
15732 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
15733 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
15734 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
15735
15736 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
15737 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15738 @cindex remote monitor prompt
15739 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
15740 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
15741 @table @asis
15742 @item pmon target
15743 @samp{PMON}
15744 @item ddb target
15745 @samp{NEC010}
15746 @item lsi target
15747 @samp{PMON>}
15748 @end table
15749
15750 @item show monitor-prompt
15751 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
15752 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
15753 remote monitor.
15754
15755 @item set monitor-warnings
15756 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15757 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
15758 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
15759 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
15760 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
15761
15762 @item show monitor-warnings
15763 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
15764 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
15765
15766 @item pmon @var{command}
15767 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
15768 @cindex send PMON command
15769 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
15770 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
15771 @end table
15772
15773 @node OpenRISC 1000
15774 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
15775 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
15776
15777 @cindex or1k boards
15778 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15779 about platform and commands.
15780
15781 @table @code
15782
15783 @kindex target jtag
15784 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15785
15786 Connects to remote JTAG server.
15787 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15788 connected via parallel port to the board.
15789
15790 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15791
15792 @kindex or1ksim
15793 @item or1ksim @var{command}
15794 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15795 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15796
15797 @kindex info or1k spr
15798 @item info or1k spr
15799 Displays spr groups.
15800
15801 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
15802 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15803 Displays register names in selected group.
15804
15805 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15806 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15807 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15808 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15809 Shows information about specified spr register.
15810
15811 @kindex spr
15812 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15813 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15814 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15815 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15816 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15817 @end table
15818
15819 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15820 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15821 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15822 triggers can be set using:
15823 @table @code
15824 @item $LEA/$LDATA
15825 Load effective address/data
15826 @item $SEA/$SDATA
15827 Store effective address/data
15828 @item $AEA/$ADATA
15829 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15830 @item $FETCH
15831 Fetch data
15832 @end table
15833
15834 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15835 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15836
15837 @code{htrace} commands:
15838 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15839 @table @code
15840 @kindex hwatch
15841 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
15842 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15843 or Data. For example:
15844
15845 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15846
15847 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15848
15849 @kindex htrace
15850 @item htrace info
15851 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15852
15853 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15854 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15855
15856 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15857 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15858
15859 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15860 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15861
15862 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15863 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15864 triggered.
15865
15866 @item htrace enable
15867 @itemx htrace disable
15868 Enables/disables the HW trace.
15869
15870 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15871 Clears currently recorded trace data.
15872
15873 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15874 will be written there.
15875
15876 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15877 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15878
15879 @item htrace mode continuous
15880 Set continuous trace mode.
15881
15882 @item htrace mode suspend
15883 Set suspend trace mode.
15884
15885 @end table
15886
15887 @node PowerPC Embedded
15888 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
15889
15890 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15891
15892 @table @code
15893 @kindex set powerpc
15894 @item set powerpc soft-float
15895 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
15896 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15897 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15898 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15899
15900 @item set powerpc vector-abi
15901 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15902 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15903 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15904 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15905 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15906 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15907 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15908
15909 @kindex target dink32
15910 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
15911 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15912
15913 @kindex target ppcbug
15914 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15915 @kindex target ppcbug1
15916 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15917 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15918
15919 @kindex target sds
15920 @item target sds @var{dev}
15921 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15922 @end table
15923
15924 @cindex SDS protocol
15925 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15926 by @value{GDBN}:
15927
15928 @table @code
15929 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15930 @kindex set sdstimeout
15931 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15932 default is 2 seconds.
15933
15934 @item show sdstimeout
15935 @kindex show sdstimeout
15936 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15937
15938 @item sds @var{command}
15939 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15940 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15941 @end table
15942
15943
15944 @node PA
15945 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15946
15947 @table @code
15948
15949 @kindex target op50n
15950 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15951 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15952
15953 @kindex target w89k
15954 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15955 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15956
15957 @end table
15958
15959 @node Sparclet
15960 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15961
15962 @cindex Sparclet
15963
15964 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15965 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15966 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15967 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15968 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15969
15970 @table @code
15971 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15972 @kindex remotetimeout
15973 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15974 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15975 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15976 @end table
15977
15978 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15979 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15980 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15981 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15982 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15983
15984 @smallexample
15985 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15986 @end smallexample
15987
15988 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15989
15990 @smallexample
15991 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15992 @end smallexample
15993
15994 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15995 Once you have set
15996 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15997 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15998 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15999
16000 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16001
16002 @smallexample
16003 (gdbslet)
16004 @end smallexample
16005
16006 @menu
16007 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
16008 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
16009 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
16010 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
16011 @end menu
16012
16013 @node Sparclet File
16014 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
16015
16016 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
16017
16018 @smallexample
16019 (gdbslet) file prog
16020 @end smallexample
16021
16022 @need 1000
16023 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
16024 @value{GDBN} locates
16025 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
16026 path.
16027 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
16028 files will be searched as well.
16029 @value{GDBN} locates
16030 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
16031 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
16032 If it fails
16033 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
16034
16035 @smallexample
16036 prog: No such file or directory.
16037 @end smallexample
16038
16039 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
16040 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
16041 @code{target} command again.
16042
16043 @node Sparclet Connection
16044 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
16045
16046 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
16047 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
16048
16049 @smallexample
16050 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
16051 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
16052 main () at ../prog.c:3
16053 @end smallexample
16054
16055 @need 750
16056 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16057
16058 @smallexample
16059 Connected to ttya.
16060 @end smallexample
16061
16062 @node Sparclet Download
16063 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
16064
16065 @cindex download to Sparclet
16066 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
16067 you can use the @value{GDBN}
16068 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
16069 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
16070 command.
16071 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
16072 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
16073 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
16074 of each of the file's sections.
16075 For instance, if the program
16076 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
16077 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16078
16079 @smallexample
16080 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
16081 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
16082 @end smallexample
16083
16084 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
16085 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
16086 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
16087
16088 @node Sparclet Execution
16089 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
16090
16091 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
16092 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
16093 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
16094 manual for the list of commands.
16095
16096 @smallexample
16097 (gdbslet) b main
16098 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
16099 (gdbslet) run
16100 Starting program: prog
16101 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
16102 3 char *symarg = 0;
16103 (gdbslet) step
16104 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
16105 (gdbslet)
16106 @end smallexample
16107
16108 @node Sparclite
16109 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
16110
16111 @table @code
16112
16113 @kindex target sparclite
16114 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
16115 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
16116 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
16117 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
16118 remote protocol.
16119
16120 @end table
16121
16122 @node Z8000
16123 @subsection Zilog Z8000
16124
16125 @cindex Z8000
16126 @cindex simulator, Z8000
16127 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
16128
16129 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
16130 a Z8000 simulator.
16131
16132 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
16133 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
16134 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
16135 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
16136
16137 @table @code
16138 @item target sim @var{args}
16139 @kindex sim
16140 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
16141 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
16142 options, specify them via @var{args}.
16143 @end table
16144
16145 @noindent
16146 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
16147 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
16148 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
16149 to run your program, and so on.
16150
16151 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
16152 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
16153 additional items of information as specially named registers:
16154
16155 @table @code
16156
16157 @item cycles
16158 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
16159
16160 @item insts
16161 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
16162
16163 @item time
16164 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
16165
16166 @end table
16167
16168 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
16169 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
16170 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
16171 simulated clock ticks.
16172
16173 @node AVR
16174 @subsection Atmel AVR
16175 @cindex AVR
16176
16177 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
16178 following AVR-specific commands:
16179
16180 @table @code
16181 @item info io_registers
16182 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
16183 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
16184 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
16185 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
16186 @end table
16187
16188 @node CRIS
16189 @subsection CRIS
16190 @cindex CRIS
16191
16192 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
16193 following CRIS-specific commands:
16194
16195 @table @code
16196 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
16197 @cindex CRIS version
16198 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
16199 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
16200 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
16201
16202 @item show cris-version
16203 Show the current CRIS version.
16204
16205 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
16206 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
16207 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
16208 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
16209 @code{R59}.
16210
16211 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
16212 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
16213
16214 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
16215 @cindex CRIS mode
16216 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
16217 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
16218 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
16219
16220 @item show cris-mode
16221 Show the current CRIS mode.
16222 @end table
16223
16224 @node Super-H
16225 @subsection Renesas Super-H
16226 @cindex Super-H
16227
16228 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
16229 commands:
16230
16231 @table @code
16232 @item regs
16233 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
16234 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
16235
16236 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
16237 @kindex set sh calling-convention
16238 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
16239 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
16240 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
16241 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
16242 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
16243 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
16244 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
16245 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
16246 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
16247 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
16248
16249 @item show sh calling-convention
16250 @kindex show sh calling-convention
16251 Show the current calling convention setting.
16252
16253 @end table
16254
16255
16256 @node Architectures
16257 @section Architectures
16258
16259 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
16260 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
16261
16262 @menu
16263 * i386::
16264 * A29K::
16265 * Alpha::
16266 * MIPS::
16267 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
16268 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16269 * PowerPC::
16270 @end menu
16271
16272 @node i386
16273 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
16274
16275 @table @code
16276 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
16277 @kindex set struct-convention
16278 @cindex struct return convention
16279 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
16280 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
16281 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
16282 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
16283 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
16284 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
16285 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
16286 be returned in a register.
16287
16288 @item show struct-convention
16289 @kindex show struct-convention
16290 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
16291 from functions.
16292 @end table
16293
16294 @node A29K
16295 @subsection A29K
16296
16297 @table @code
16298
16299 @kindex set rstack_high_address
16300 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
16301 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
16302 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
16303 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
16304 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
16305 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
16306 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
16307 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
16308 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
16309 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
16310 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
16311 hexadecimal.
16312
16313 @kindex show rstack_high_address
16314 @item show rstack_high_address
16315 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
16316 processors.
16317
16318 @end table
16319
16320 @node Alpha
16321 @subsection Alpha
16322
16323 See the following section.
16324
16325 @node MIPS
16326 @subsection MIPS
16327
16328 @cindex stack on Alpha
16329 @cindex stack on MIPS
16330 @cindex Alpha stack
16331 @cindex MIPS stack
16332 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
16333 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
16334 find the beginning of a function.
16335
16336 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
16337 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
16338 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
16339 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
16340 commands:
16341
16342 @table @code
16343 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
16344 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
16345 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
16346 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
16347 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
16348 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
16349 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
16350 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
16351
16352 @item show heuristic-fence-post
16353 Display the current limit.
16354 @end table
16355
16356 @noindent
16357 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
16358 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
16359
16360 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
16361 programs:
16362
16363 @table @code
16364 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
16365 @kindex set mips abi
16366 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
16367 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
16368 values of @var{arg} are:
16369
16370 @table @samp
16371 @item auto
16372 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
16373 default).
16374 @item o32
16375 @item o64
16376 @item n32
16377 @item n64
16378 @item eabi32
16379 @item eabi64
16380 @item auto
16381 @end table
16382
16383 @item show mips abi
16384 @kindex show mips abi
16385 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
16386
16387 @item set mipsfpu
16388 @itemx show mipsfpu
16389 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
16390
16391 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
16392 @kindex set mips mask-address
16393 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
16394 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
16395 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
16396 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
16397 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
16398
16399 @item show mips mask-address
16400 @kindex show mips mask-address
16401 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16402 not.
16403
16404 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16405 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16406 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16407 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16408 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16409 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16410
16411 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16412 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16413 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16414
16415 @item set debug mips
16416 @kindex set debug mips
16417 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
16418 target code in @value{GDBN}.
16419
16420 @item show debug mips
16421 @kindex show debug mips
16422 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
16423 @end table
16424
16425
16426 @node HPPA
16427 @subsection HPPA
16428 @cindex HPPA support
16429
16430 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
16431 following special commands:
16432
16433 @table @code
16434 @item set debug hppa
16435 @kindex set debug hppa
16436 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
16437 messages are to be displayed.
16438
16439 @item show debug hppa
16440 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
16441
16442 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
16443 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
16444 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
16445 given @var{address}.
16446
16447 @end table
16448
16449
16450 @node SPU
16451 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16452 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
16453 @cindex SPU
16454
16455 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
16456 it provides the following special commands:
16457
16458 @table @code
16459 @item info spu event
16460 @kindex info spu
16461 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
16462 and pending event status.
16463
16464 @item info spu signal
16465 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
16466 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
16467 notification channels.
16468
16469 @item info spu mailbox
16470 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
16471 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
16472 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
16473
16474 @item info spu dma
16475 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16476 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16477 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16478
16479 @item info spu proxydma
16480 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16481 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16482 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16483
16484 @end table
16485
16486 @node PowerPC
16487 @subsection PowerPC
16488 @cindex PowerPC architecture
16489
16490 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
16491 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
16492 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
16493 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
16494 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
16495
16496 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
16497 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
16498 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
16499
16500 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
16501 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
16502
16503
16504 @node Controlling GDB
16505 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
16506
16507 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
16508 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
16509 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
16510 described here.
16511
16512 @menu
16513 * Prompt:: Prompt
16514 * Editing:: Command editing
16515 * Command History:: Command history
16516 * Screen Size:: Screen size
16517 * Numbers:: Numbers
16518 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
16519 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
16520 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
16521 @end menu
16522
16523 @node Prompt
16524 @section Prompt
16525
16526 @cindex prompt
16527
16528 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
16529 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
16530 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
16531 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
16532 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
16533 which one you are talking to.
16534
16535 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
16536 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
16537 or a prompt that does not.
16538
16539 @table @code
16540 @kindex set prompt
16541 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
16542 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
16543
16544 @kindex show prompt
16545 @item show prompt
16546 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
16547 @end table
16548
16549 @node Editing
16550 @section Command Editing
16551 @cindex readline
16552 @cindex command line editing
16553
16554 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
16555 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
16556 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
16557 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
16558 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
16559 debugging sessions.
16560
16561 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
16562 command @code{set}.
16563
16564 @table @code
16565 @kindex set editing
16566 @cindex editing
16567 @item set editing
16568 @itemx set editing on
16569 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
16570
16571 @item set editing off
16572 Disable command line editing.
16573
16574 @kindex show editing
16575 @item show editing
16576 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
16577 @end table
16578
16579 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
16580 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
16581 encouraged to read that chapter.
16582
16583 @node Command History
16584 @section Command History
16585 @cindex command history
16586
16587 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
16588 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
16589 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
16590 history facility.
16591
16592 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
16593 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
16594 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
16595
16596 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
16597 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
16598 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
16599 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
16600 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
16601 pressed on a line by itself.
16602
16603 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
16604 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
16605 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
16606 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
16607
16608 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
16609 history.
16610
16611 @table @code
16612 @cindex history substitution
16613 @cindex history file
16614 @kindex set history filename
16615 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
16616 @item set history filename @var{fname}
16617 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
16618 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
16619 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
16620 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
16621 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
16622 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
16623 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
16624 is not set.
16625
16626 @cindex save command history
16627 @kindex set history save
16628 @item set history save
16629 @itemx set history save on
16630 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
16631 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
16632
16633 @item set history save off
16634 Stop recording command history in a file.
16635
16636 @cindex history size
16637 @kindex set history size
16638 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
16639 @item set history size @var{size}
16640 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
16641 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
16642 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
16643 @end table
16644
16645 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
16646 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
16647
16648 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
16649 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
16650 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
16651 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
16652 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
16653 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
16654 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
16655 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
16656
16657 The commands to control history expansion are:
16658
16659 @table @code
16660 @item set history expansion on
16661 @itemx set history expansion
16662 @kindex set history expansion
16663 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
16664
16665 @item set history expansion off
16666 Disable history expansion.
16667
16668 @c @group
16669 @kindex show history
16670 @item show history
16671 @itemx show history filename
16672 @itemx show history save
16673 @itemx show history size
16674 @itemx show history expansion
16675 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
16676 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
16677 @c @end group
16678 @end table
16679
16680 @table @code
16681 @kindex show commands
16682 @cindex show last commands
16683 @cindex display command history
16684 @item show commands
16685 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
16686
16687 @item show commands @var{n}
16688 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
16689
16690 @item show commands +
16691 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
16692 @end table
16693
16694 @node Screen Size
16695 @section Screen Size
16696 @cindex size of screen
16697 @cindex pauses in output
16698
16699 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
16700 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
16701 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
16702 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
16703 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
16704 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
16705 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
16706 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
16707
16708 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
16709 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
16710 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
16711 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
16712 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
16713 width} commands:
16714
16715 @table @code
16716 @kindex set height
16717 @kindex set width
16718 @kindex show width
16719 @kindex show height
16720 @item set height @var{lpp}
16721 @itemx show height
16722 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
16723 @itemx show width
16724 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
16725 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
16726 commands display the current settings.
16727
16728 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
16729 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
16730 file or to an editor buffer.
16731
16732 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
16733 from wrapping its output.
16734
16735 @item set pagination on
16736 @itemx set pagination off
16737 @kindex set pagination
16738 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
16739 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
16740
16741 @item show pagination
16742 @kindex show pagination
16743 Show the current pagination mode.
16744 @end table
16745
16746 @node Numbers
16747 @section Numbers
16748 @cindex number representation
16749 @cindex entering numbers
16750
16751 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
16752 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
16753 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
16754 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
16755 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
16756 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
16757 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
16758 both input and output with the commands described below.
16759
16760 @table @code
16761 @kindex set input-radix
16762 @item set input-radix @var{base}
16763 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
16764 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16765 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
16766 example, any of
16767
16768 @smallexample
16769 set input-radix 012
16770 set input-radix 10.
16771 set input-radix 0xa
16772 @end smallexample
16773
16774 @noindent
16775 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
16776 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
16777 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
16778 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
16779 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
16780 change the radix.
16781
16782 @kindex set output-radix
16783 @item set output-radix @var{base}
16784 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
16785 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
16786 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
16787
16788 @kindex show input-radix
16789 @item show input-radix
16790 Display the current default base for numeric input.
16791
16792 @kindex show output-radix
16793 @item show output-radix
16794 Display the current default base for numeric display.
16795
16796 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
16797 @itemx show radix
16798 @kindex set radix
16799 @kindex show radix
16800 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
16801 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
16802 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
16803 default value of 10.
16804
16805 @end table
16806
16807 @node ABI
16808 @section Configuring the Current ABI
16809
16810 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16811 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16812 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16813 current ABI.
16814
16815 @cindex OS ABI
16816 @kindex set osabi
16817 @kindex show osabi
16818
16819 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16820 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16821 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16822 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16823 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16824 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16825 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16826 platform provides.
16827
16828 @table @code
16829 @item show osabi
16830 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16831
16832 @item set osabi
16833 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16834
16835 @item set osabi @var{abi}
16836 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16837 @end table
16838
16839 @cindex float promotion
16840
16841 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16842 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16843 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16844 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16845 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16846 @code{double} and then passed.
16847
16848 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16849 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16850 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16851
16852 @table @code
16853 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16854 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16855 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16856 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16857 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16858
16859 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16860 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16861 functions.
16862
16863 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16864 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16865 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16866 @end table
16867
16868 @kindex set cp-abi
16869 @kindex show cp-abi
16870 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16871 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16872 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16873 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16874 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16875 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16876 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16877 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16878 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16879 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16880 ``auto''.
16881
16882 @table @code
16883 @item show cp-abi
16884 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16885
16886 @item set cp-abi
16887 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16888
16889 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16890 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16891 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16892 @end table
16893
16894 @node Messages/Warnings
16895 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
16896
16897 @cindex verbose operation
16898 @cindex optional warnings
16899 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16900 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16901 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16902 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16903
16904 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16905 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16906 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16907
16908 @table @code
16909 @kindex set verbose
16910 @item set verbose on
16911 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16912
16913 @item set verbose off
16914 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16915
16916 @kindex show verbose
16917 @item show verbose
16918 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16919 @end table
16920
16921 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16922 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16923 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16924 Symbol Files}).
16925
16926 @table @code
16927
16928 @kindex set complaints
16929 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16930 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16931 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16932 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16933 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16934
16935 @kindex show complaints
16936 @item show complaints
16937 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16938
16939 @end table
16940
16941 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16942 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16943 you try to run a program which is already running:
16944
16945 @smallexample
16946 (@value{GDBP}) run
16947 The program being debugged has been started already.
16948 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16949 @end smallexample
16950
16951 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16952 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16953
16954 @table @code
16955
16956 @kindex set confirm
16957 @cindex flinching
16958 @cindex confirmation
16959 @cindex stupid questions
16960 @item set confirm off
16961 Disables confirmation requests.
16962
16963 @item set confirm on
16964 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16965
16966 @kindex show confirm
16967 @item show confirm
16968 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16969
16970 @end table
16971
16972 @cindex command tracing
16973 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16974 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16975 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16976 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16977
16978 @table @code
16979 @kindex set trace-commands
16980 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16981 @item set trace-commands on
16982 Enable command tracing.
16983 @item set trace-commands off
16984 Disable command tracing.
16985 @item show trace-commands
16986 Display the current state of command tracing.
16987 @end table
16988
16989 @node Debugging Output
16990 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16991 @cindex optional debugging messages
16992
16993 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16994 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16995 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16996 section documents those commands.
16997
16998 @table @code
16999 @kindex set exec-done-display
17000 @item set exec-done-display
17001 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
17002 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
17003 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
17004 @kindex show exec-done-display
17005 @item show exec-done-display
17006 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
17007 notification.
17008 @kindex set debug
17009 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
17010 @cindex architecture debugging info
17011 @item set debug arch
17012 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
17013 @kindex show debug
17014 @item show debug arch
17015 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
17016 @item set debug aix-thread
17017 @cindex AIX threads
17018 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
17019 module.
17020 @item show debug aix-thread
17021 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
17022 @item set debug dwarf2-die
17023 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
17024 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
17025 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
17026 A value of zero turns off the display.
17027 @item show debug dwarf2-die
17028 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
17029 @item set debug displaced
17030 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
17031 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
17032 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
17033 @item show debug displaced
17034 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
17035 related to displaced stepping.
17036 @item set debug event
17037 @cindex event debugging info
17038 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
17039 default is off.
17040 @item show debug event
17041 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
17042 info.
17043 @item set debug expression
17044 @cindex expression debugging info
17045 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
17046 expression parsing. The default is off.
17047 @item show debug expression
17048 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
17049 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
17050 @item set debug frame
17051 @cindex frame debugging info
17052 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
17053 default is off.
17054 @item show debug frame
17055 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
17056 info.
17057 @item set debug infrun
17058 @cindex inferior debugging info
17059 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
17060 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
17061 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
17062 @item show debug infrun
17063 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
17064 @item set debug lin-lwp
17065 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
17066 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17067 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
17068 @item show debug lin-lwp
17069 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
17070 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
17071 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
17072 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17073 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
17074 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
17075 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
17076 @item set debug observer
17077 @cindex observer debugging info
17078 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
17079 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
17080 @item show debug observer
17081 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
17082 @item set debug overload
17083 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
17084 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
17085 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
17086 is off.
17087 @item show debug overload
17088 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
17089 debugging info.
17090 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
17091 @cindex serial connections, debugging
17092 @cindex debug remote protocol
17093 @cindex remote protocol debugging
17094 @cindex display remote packets
17095 @item set debug remote
17096 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
17097 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
17098 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
17099 @item show debug remote
17100 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
17101 @item set debug serial
17102 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
17103 default is off.
17104 @item show debug serial
17105 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
17106 info.
17107 @item set debug solib-frv
17108 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
17109 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
17110 @item show debug solib-frv
17111 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
17112 messages.
17113 @item set debug target
17114 @cindex target debugging info
17115 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
17116 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
17117 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
17118 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
17119 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
17120 @item show debug target
17121 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
17122 info.
17123 @item set debug timestamp
17124 @cindex timestampping debugging info
17125 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
17126 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
17127 message.
17128 @item show debug timestamp
17129 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
17130 debugging info.
17131 @item set debugvarobj
17132 @cindex variable object debugging info
17133 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
17134 info. The default is off.
17135 @item show debugvarobj
17136 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
17137 debugging info.
17138 @item set debug xml
17139 @cindex XML parser debugging
17140 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
17141 @item show debug xml
17142 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
17143 @end table
17144
17145 @node Extending GDB
17146 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
17147 @cindex extending GDB
17148
17149 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
17150 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
17151 Python scripting language.
17152
17153 @menu
17154 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
17155 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17156 @end menu
17157
17158 @node Sequences
17159 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
17160
17161 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
17162 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
17163 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
17164 files.
17165
17166 @menu
17167 * Define:: How to define your own commands
17168 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
17169 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
17170 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
17171 @end menu
17172
17173 @node Define
17174 @subsection User-defined Commands
17175
17176 @cindex user-defined command
17177 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
17178 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
17179 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
17180 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
17181 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
17182 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
17183
17184 @smallexample
17185 define adder
17186 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17187 end
17188 @end smallexample
17189
17190 @noindent
17191 To execute the command use:
17192
17193 @smallexample
17194 adder 1 2 3
17195 @end smallexample
17196
17197 @noindent
17198 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
17199 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
17200 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
17201 functions calls.
17202
17203 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
17204 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
17205 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
17206 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
17207
17208 @smallexample
17209 define adder
17210 if $argc == 2
17211 print $arg0 + $arg1
17212 end
17213 if $argc == 3
17214 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17215 end
17216 end
17217 @end smallexample
17218
17219 @table @code
17220
17221 @kindex define
17222 @item define @var{commandname}
17223 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
17224 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
17225
17226 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
17227 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
17228 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17229
17230 @kindex document
17231 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
17232 @item document @var{commandname}
17233 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
17234 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
17235 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
17236 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
17237 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
17238 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
17239
17240 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
17241 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
17242 does not change the documentation.
17243
17244 @kindex dont-repeat
17245 @cindex don't repeat command
17246 @item dont-repeat
17247 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
17248 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
17249 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
17250
17251 @kindex help user-defined
17252 @item help user-defined
17253 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
17254 (if any) for each.
17255
17256 @kindex show user
17257 @item show user
17258 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
17259 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
17260 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
17261 definitions for all user-defined commands.
17262
17263 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
17264 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
17265 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
17266 @item show max-user-call-depth
17267 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
17268 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
17269 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
17270 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
17271 @end table
17272
17273 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
17274 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
17275
17276 When user-defined commands are executed, the
17277 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
17278 stops execution of the user-defined command.
17279
17280 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
17281 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
17282 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
17283 messages when used in a user-defined command.
17284
17285 @node Hooks
17286 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
17287 @cindex command hooks
17288 @cindex hooks, for commands
17289 @cindex hooks, pre-command
17290
17291 @kindex hook
17292 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
17293 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
17294 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
17295 before that command.
17296
17297 @cindex hooks, post-command
17298 @kindex hookpost
17299 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
17300 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
17301 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
17302 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
17303 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
17304
17305 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
17306 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
17307
17308 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
17309 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
17310
17311 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
17312 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
17313 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
17314 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
17315 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
17316
17317 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
17318 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
17319 you could define:
17320
17321 @smallexample
17322 define hook-stop
17323 handle SIGALRM nopass
17324 end
17325
17326 define hook-run
17327 handle SIGALRM pass
17328 end
17329
17330 define hook-continue
17331 handle SIGALRM pass
17332 end
17333 @end smallexample
17334
17335 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
17336 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
17337 you could define:
17338
17339 @smallexample
17340 define hook-echo
17341 echo <<<---
17342 end
17343
17344 define hookpost-echo
17345 echo --->>>\n
17346 end
17347
17348 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
17349 <<<---Hello World--->>>
17350 (@value{GDBP})
17351
17352 @end smallexample
17353
17354 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
17355 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
17356 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
17357 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
17358 @c or not?
17359 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
17360 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
17361 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
17362
17363 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
17364 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
17365
17366 @node Command Files
17367 @subsection Command Files
17368
17369 @cindex command files
17370 @cindex scripting commands
17371 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
17372 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
17373 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
17374 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
17375 terminal.
17376
17377 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
17378 command:
17379
17380 @table @code
17381 @kindex source
17382 @cindex execute commands from a file
17383 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
17384 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
17385 @end table
17386
17387 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
17388 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
17389 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
17390 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
17391 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
17392
17393 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
17394 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
17395
17396 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
17397 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
17398 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
17399
17400 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
17401 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
17402 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
17403 when called from command files.
17404
17405 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
17406 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
17407 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
17408 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
17409 the next command.
17410
17411 @smallexample
17412 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
17413 @end smallexample
17414
17415 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
17416 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
17417 would be directed to @file{log}.
17418
17419 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
17420 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
17421 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
17422 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
17423 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
17424 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
17425 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
17426 conditionally, etc.
17427
17428 @table @code
17429 @kindex if
17430 @kindex else
17431 @item if
17432 @itemx else
17433 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
17434 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
17435 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
17436 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
17437 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
17438 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
17439 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17440
17441 @kindex while
17442 @item while
17443 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
17444 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
17445 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
17446 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
17447 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
17448 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
17449
17450 @kindex loop_break
17451 @item loop_break
17452 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
17453 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
17454 line.
17455
17456 @kindex loop_continue
17457 @item loop_continue
17458 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
17459 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
17460 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
17461 the controlling expression.
17462
17463 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
17464 @item end
17465 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
17466 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
17467 @end table
17468
17469
17470 @node Output
17471 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
17472
17473 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
17474 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
17475 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
17476 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
17477 want.
17478
17479 @table @code
17480 @kindex echo
17481 @item echo @var{text}
17482 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
17483 @c because it is not in ANSI.
17484 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
17485 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
17486 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
17487 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
17488 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
17489 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
17490 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
17491 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
17492 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
17493
17494 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
17495 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
17496
17497 @smallexample
17498 echo This is some text\n\
17499 which is continued\n\
17500 onto several lines.\n
17501 @end smallexample
17502
17503 produces the same output as
17504
17505 @smallexample
17506 echo This is some text\n
17507 echo which is continued\n
17508 echo onto several lines.\n
17509 @end smallexample
17510
17511 @kindex output
17512 @item output @var{expression}
17513 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
17514 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
17515 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
17516 on expressions.
17517
17518 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
17519 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
17520 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
17521 Formats}, for more information.
17522
17523 @kindex printf
17524 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
17525 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
17526 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
17527 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
17528 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
17529 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
17530 executing the code below:
17531
17532 @smallexample
17533 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
17534 @end smallexample
17535
17536 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
17537 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
17538 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
17539 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
17540 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
17541 printed.
17542
17543 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
17544
17545 @smallexample
17546 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
17547 @end smallexample
17548
17549 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
17550 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
17551 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
17552
17553 @itemize @bullet
17554 @item
17555 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
17556
17557 @item
17558 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
17559 width.
17560
17561 @item
17562 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
17563 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
17564
17565 @item
17566 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
17567 supported.
17568
17569 @item
17570 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
17571
17572 @item
17573 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
17574 @end itemize
17575
17576 @noindent
17577 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
17578 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
17579 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
17580 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
17581
17582 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
17583 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
17584 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
17585 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
17586 supported.
17587
17588 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
17589 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
17590 together with a floating point specifier.
17591 letters:
17592
17593 @itemize @bullet
17594 @item
17595 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
17596
17597 @item
17598 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
17599
17600 @item
17601 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
17602 @end itemize
17603
17604 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
17605 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
17606 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
17607
17608 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
17609 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
17610
17611 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
17612 @smallexample
17613 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
17614 @end smallexample
17615
17616 @end table
17617
17618 @node Python
17619 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17620 @cindex python scripting
17621 @cindex scripting with python
17622
17623 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
17624 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
17625 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
17626
17627 @menu
17628 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
17629 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
17630 @end menu
17631
17632 @node Python Commands
17633 @subsection Python Commands
17634 @cindex python commands
17635 @cindex commands to access python
17636
17637 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
17638 and one related setting:
17639
17640 @table @code
17641 @kindex python
17642 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
17643 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
17644
17645 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
17646 argument as a Python command. For example:
17647
17648 @smallexample
17649 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
17650 23
17651 @end smallexample
17652
17653 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
17654 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
17655 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
17656 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
17657 containing @code{end}. For example:
17658
17659 @smallexample
17660 (@value{GDBP}) python
17661 Type python script
17662 End with a line saying just "end".
17663 >print 23
17664 >end
17665 23
17666 @end smallexample
17667
17668 @kindex maint set python print-stack
17669 @item maint set python print-stack
17670 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
17671 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
17672 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
17673 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
17674 disabled.
17675 @end table
17676
17677 @node Python API
17678 @subsection Python API
17679 @cindex python api
17680 @cindex programming in python
17681
17682 @cindex python stdout
17683 @cindex python pagination
17684 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
17685 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
17686 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
17687 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
17688 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
17689
17690 @menu
17691 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
17692 * Exception Handling::
17693 * Values From Inferior::
17694 @end menu
17695
17696 @node Basic Python
17697 @subsubsection Basic Python
17698
17699 @cindex python functions
17700 @cindex python module
17701 @cindex gdb module
17702 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
17703 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
17704 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
17705 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
17706
17707 @findex gdb.execute
17708 @defun execute command
17709 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17710 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
17711 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
17712 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
17713 @end defun
17714
17715 @findex gdb.get_parameter
17716 @defun get_parameter parameter
17717 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
17718 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
17719 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
17720 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
17721
17722 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
17723 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
17724 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
17725 @end defun
17726
17727 @findex gdb.write
17728 @defun write string
17729 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
17730 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
17731 call this function.
17732 @end defun
17733
17734 @findex gdb.flush
17735 @defun flush
17736 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
17737 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
17738 function.
17739 @end defun
17740
17741 @node Exception Handling
17742 @subsubsection Exception Handling
17743 @cindex python exceptions
17744 @cindex exceptions, python
17745
17746 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
17747 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
17748 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
17749 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
17750 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
17751 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
17752 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
17753
17754 @smallexample
17755 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
17756 Traceback (most recent call last):
17757 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
17758 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
17759 @end smallexample
17760
17761 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
17762 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
17763 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
17764 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
17765 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
17766 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
17767 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
17768 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
17769 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
17770 traceback.
17771
17772 @node Values From Inferior
17773 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
17774 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
17775 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
17776
17777 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
17778 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
17779 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
17780 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
17781 fetching values when necessary.
17782
17783 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
17784 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
17785 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
17786
17787 @smallexample
17788 bar = some_val + 2
17789 @end smallexample
17790
17791 @noindent
17792 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
17793 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
17794
17795 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
17796 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
17797 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
17798 can access its @code{foo} element with:
17799
17800 @smallexample
17801 bar = some_val['foo']
17802 @end smallexample
17803
17804 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
17805
17806 For pointer data types, @code{gdb.Value} provides a method for
17807 dereferencing the pointer to obtain the object it points to.
17808
17809 @defmethod Value dereference
17810 This method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object whose contents is
17811 the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if @code{foo} is
17812 a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
17813
17814 @smallexample
17815 int *foo;
17816 @end smallexample
17817
17818 @noindent
17819 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
17820 @code{foo} points to like this:
17821
17822 @smallexample
17823 bar = foo.dereference ()
17824 @end smallexample
17825
17826 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
17827 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
17828 @end defmethod
17829
17830 @node Interpreters
17831 @chapter Command Interpreters
17832 @cindex command interpreters
17833
17834 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
17835 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
17836 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
17837
17838 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
17839 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
17840 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
17841 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
17842
17843 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
17844 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
17845 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
17846 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
17847
17848 @table @code
17849 @item console
17850 @cindex console interpreter
17851 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
17852 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
17853 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
17854
17855 @item mi
17856 @cindex mi interpreter
17857 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
17858 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
17859 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
17860 Interface}.
17861
17862 @item mi2
17863 @cindex mi2 interpreter
17864 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
17865
17866 @item mi1
17867 @cindex mi1 interpreter
17868 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
17869
17870 @end table
17871
17872 @cindex invoke another interpreter
17873 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
17874 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
17875 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
17876 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
17877 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
17878 the IDE inoperable!
17879
17880 @kindex interpreter-exec
17881 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
17882 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
17883 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
17884 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
17885
17886 @smallexample
17887 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
17888 @end smallexample
17889
17890 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
17891 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
17892
17893 @node TUI
17894 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
17895 @cindex TUI
17896 @cindex Text User Interface
17897
17898 @menu
17899 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
17900 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
17901 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
17902 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
17903 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
17904 @end menu
17905
17906 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
17907 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
17908 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
17909 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
17910 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
17911 is available.
17912
17913 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
17914 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
17915 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
17916 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
17917 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
17918 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
17919
17920 @node TUI Overview
17921 @section TUI Overview
17922
17923 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
17924
17925 @table @emph
17926 @item command
17927 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
17928 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
17929 managed using readline.
17930
17931 @item source
17932 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
17933 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
17934
17935 @item assembly
17936 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
17937
17938 @item register
17939 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
17940 when their values change.
17941 @end table
17942
17943 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
17944 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
17945 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
17946 indicates the breakpoint type:
17947
17948 @table @code
17949 @item B
17950 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17951
17952 @item b
17953 Breakpoint which was never hit.
17954
17955 @item H
17956 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
17957
17958 @item h
17959 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
17960 @end table
17961
17962 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
17963
17964 @table @code
17965 @item +
17966 Breakpoint is enabled.
17967
17968 @item -
17969 Breakpoint is disabled.
17970 @end table
17971
17972 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
17973 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
17974 changes.
17975
17976 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
17977 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
17978 layouts:
17979
17980 @itemize @bullet
17981 @item
17982 source only,
17983
17984 @item
17985 assembly only,
17986
17987 @item
17988 source and assembly,
17989
17990 @item
17991 source and registers, or
17992
17993 @item
17994 assembly and registers.
17995 @end itemize
17996
17997 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
17998
17999 @table @emph
18000 @item target
18001 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
18002 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
18003
18004 @item process
18005 Gives the current process or thread number.
18006 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
18007
18008 @item function
18009 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
18010 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
18011 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
18012 the string @code{??} is displayed.
18013
18014 @item line
18015 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
18016 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
18017
18018 @item pc
18019 Indicates the current program counter address.
18020 @end table
18021
18022 @node TUI Keys
18023 @section TUI Key Bindings
18024 @cindex TUI key bindings
18025
18026 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
18027 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
18028 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
18029
18030 @table @kbd
18031 @kindex C-x C-a
18032 @item C-x C-a
18033 @kindex C-x a
18034 @itemx C-x a
18035 @kindex C-x A
18036 @itemx C-x A
18037 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
18038 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
18039 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
18040 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
18041 The screen is then refreshed.
18042
18043 @kindex C-x 1
18044 @item C-x 1
18045 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
18046 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
18047 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
18048
18049 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
18050
18051 @kindex C-x 2
18052 @item C-x 2
18053 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
18054 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
18055 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
18056 previous layout and the new one.
18057
18058 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
18059
18060 @kindex C-x o
18061 @item C-x o
18062 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
18063 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
18064 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
18065
18066 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
18067
18068 @kindex C-x s
18069 @item C-x s
18070 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
18071 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
18072 @end table
18073
18074 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
18075
18076 @table @asis
18077 @kindex PgUp
18078 @item @key{PgUp}
18079 Scroll the active window one page up.
18080
18081 @kindex PgDn
18082 @item @key{PgDn}
18083 Scroll the active window one page down.
18084
18085 @kindex Up
18086 @item @key{Up}
18087 Scroll the active window one line up.
18088
18089 @kindex Down
18090 @item @key{Down}
18091 Scroll the active window one line down.
18092
18093 @kindex Left
18094 @item @key{Left}
18095 Scroll the active window one column left.
18096
18097 @kindex Right
18098 @item @key{Right}
18099 Scroll the active window one column right.
18100
18101 @kindex C-L
18102 @item @kbd{C-L}
18103 Refresh the screen.
18104 @end table
18105
18106 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
18107 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
18108 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
18109 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
18110 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
18111
18112 @node TUI Single Key Mode
18113 @section TUI Single Key Mode
18114 @cindex TUI single key mode
18115
18116 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
18117 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
18118 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
18119
18120 @table @kbd
18121 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18122 @item c
18123 continue
18124
18125 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18126 @item d
18127 down
18128
18129 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18130 @item f
18131 finish
18132
18133 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18134 @item n
18135 next
18136
18137 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18138 @item q
18139 exit the SingleKey mode.
18140
18141 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18142 @item r
18143 run
18144
18145 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18146 @item s
18147 step
18148
18149 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18150 @item u
18151 up
18152
18153 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18154 @item v
18155 info locals
18156
18157 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18158 @item w
18159 where
18160 @end table
18161
18162 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
18163 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
18164 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
18165 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
18166 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
18167 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
18168
18169
18170 @node TUI Commands
18171 @section TUI-specific Commands
18172 @cindex TUI commands
18173
18174 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
18175 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
18176 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
18177 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
18178
18179 @table @code
18180 @item info win
18181 @kindex info win
18182 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
18183
18184 @item layout next
18185 @kindex layout
18186 Display the next layout.
18187
18188 @item layout prev
18189 Display the previous layout.
18190
18191 @item layout src
18192 Display the source window only.
18193
18194 @item layout asm
18195 Display the assembly window only.
18196
18197 @item layout split
18198 Display the source and assembly window.
18199
18200 @item layout regs
18201 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
18202
18203 @item focus next
18204 @kindex focus
18205 Make the next window active for scrolling.
18206
18207 @item focus prev
18208 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
18209
18210 @item focus src
18211 Make the source window active for scrolling.
18212
18213 @item focus asm
18214 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
18215
18216 @item focus regs
18217 Make the register window active for scrolling.
18218
18219 @item focus cmd
18220 Make the command window active for scrolling.
18221
18222 @item refresh
18223 @kindex refresh
18224 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
18225
18226 @item tui reg float
18227 @kindex tui reg
18228 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
18229
18230 @item tui reg general
18231 Show the general registers in the register window.
18232
18233 @item tui reg next
18234 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
18235 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
18236 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
18237 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
18238
18239 @item tui reg system
18240 Show the system registers in the register window.
18241
18242 @item update
18243 @kindex update
18244 Update the source window and the current execution point.
18245
18246 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
18247 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
18248 @kindex winheight
18249 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
18250 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
18251 decrease it.
18252
18253 @item tabset @var{nchars}
18254 @kindex tabset
18255 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
18256 @end table
18257
18258 @node TUI Configuration
18259 @section TUI Configuration Variables
18260 @cindex TUI configuration variables
18261
18262 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
18263
18264 @table @code
18265 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
18266 @kindex set tui border-kind
18267 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
18268 The possible values are the following:
18269 @table @code
18270 @item space
18271 Use a space character to draw the border.
18272
18273 @item ascii
18274 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
18275
18276 @item acs
18277 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
18278 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
18279 @end table
18280
18281 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
18282 @kindex set tui border-mode
18283 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
18284 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
18285 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
18286 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
18287 @table @code
18288 @item normal
18289 Use normal attributes to display the border.
18290
18291 @item standout
18292 Use standout mode.
18293
18294 @item reverse
18295 Use reverse video mode.
18296
18297 @item half
18298 Use half bright mode.
18299
18300 @item half-standout
18301 Use half bright and standout mode.
18302
18303 @item bold
18304 Use extra bright or bold mode.
18305
18306 @item bold-standout
18307 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
18308 @end table
18309 @end table
18310
18311 @node Emacs
18312 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
18313
18314 @cindex Emacs
18315 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
18316 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
18317 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
18318 @value{GDBN}.
18319
18320 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
18321 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
18322 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
18323 created Emacs buffer.
18324 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
18325
18326 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
18327 things:
18328
18329 @itemize @bullet
18330 @item
18331 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
18332 the GUD buffer.
18333
18334 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
18335 and output done by the program you are debugging.
18336
18337 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
18338 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
18339 in this way.
18340
18341 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
18342 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
18343 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
18344 stop.
18345
18346 @item
18347 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
18348
18349 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
18350 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
18351 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
18352 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
18353 and the source.
18354
18355 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
18356 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
18357 @end itemize
18358
18359 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
18360 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
18361 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
18362 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
18363
18364 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
18365 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
18366 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
18367 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
18368 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
18369 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
18370 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
18371 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
18372 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
18373
18374 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
18375 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
18376 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
18377 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
18378
18379 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
18380 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
18381 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
18382 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
18383 one you want.
18384
18385 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
18386 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
18387
18388 @table @kbd
18389 @item C-h m
18390 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
18391
18392 @item C-c C-s
18393 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
18394 update the display window to show the current file and location.
18395
18396 @item C-c C-n
18397 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
18398 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
18399 to show the current file and location.
18400
18401 @item C-c C-i
18402 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
18403 display window accordingly.
18404
18405 @item C-c C-f
18406 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
18407 @code{finish} command.
18408
18409 @item C-c C-r
18410 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
18411 command.
18412
18413 @item C-c <
18414 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
18415 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
18416 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
18417
18418 @item C-c >
18419 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
18420 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
18421 @end table
18422
18423 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
18424 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
18425
18426 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
18427 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
18428 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
18429 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
18430 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
18431 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
18432 speedbar displays watch expressions.
18433
18434 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
18435 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
18436 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
18437 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
18438 frame.
18439
18440 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
18441 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
18442 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
18443 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
18444 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
18445 to correspond properly with the code.
18446
18447 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
18448 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
18449 Emacs Manual}).
18450
18451 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
18452 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
18453 @ignore
18454 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
18455 @kindex Epoch
18456 @kindex inspect
18457
18458 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
18459 called the @code{epoch}
18460 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
18461 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
18462 each value is printed in its own window.
18463 @end ignore
18464
18465
18466 @node GDB/MI
18467 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
18468
18469 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
18470
18471 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
18472 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
18473 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
18474 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
18475 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
18476 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
18477
18478 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
18479 in the form of a reference manual.
18480
18481 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
18482 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
18483 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
18484
18485 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
18486
18487 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
18488 This chapter uses the following notation:
18489
18490 @itemize @bullet
18491 @item
18492 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
18493
18494 @item
18495 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
18496 it may or may not be given.
18497
18498 @item
18499 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18500 may repeat zero or more times.
18501
18502 @item
18503 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
18504 may repeat one or more times.
18505
18506 @item
18507 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
18508 @end itemize
18509
18510 @ignore
18511 @heading Dependencies
18512 @end ignore
18513
18514 @menu
18515 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
18516 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
18517 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
18518 * GDB/MI Output Records::
18519 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
18520 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
18521 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
18522 * GDB/MI Program Context::
18523 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
18524 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
18525 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
18526 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
18527 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
18528 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
18529 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
18530 * GDB/MI File Commands::
18531 @ignore
18532 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
18533 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
18534 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
18535 @end ignore
18536 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
18537 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
18538 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
18539 @end menu
18540
18541 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18542 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
18543 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
18544
18545 @menu
18546 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
18547 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
18548 @end menu
18549
18550 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
18551 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
18552
18553 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
18554 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
18555 @table @code
18556 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
18557 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
18558
18559 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
18560 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
18561 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18562
18563 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
18564 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
18565 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
18566
18567 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
18568 "any sequence of digits"
18569
18570 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
18571 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
18572
18573 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
18574 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
18575
18576 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
18577 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
18578
18579 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
18580 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
18581 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
18582
18583 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
18584 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
18585
18586 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18587 @code{CR | CR-LF}
18588 @end table
18589
18590 @noindent
18591 Notes:
18592
18593 @itemize @bullet
18594 @item
18595 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
18596 output is described below.
18597
18598 @item
18599 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
18600 finishes.
18601
18602 @item
18603 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
18604 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
18605 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
18606 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
18607 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
18608 @end itemize
18609
18610 Pragmatics:
18611
18612 @itemize @bullet
18613 @item
18614 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
18615
18616 @item
18617 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
18618 @end itemize
18619
18620 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
18621 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
18622
18623 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
18624 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
18625 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
18626 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
18627 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
18628 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
18629
18630 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
18631 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
18632 @var{token}.
18633
18634 @table @code
18635 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
18636 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
18637
18638 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
18639 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18640
18641 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
18642 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
18643
18644 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
18645 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
18646
18647 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
18648 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
18649
18650 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
18651 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
18652
18653 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
18654 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
18655
18656 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
18657 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
18658
18659 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
18660 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
18661
18662 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
18663 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
18664 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
18665
18666 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
18667 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
18668
18669 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
18670 @code{ @var{string} }
18671
18672 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
18673 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
18674
18675 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
18676 @code{@var{c-string}}
18677
18678 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
18679 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
18680
18681 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
18682 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
18683 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
18684
18685 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
18686 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
18687
18688 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
18689 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
18690
18691 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
18692 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
18693
18694 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
18695 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
18696
18697 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
18698 @code{CR | CR-LF}
18699
18700 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
18701 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
18702 @end table
18703
18704 @noindent
18705 Notes:
18706
18707 @itemize @bullet
18708 @item
18709 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
18710
18711 @item
18712 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
18713 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
18714 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
18715 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
18716 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
18717 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
18718 prior command.
18719
18720 @item
18721 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18722 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
18723 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
18724 prefixed by @samp{+}.
18725
18726 @item
18727 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18728 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
18729 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
18730 @samp{*}.
18731
18732 @item
18733 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18734 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
18735 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
18736 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
18737
18738 @item
18739 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18740 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
18741 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
18742 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
18743
18744 @item
18745 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18746 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
18747 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
18748
18749 @item
18750 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18751 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
18752 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
18753 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
18754
18755 @item
18756 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
18757 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
18758 @var{values}.
18759
18760
18761 @end itemize
18762
18763 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
18764 details about the various output records.
18765
18766 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18767 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
18768 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
18769
18770 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
18771 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
18772
18773 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
18774 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
18775 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
18776 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
18777 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
18778 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
18779
18780 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
18781 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
18782 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
18783
18784 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18785 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
18786 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
18787 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
18788
18789 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
18790 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
18791
18792 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
18793 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
18794 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
18795 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
18796 might change.
18797
18798 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
18799 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
18800 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
18801 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
18802
18803 @itemize @bullet
18804 @item
18805 New MI commands may be added.
18806
18807 @item
18808 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
18809
18810 @item
18811 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
18812 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
18813
18814 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
18815 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
18816
18817 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
18818 @c resolve inconsistencies.
18819 @end itemize
18820
18821 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
18822 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
18823 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
18824 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
18825 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
18826
18827 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
18828 @c version?
18829
18830 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
18831 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
18832 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
18833 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
18834 @cindex mailing lists
18835
18836 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18837 @node GDB/MI Output Records
18838 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
18839
18840 @menu
18841 * GDB/MI Result Records::
18842 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
18843 * GDB/MI Async Records::
18844 @end menu
18845
18846 @node GDB/MI Result Records
18847 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
18848
18849 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18850 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
18851 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
18852 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
18853
18854 @table @code
18855 @findex ^done
18856 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
18857 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
18858 values.
18859
18860 @item "^running"
18861 @findex ^running
18862 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
18863 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
18864 running.
18865
18866 @item "^connected"
18867 @findex ^connected
18868 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
18869
18870 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
18871 @findex ^error
18872 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
18873 error message.
18874
18875 @item "^exit"
18876 @findex ^exit
18877 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
18878
18879 @end table
18880
18881 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
18882 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
18883
18884 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
18885 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18886 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
18887 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
18888 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
18889
18890 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
18891 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
18892 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
18893 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
18894 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
18895
18896 @table @code
18897 @item "~" @var{string-output}
18898 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
18899 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
18900
18901 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
18902 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
18903 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
18904 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
18905
18906 @item "&" @var{string-output}
18907 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
18908 internals.
18909 @end table
18910
18911 @node GDB/MI Async Records
18912 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
18913
18914 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
18915 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
18916 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
18917 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
18918 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
18919 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
18920
18921 The following is the list of possible async records:
18922
18923 @table @code
18924
18925 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
18926 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
18927 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
18928 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
18929 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
18930 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
18931 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
18932 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
18933 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
18934 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
18935
18936 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
18937 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
18938 following values:
18939
18940 @table @code
18941 @item breakpoint-hit
18942 A breakpoint was reached.
18943 @item watchpoint-trigger
18944 A watchpoint was triggered.
18945 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
18946 A read watchpoint was triggered.
18947 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
18948 An access watchpoint was triggered.
18949 @item function-finished
18950 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18951 @item location-reached
18952 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
18953 @item watchpoint-scope
18954 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
18955 @item end-stepping-range
18956 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
18957 similar CLI command was accomplished.
18958 @item exited-signalled
18959 The inferior exited because of a signal.
18960 @item exited
18961 The inferior exited.
18962 @item exited-normally
18963 The inferior exited normally.
18964 @item signal-received
18965 A signal was received by the inferior.
18966 @end table
18967
18968 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}"
18969 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}"
18970 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
18971 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread.
18972 @end table
18973
18974
18975
18976 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18977 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
18978 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
18979 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
18980
18981 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
18982 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
18983 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
18984 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
18985
18986 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
18987 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
18988
18989 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
18990
18991 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
18992 information of the breakpoint.
18993
18994 @smallexample
18995 -> -break-insert main
18996 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
18997 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
18998 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
18999 <- (gdb)
19000 @end smallexample
19001
19002 @subheading Program Execution
19003
19004 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
19005 reason that execution stopped.
19006
19007 @smallexample
19008 -> -exec-run
19009 <- ^running
19010 <- (gdb)
19011 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
19012 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
19013 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
19014 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
19015 <- (gdb)
19016 -> -exec-continue
19017 <- ^running
19018 <- (gdb)
19019 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19020 <- (gdb)
19021 @end smallexample
19022
19023 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
19024
19025 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
19026
19027 @smallexample
19028 -> (gdb)
19029 <- -gdb-exit
19030 <- ^exit
19031 @end smallexample
19032
19033 @subheading A Bad Command
19034
19035 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
19036
19037 @smallexample
19038 -> -rubbish
19039 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
19040 <- (gdb)
19041 @end smallexample
19042
19043
19044 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19045 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
19046 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
19047
19048 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
19049 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
19050
19051 @subheading Motivation
19052
19053 The motivation for this collection of commands.
19054
19055 @subheading Introduction
19056
19057 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
19058
19059 @subheading Commands
19060
19061 For each command in the block, the following is described:
19062
19063 @subsubheading Synopsis
19064
19065 @smallexample
19066 -command @var{args}@dots{}
19067 @end smallexample
19068
19069 @subsubheading Result
19070
19071 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19072
19073 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
19074
19075 @subsubheading Example
19076
19077 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
19078 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
19079
19080
19081 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19082 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
19083 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
19084
19085 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
19086 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
19087 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
19088 breakpoints.
19089
19090 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
19091 @findex -break-after
19092
19093 @subsubheading Synopsis
19094
19095 @smallexample
19096 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
19097 @end smallexample
19098
19099 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
19100 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
19101 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
19102 @samp{-break-list} command below.
19103
19104 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19105
19106 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
19107
19108 @subsubheading Example
19109
19110 @smallexample
19111 (gdb)
19112 -break-insert main
19113 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
19114 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
19115 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
19116 (gdb)
19117 -break-after 1 3
19118 ~
19119 ^done
19120 (gdb)
19121 -break-list
19122 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19123 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19124 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19125 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19126 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19127 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19128 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19129 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19130 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19131 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
19132 (gdb)
19133 @end smallexample
19134
19135 @ignore
19136 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
19137 @findex -break-catch
19138
19139 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
19140 @findex -break-commands
19141 @end ignore
19142
19143
19144 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
19145 @findex -break-condition
19146
19147 @subsubheading Synopsis
19148
19149 @smallexample
19150 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
19151 @end smallexample
19152
19153 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
19154 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
19155 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
19156 command below).
19157
19158 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19159
19160 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
19161
19162 @subsubheading Example
19163
19164 @smallexample
19165 (gdb)
19166 -break-condition 1 1
19167 ^done
19168 (gdb)
19169 -break-list
19170 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19171 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19172 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19173 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19174 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19175 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19176 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19177 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19178 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19179 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
19180 (gdb)
19181 @end smallexample
19182
19183 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
19184 @findex -break-delete
19185
19186 @subsubheading Synopsis
19187
19188 @smallexample
19189 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19190 @end smallexample
19191
19192 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
19193 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
19194
19195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19196
19197 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
19198
19199 @subsubheading Example
19200
19201 @smallexample
19202 (gdb)
19203 -break-delete 1
19204 ^done
19205 (gdb)
19206 -break-list
19207 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
19208 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19209 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19210 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19211 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19212 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19213 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19214 body=[]@}
19215 (gdb)
19216 @end smallexample
19217
19218 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
19219 @findex -break-disable
19220
19221 @subsubheading Synopsis
19222
19223 @smallexample
19224 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19225 @end smallexample
19226
19227 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
19228 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
19229
19230 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19231
19232 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
19233
19234 @subsubheading Example
19235
19236 @smallexample
19237 (gdb)
19238 -break-disable 2
19239 ^done
19240 (gdb)
19241 -break-list
19242 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19243 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19244 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19245 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19246 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19247 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19248 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19249 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
19250 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19251 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19252 (gdb)
19253 @end smallexample
19254
19255 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
19256 @findex -break-enable
19257
19258 @subsubheading Synopsis
19259
19260 @smallexample
19261 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
19262 @end smallexample
19263
19264 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
19265
19266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19267
19268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
19269
19270 @subsubheading Example
19271
19272 @smallexample
19273 (gdb)
19274 -break-enable 2
19275 ^done
19276 (gdb)
19277 -break-list
19278 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19279 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19280 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19281 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19282 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19283 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19284 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19285 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19286 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19287 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
19288 (gdb)
19289 @end smallexample
19290
19291 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
19292 @findex -break-info
19293
19294 @subsubheading Synopsis
19295
19296 @smallexample
19297 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
19298 @end smallexample
19299
19300 @c REDUNDANT???
19301 Get information about a single breakpoint.
19302
19303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19304
19305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
19306
19307 @subsubheading Example
19308 N.A.
19309
19310 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
19311 @findex -break-insert
19312
19313 @subsubheading Synopsis
19314
19315 @smallexample
19316 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
19317 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
19318 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
19319 @end smallexample
19320
19321 @noindent
19322 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
19323
19324 @itemize @bullet
19325 @item function
19326 @c @item +offset
19327 @c @item -offset
19328 @c @item linenum
19329 @item filename:linenum
19330 @item filename:function
19331 @item *address
19332 @end itemize
19333
19334 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
19335
19336 @table @samp
19337 @item -t
19338 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
19339 @item -h
19340 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
19341 @item -c @var{condition}
19342 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
19343 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
19344 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
19345 @item -f
19346 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
19347 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
19348 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
19349 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
19350 cannot be parsed.
19351 @end table
19352
19353 @subsubheading Result
19354
19355 The result is in the form:
19356
19357 @smallexample
19358 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
19359 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
19360 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
19361 times="@var{times}"@}
19362 @end smallexample
19363
19364 @noindent
19365 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
19366 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
19367 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
19368 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
19369 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
19370 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
19371 which use the same output).
19372
19373 Note: this format is open to change.
19374 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
19375
19376 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19377
19378 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
19379 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
19380
19381 @subsubheading Example
19382
19383 @smallexample
19384 (gdb)
19385 -break-insert main
19386 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
19387 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
19388 (gdb)
19389 -break-insert -t foo
19390 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
19391 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
19392 (gdb)
19393 -break-list
19394 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19395 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19396 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19397 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19398 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19399 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19400 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19401 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19402 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
19403 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
19404 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
19405 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
19406 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
19407 (gdb)
19408 -break-insert -r foo.*
19409 ~int foo(int, int);
19410 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
19411 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
19412 (gdb)
19413 @end smallexample
19414
19415 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
19416 @findex -break-list
19417
19418 @subsubheading Synopsis
19419
19420 @smallexample
19421 -break-list
19422 @end smallexample
19423
19424 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
19425
19426 @table @samp
19427 @item Number
19428 number of the breakpoint
19429 @item Type
19430 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
19431 @item Disposition
19432 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
19433 or @samp{nokeep}
19434 @item Enabled
19435 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
19436 @item Address
19437 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
19438 @item What
19439 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
19440 name, line number
19441 @item Times
19442 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
19443 @end table
19444
19445 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
19446 @code{body} field is an empty list.
19447
19448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19449
19450 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
19451
19452 @subsubheading Example
19453
19454 @smallexample
19455 (gdb)
19456 -break-list
19457 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19458 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19459 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19460 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19461 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19462 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19463 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19464 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19465 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
19466 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19467 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
19468 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
19469 (gdb)
19470 @end smallexample
19471
19472 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
19473
19474 @smallexample
19475 (gdb)
19476 -break-list
19477 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
19478 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19479 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19480 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19481 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19482 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19483 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19484 body=[]@}
19485 (gdb)
19486 @end smallexample
19487
19488 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
19489 @findex -break-watch
19490
19491 @subsubheading Synopsis
19492
19493 @smallexample
19494 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
19495 @end smallexample
19496
19497 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
19498 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
19499 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
19500 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
19501 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
19502 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
19503 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
19504 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
19505
19506 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
19507 breakpoints inserted.
19508
19509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19510
19511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
19512 @samp{rwatch}.
19513
19514 @subsubheading Example
19515
19516 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
19517
19518 @smallexample
19519 (gdb)
19520 -break-watch x
19521 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
19522 (gdb)
19523 -exec-continue
19524 ^running
19525 (gdb)
19526 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
19527 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
19528 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19529 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
19530 (gdb)
19531 @end smallexample
19532
19533 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
19534 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
19535 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
19536
19537 @smallexample
19538 (gdb)
19539 -break-watch C
19540 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
19541 (gdb)
19542 -exec-continue
19543 ^running
19544 (gdb)
19545 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
19546 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
19547 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19548 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19549 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
19550 (gdb)
19551 -exec-continue
19552 ^running
19553 (gdb)
19554 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
19555 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
19556 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19557 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19558 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19559 (gdb)
19560 @end smallexample
19561
19562 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
19563 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
19564 deleted.
19565
19566 @smallexample
19567 (gdb)
19568 -break-watch C
19569 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
19570 (gdb)
19571 -break-list
19572 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19573 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19574 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19575 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19576 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19577 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19578 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19579 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19580 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19581 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19582 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
19583 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
19584 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
19585 (gdb)
19586 -exec-continue
19587 ^running
19588 (gdb)
19589 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
19590 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
19591 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19592 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19593 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
19594 (gdb)
19595 -break-list
19596 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
19597 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19598 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19599 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19600 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19601 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19602 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19603 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19604 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19605 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19606 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
19607 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
19608 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
19609 (gdb)
19610 -exec-continue
19611 ^running
19612 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
19613 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
19614 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19615 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19616 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19617 (gdb)
19618 -break-list
19619 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
19620 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
19621 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
19622 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
19623 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
19624 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
19625 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
19626 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
19627 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19628 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19629 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
19630 times="1"@}]@}
19631 (gdb)
19632 @end smallexample
19633
19634 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19635 @node GDB/MI Program Context
19636 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
19637
19638 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
19639 @findex -exec-arguments
19640
19641
19642 @subsubheading Synopsis
19643
19644 @smallexample
19645 -exec-arguments @var{args}
19646 @end smallexample
19647
19648 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
19649 @samp{-exec-run}.
19650
19651 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19652
19653 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
19654
19655 @subsubheading Example
19656
19657 @smallexample
19658 (gdb)
19659 -exec-arguments -v word
19660 ^done
19661 (gdb)
19662 @end smallexample
19663
19664
19665 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
19666 @findex -exec-show-arguments
19667
19668 @subsubheading Synopsis
19669
19670 @smallexample
19671 -exec-show-arguments
19672 @end smallexample
19673
19674 Print the arguments of the program.
19675
19676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19677
19678 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
19679
19680 @subsubheading Example
19681 N.A.
19682
19683
19684 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
19685 @findex -environment-cd
19686
19687 @subsubheading Synopsis
19688
19689 @smallexample
19690 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
19691 @end smallexample
19692
19693 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
19694
19695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19696
19697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
19698
19699 @subsubheading Example
19700
19701 @smallexample
19702 (gdb)
19703 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19704 ^done
19705 (gdb)
19706 @end smallexample
19707
19708
19709 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
19710 @findex -environment-directory
19711
19712 @subsubheading Synopsis
19713
19714 @smallexample
19715 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19716 @end smallexample
19717
19718 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
19719 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
19720 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
19721 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19722 occurs as normal.
19723 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19724 multiple directories in a single command
19725 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19726 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19727 If blanks are needed as
19728 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19729 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19730 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19731 character must not be used
19732 in any directory name.
19733 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
19734
19735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19736
19737 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
19738
19739 @subsubheading Example
19740
19741 @smallexample
19742 (gdb)
19743 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
19744 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19745 (gdb)
19746 -environment-directory ""
19747 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
19748 (gdb)
19749 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
19750 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
19751 (gdb)
19752 -environment-directory -r
19753 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
19754 (gdb)
19755 @end smallexample
19756
19757
19758 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
19759 @findex -environment-path
19760
19761 @subsubheading Synopsis
19762
19763 @smallexample
19764 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
19765 @end smallexample
19766
19767 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
19768 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
19769 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
19770 supplied in addition to the
19771 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
19772 occurs as normal.
19773 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
19774 multiple directories in a single command
19775 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
19776 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
19777 If blanks are needed as
19778 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
19779 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
19780 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
19781 character must not be used
19782 in any directory name.
19783 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
19784
19785
19786 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19787
19788 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
19789
19790 @subsubheading Example
19791
19792 @smallexample
19793 (gdb)
19794 -environment-path
19795 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
19796 (gdb)
19797 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
19798 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
19799 (gdb)
19800 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
19801 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
19802 (gdb)
19803 @end smallexample
19804
19805
19806 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
19807 @findex -environment-pwd
19808
19809 @subsubheading Synopsis
19810
19811 @smallexample
19812 -environment-pwd
19813 @end smallexample
19814
19815 Show the current working directory.
19816
19817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19818
19819 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
19820
19821 @subsubheading Example
19822
19823 @smallexample
19824 (gdb)
19825 -environment-pwd
19826 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
19827 (gdb)
19828 @end smallexample
19829
19830 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19831 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
19832 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
19833
19834
19835 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
19836 @findex -thread-info
19837
19838 @subsubheading Synopsis
19839
19840 @smallexample
19841 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
19842 @end smallexample
19843
19844 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
19845 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
19846 threads. When printing information about all threads,
19847 also reports the current thread.
19848
19849 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19850
19851 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
19852 about all threads.
19853
19854 @subsubheading Example
19855
19856 @smallexample
19857 -thread-info
19858 ^done,threads=[
19859 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
19860 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},
19861 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
19862 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
19863 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}@}],
19864 current-thread-id="1"
19865 (gdb)
19866 @end smallexample
19867
19868 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
19869 @findex -thread-list-ids
19870
19871 @subsubheading Synopsis
19872
19873 @smallexample
19874 -thread-list-ids
19875 @end smallexample
19876
19877 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
19878 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
19879
19880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19881
19882 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
19883
19884 @subsubheading Example
19885
19886 No threads present, besides the main process:
19887
19888 @smallexample
19889 (gdb)
19890 -thread-list-ids
19891 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
19892 (gdb)
19893 @end smallexample
19894
19895
19896 Several threads:
19897
19898 @smallexample
19899 (gdb)
19900 -thread-list-ids
19901 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19902 number-of-threads="3"
19903 (gdb)
19904 @end smallexample
19905
19906
19907 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
19908 @findex -thread-select
19909
19910 @subsubheading Synopsis
19911
19912 @smallexample
19913 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
19914 @end smallexample
19915
19916 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
19917 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
19918
19919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19920
19921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
19922
19923 @subsubheading Example
19924
19925 @smallexample
19926 (gdb)
19927 -exec-next
19928 ^running
19929 (gdb)
19930 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
19931 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
19932 (gdb)
19933 -thread-list-ids
19934 ^done,
19935 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
19936 number-of-threads="3"
19937 (gdb)
19938 -thread-select 3
19939 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
19940 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
19941 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
19942 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
19943 (gdb)
19944 @end smallexample
19945
19946 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19947 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
19948 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
19949
19950 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
19951 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
19952 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
19953 other cases.
19954
19955 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
19956 @findex -exec-continue
19957
19958 @subsubheading Synopsis
19959
19960 @smallexample
19961 -exec-continue
19962 @end smallexample
19963
19964 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
19965 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
19966
19967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19968
19969 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
19970
19971 @subsubheading Example
19972
19973 @smallexample
19974 -exec-continue
19975 ^running
19976 (gdb)
19977 @@Hello world
19978 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
19979 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
19980 line="13"@}
19981 (gdb)
19982 @end smallexample
19983
19984
19985 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
19986 @findex -exec-finish
19987
19988 @subsubheading Synopsis
19989
19990 @smallexample
19991 -exec-finish
19992 @end smallexample
19993
19994 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
19995 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
19996
19997 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19998
19999 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
20000
20001 @subsubheading Example
20002
20003 Function returning @code{void}.
20004
20005 @smallexample
20006 -exec-finish
20007 ^running
20008 (gdb)
20009 @@hello from foo
20010 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
20011 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
20012 (gdb)
20013 @end smallexample
20014
20015 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
20016 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
20017 value itself.
20018
20019 @smallexample
20020 -exec-finish
20021 ^running
20022 (gdb)
20023 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
20024 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
20025 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20026 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
20027 (gdb)
20028 @end smallexample
20029
20030
20031 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
20032 @findex -exec-interrupt
20033
20034 @subsubheading Synopsis
20035
20036 @smallexample
20037 -exec-interrupt
20038 @end smallexample
20039
20040 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
20041 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
20042 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
20043 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
20044 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
20045
20046 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20047
20048 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
20049
20050 @subsubheading Example
20051
20052 @smallexample
20053 (gdb)
20054 111-exec-continue
20055 111^running
20056
20057 (gdb)
20058 222-exec-interrupt
20059 222^done
20060 (gdb)
20061 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
20062 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20063 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
20064 (gdb)
20065
20066 (gdb)
20067 -exec-interrupt
20068 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
20069 (gdb)
20070 @end smallexample
20071
20072
20073 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
20074 @findex -exec-next
20075
20076 @subsubheading Synopsis
20077
20078 @smallexample
20079 -exec-next
20080 @end smallexample
20081
20082 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
20083 of the next source line is reached.
20084
20085 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20086
20087 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
20088
20089 @subsubheading Example
20090
20091 @smallexample
20092 -exec-next
20093 ^running
20094 (gdb)
20095 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
20096 (gdb)
20097 @end smallexample
20098
20099
20100 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
20101 @findex -exec-next-instruction
20102
20103 @subsubheading Synopsis
20104
20105 @smallexample
20106 -exec-next-instruction
20107 @end smallexample
20108
20109 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
20110 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
20111 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
20112 printed as well.
20113
20114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20115
20116 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
20117
20118 @subsubheading Example
20119
20120 @smallexample
20121 (gdb)
20122 -exec-next-instruction
20123 ^running
20124
20125 (gdb)
20126 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20127 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
20128 (gdb)
20129 @end smallexample
20130
20131
20132 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
20133 @findex -exec-return
20134
20135 @subsubheading Synopsis
20136
20137 @smallexample
20138 -exec-return
20139 @end smallexample
20140
20141 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
20142 Displays the new current frame.
20143
20144 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20145
20146 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
20147
20148 @subsubheading Example
20149
20150 @smallexample
20151 (gdb)
20152 200-break-insert callee4
20153 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
20154 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20155 (gdb)
20156 000-exec-run
20157 000^running
20158 (gdb)
20159 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20160 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20161 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20162 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
20163 (gdb)
20164 205-break-delete
20165 205^done
20166 (gdb)
20167 111-exec-return
20168 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
20169 args=[@{name="strarg",
20170 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20171 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20172 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20173 (gdb)
20174 @end smallexample
20175
20176
20177 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
20178 @findex -exec-run
20179
20180 @subsubheading Synopsis
20181
20182 @smallexample
20183 -exec-run
20184 @end smallexample
20185
20186 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
20187 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
20188 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
20189 the program has exited exceptionally.
20190
20191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20192
20193 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
20194
20195 @subsubheading Examples
20196
20197 @smallexample
20198 (gdb)
20199 -break-insert main
20200 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20201 (gdb)
20202 -exec-run
20203 ^running
20204 (gdb)
20205 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
20206 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20207 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
20208 (gdb)
20209 @end smallexample
20210
20211 @noindent
20212 Program exited normally:
20213
20214 @smallexample
20215 (gdb)
20216 -exec-run
20217 ^running
20218 (gdb)
20219 x = 55
20220 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
20221 (gdb)
20222 @end smallexample
20223
20224 @noindent
20225 Program exited exceptionally:
20226
20227 @smallexample
20228 (gdb)
20229 -exec-run
20230 ^running
20231 (gdb)
20232 x = 55
20233 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
20234 (gdb)
20235 @end smallexample
20236
20237 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
20238 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
20239
20240 @smallexample
20241 (gdb)
20242 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
20243 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
20244 @end smallexample
20245
20246
20247 @c @subheading -exec-signal
20248
20249
20250 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
20251 @findex -exec-step
20252
20253 @subsubheading Synopsis
20254
20255 @smallexample
20256 -exec-step
20257 @end smallexample
20258
20259 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
20260 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
20261 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
20262 function.
20263
20264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20265
20266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
20267
20268 @subsubheading Example
20269
20270 Stepping into a function:
20271
20272 @smallexample
20273 -exec-step
20274 ^running
20275 (gdb)
20276 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20277 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
20278 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
20279 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
20280 (gdb)
20281 @end smallexample
20282
20283 Regular stepping:
20284
20285 @smallexample
20286 -exec-step
20287 ^running
20288 (gdb)
20289 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
20290 (gdb)
20291 @end smallexample
20292
20293
20294 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
20295 @findex -exec-step-instruction
20296
20297 @subsubheading Synopsis
20298
20299 @smallexample
20300 -exec-step-instruction
20301 @end smallexample
20302
20303 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
20304 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
20305 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
20306 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
20307 well.
20308
20309 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20310
20311 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
20312
20313 @subsubheading Example
20314
20315 @smallexample
20316 (gdb)
20317 -exec-step-instruction
20318 ^running
20319
20320 (gdb)
20321 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20322 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20323 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20324 (gdb)
20325 -exec-step-instruction
20326 ^running
20327
20328 (gdb)
20329 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
20330 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
20331 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
20332 (gdb)
20333 @end smallexample
20334
20335
20336 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
20337 @findex -exec-until
20338
20339 @subsubheading Synopsis
20340
20341 @smallexample
20342 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
20343 @end smallexample
20344
20345 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
20346 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
20347 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
20348 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
20349
20350 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20351
20352 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
20353
20354 @subsubheading Example
20355
20356 @smallexample
20357 (gdb)
20358 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
20359 ^running
20360 (gdb)
20361 x = 55
20362 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
20363 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
20364 (gdb)
20365 @end smallexample
20366
20367 @ignore
20368 @subheading -file-clear
20369 Is this going away????
20370 @end ignore
20371
20372 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20373 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
20374 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
20375
20376
20377 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
20378 @findex -stack-info-frame
20379
20380 @subsubheading Synopsis
20381
20382 @smallexample
20383 -stack-info-frame
20384 @end smallexample
20385
20386 Get info on the selected frame.
20387
20388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20389
20390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
20391 (without arguments).
20392
20393 @subsubheading Example
20394
20395 @smallexample
20396 (gdb)
20397 -stack-info-frame
20398 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
20399 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20400 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
20401 (gdb)
20402 @end smallexample
20403
20404 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
20405 @findex -stack-info-depth
20406
20407 @subsubheading Synopsis
20408
20409 @smallexample
20410 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
20411 @end smallexample
20412
20413 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
20414 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
20415
20416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20417
20418 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20419
20420 @subsubheading Example
20421
20422 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
20423
20424 @smallexample
20425 (gdb)
20426 -stack-info-depth
20427 ^done,depth="12"
20428 (gdb)
20429 -stack-info-depth 4
20430 ^done,depth="4"
20431 (gdb)
20432 -stack-info-depth 12
20433 ^done,depth="12"
20434 (gdb)
20435 -stack-info-depth 11
20436 ^done,depth="11"
20437 (gdb)
20438 -stack-info-depth 13
20439 ^done,depth="12"
20440 (gdb)
20441 @end smallexample
20442
20443 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
20444 @findex -stack-list-arguments
20445
20446 @subsubheading Synopsis
20447
20448 @smallexample
20449 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
20450 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
20451 @end smallexample
20452
20453 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
20454 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
20455 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
20456 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
20457 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
20458 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
20459 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
20460 which case only existing frames will be returned.
20461
20462 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
20463 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
20464 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
20465
20466 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20467
20468 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
20469 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
20470 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
20471
20472 @subsubheading Example
20473
20474 @smallexample
20475 (gdb)
20476 -stack-list-frames
20477 ^done,
20478 stack=[
20479 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20480 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20481 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
20482 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
20483 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20484 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
20485 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
20486 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20487 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
20488 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
20489 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20490 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
20491 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
20492 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20493 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
20494 (gdb)
20495 -stack-list-arguments 0
20496 ^done,
20497 stack-args=[
20498 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
20499 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
20500 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
20501 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
20502 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
20503 (gdb)
20504 -stack-list-arguments 1
20505 ^done,
20506 stack-args=[
20507 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
20508 frame=@{level="1",
20509 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
20510 frame=@{level="2",args=[
20511 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20512 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
20513 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
20514 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20515 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
20516 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
20517 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
20518 (gdb)
20519 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
20520 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
20521 (gdb)
20522 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
20523 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
20524 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
20525 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
20526 (gdb)
20527 @end smallexample
20528
20529 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
20530
20531
20532 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
20533 @findex -stack-list-frames
20534
20535 @subsubheading Synopsis
20536
20537 @smallexample
20538 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
20539 @end smallexample
20540
20541 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
20542 following info:
20543
20544 @table @samp
20545 @item @var{level}
20546 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
20547 @item @var{addr}
20548 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
20549 @item @var{func}
20550 Function name.
20551 @item @var{file}
20552 File name of the source file where the function lives.
20553 @item @var{line}
20554 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
20555 @end table
20556
20557 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
20558 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
20559 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
20560 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
20561 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
20562 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
20563 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
20564
20565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20566
20567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
20568
20569 @subsubheading Example
20570
20571 Full stack backtrace:
20572
20573 @smallexample
20574 (gdb)
20575 -stack-list-frames
20576 ^done,stack=
20577 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
20578 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
20579 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20580 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20581 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20582 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20583 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20584 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20585 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20586 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20587 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20588 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20589 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20590 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20591 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20592 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20593 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20594 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20595 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20596 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20597 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20598 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20599 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
20600 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
20601 (gdb)
20602 @end smallexample
20603
20604 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
20605
20606 @smallexample
20607 (gdb)
20608 -stack-list-frames 3 5
20609 ^done,stack=
20610 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20611 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20612 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20613 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
20614 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20615 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
20616 (gdb)
20617 @end smallexample
20618
20619 Show a single frame:
20620
20621 @smallexample
20622 (gdb)
20623 -stack-list-frames 3 3
20624 ^done,stack=
20625 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
20626 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
20627 (gdb)
20628 @end smallexample
20629
20630
20631 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
20632 @findex -stack-list-locals
20633
20634 @subsubheading Synopsis
20635
20636 @smallexample
20637 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
20638 @end smallexample
20639
20640 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
20641 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
20642 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
20643 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
20644 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
20645 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
20646 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
20647 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
20648 more detail.
20649
20650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20651
20652 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
20653
20654 @subsubheading Example
20655
20656 @smallexample
20657 (gdb)
20658 -stack-list-locals 0
20659 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
20660 (gdb)
20661 -stack-list-locals --all-values
20662 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
20663 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
20664 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
20665 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
20666 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
20667 (gdb)
20668 @end smallexample
20669
20670
20671 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
20672 @findex -stack-select-frame
20673
20674 @subsubheading Synopsis
20675
20676 @smallexample
20677 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
20678 @end smallexample
20679
20680 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
20681 the stack.
20682
20683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20684
20685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
20686 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
20687
20688 @subsubheading Example
20689
20690 @smallexample
20691 (gdb)
20692 -stack-select-frame 2
20693 ^done
20694 (gdb)
20695 @end smallexample
20696
20697 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20698 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
20699 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
20700
20701 @ignore
20702
20703 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20704
20705 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
20706 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
20707 used by @code{Insight}.
20708
20709 The two main reasons for that are:
20710
20711 @enumerate 1
20712 @item
20713 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
20714
20715 @item
20716 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
20717 now).
20718 @end enumerate
20719
20720 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
20721 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
20722 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
20723 hints about their use.
20724
20725 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
20726 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
20727 least, the following operations:
20728
20729 @itemize @bullet
20730 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
20731 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
20732 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
20733 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
20734 @end itemize
20735
20736 @end ignore
20737
20738 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
20739
20740 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
20741
20742 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
20743 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
20744 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
20745 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
20746 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
20747 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
20748 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
20749 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
20750 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
20751 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
20752 object, or to change display format.
20753
20754 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
20755 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
20756 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
20757 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
20758 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
20759 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
20760 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
20761 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
20762 child will be created.
20763
20764 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
20765 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
20766 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
20767 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
20768 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
20769
20770 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
20771 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
20772 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
20773 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
20774 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
20775 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
20776 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
20777 variables that frontend has created.
20778
20779 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
20780 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
20781 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
20782 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
20783 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
20784 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
20785 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
20786 implicitly updated.
20787
20788 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
20789 access this functionality:
20790
20791 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
20792 @item @strong{Operation}
20793 @tab @strong{Description}
20794
20795 @item @code{-var-create}
20796 @tab create a variable object
20797 @item @code{-var-delete}
20798 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
20799 @item @code{-var-set-format}
20800 @tab set the display format of this variable
20801 @item @code{-var-show-format}
20802 @tab show the display format of this variable
20803 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
20804 @tab tells how many children this object has
20805 @item @code{-var-list-children}
20806 @tab return a list of the object's children
20807 @item @code{-var-info-type}
20808 @tab show the type of this variable object
20809 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
20810 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
20811 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
20812 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
20813 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
20814 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
20815 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
20816 @tab get the value of this variable
20817 @item @code{-var-assign}
20818 @tab set the value of this variable
20819 @item @code{-var-update}
20820 @tab update the variable and its children
20821 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
20822 @tab set frozeness attribute
20823 @end multitable
20824
20825 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
20826 how it can be used.
20827
20828 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
20829
20830 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
20831 @findex -var-create
20832
20833 @subsubheading Synopsis
20834
20835 @smallexample
20836 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
20837 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
20838 @end smallexample
20839
20840 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
20841 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
20842 register.
20843
20844 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
20845 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
20846 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
20847 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
20848 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
20849
20850 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
20851 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
20852 frame should be used.
20853
20854 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
20855 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
20856
20857 @itemize @bullet
20858 @item
20859 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
20860
20861 @item
20862 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
20863
20864 @item
20865 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
20866 @end itemize
20867
20868 @subsubheading Result
20869
20870 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
20871 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
20872 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
20873
20874 @smallexample
20875 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
20876 @end smallexample
20877
20878
20879 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
20880 @findex -var-delete
20881
20882 @subsubheading Synopsis
20883
20884 @smallexample
20885 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
20886 @end smallexample
20887
20888 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
20889 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
20890
20891 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
20892
20893
20894 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
20895 @findex -var-set-format
20896
20897 @subsubheading Synopsis
20898
20899 @smallexample
20900 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
20901 @end smallexample
20902
20903 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
20904 @var{format-spec}.
20905
20906 @anchor{-var-set-format}
20907 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
20908
20909 @smallexample
20910 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
20911 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
20912 @end smallexample
20913
20914 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
20915 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
20916 for pointers, etc.).
20917
20918 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
20919 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
20920
20921 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
20922 @findex -var-show-format
20923
20924 @subsubheading Synopsis
20925
20926 @smallexample
20927 -var-show-format @var{name}
20928 @end smallexample
20929
20930 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
20931
20932 @smallexample
20933 @var{format} @expansion{}
20934 @var{format-spec}
20935 @end smallexample
20936
20937
20938 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
20939 @findex -var-info-num-children
20940
20941 @subsubheading Synopsis
20942
20943 @smallexample
20944 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
20945 @end smallexample
20946
20947 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
20948
20949 @smallexample
20950 numchild=@var{n}
20951 @end smallexample
20952
20953
20954 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
20955 @findex -var-list-children
20956
20957 @subsubheading Synopsis
20958
20959 @smallexample
20960 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
20961 @end smallexample
20962 @anchor{-var-list-children}
20963
20964 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
20965 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
20966 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
20967 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
20968 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
20969 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
20970 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
20971 and unions.
20972
20973 @subsubheading Example
20974
20975 @smallexample
20976 (gdb)
20977 -var-list-children n
20978 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20979 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20980 (gdb)
20981 -var-list-children --all-values n
20982 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
20983 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
20984 @end smallexample
20985
20986
20987 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
20988 @findex -var-info-type
20989
20990 @subsubheading Synopsis
20991
20992 @smallexample
20993 -var-info-type @var{name}
20994 @end smallexample
20995
20996 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
20997 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
20998 @value{GDBN} CLI:
20999
21000 @smallexample
21001 type=@var{typename}
21002 @end smallexample
21003
21004
21005 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
21006 @findex -var-info-expression
21007
21008 @subsubheading Synopsis
21009
21010 @smallexample
21011 -var-info-expression @var{name}
21012 @end smallexample
21013
21014 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
21015 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
21016 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
21017
21018 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
21019 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
21020
21021 @smallexample
21022 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
21023 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
21024 @end smallexample
21025
21026 @noindent
21027 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
21028
21029 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
21030 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
21031 is of limited use.
21032
21033 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
21034 @findex -var-info-path-expression
21035
21036 @subsubheading Synopsis
21037
21038 @smallexample
21039 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
21040 @end smallexample
21041
21042 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
21043 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
21044 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
21045 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
21046 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
21047 watchpoint from a variable object.
21048
21049 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
21050 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
21051 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
21052 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
21053 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
21054 @smallexample
21055 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
21056 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
21057 @end smallexample
21058
21059 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
21060 @findex -var-show-attributes
21061
21062 @subsubheading Synopsis
21063
21064 @smallexample
21065 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
21066 @end smallexample
21067
21068 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
21069
21070 @smallexample
21071 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
21072 @end smallexample
21073
21074 @noindent
21075 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
21076
21077 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
21078 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
21079
21080 @subsubheading Synopsis
21081
21082 @smallexample
21083 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
21084 @end smallexample
21085
21086 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
21087 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
21088 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
21089 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
21090 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
21091 the current display format will be used. The current display format
21092 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
21093
21094 @smallexample
21095 value=@var{value}
21096 @end smallexample
21097
21098 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
21099 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
21100
21101 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
21102 @findex -var-assign
21103
21104 @subsubheading Synopsis
21105
21106 @smallexample
21107 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
21108 @end smallexample
21109
21110 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
21111 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
21112 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
21113 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
21114
21115 @subsubheading Example
21116
21117 @smallexample
21118 (gdb)
21119 -var-assign var1 3
21120 ^done,value="3"
21121 (gdb)
21122 -var-update *
21123 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
21124 (gdb)
21125 @end smallexample
21126
21127 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
21128 @findex -var-update
21129
21130 @subsubheading Synopsis
21131
21132 @smallexample
21133 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
21134 @end smallexample
21135
21136 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
21137 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
21138 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
21139 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
21140 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
21141 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
21142 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
21143 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
21144 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
21145 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
21146 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
21147 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
21148 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
21149
21150
21151 @subsubheading Example
21152
21153 @smallexample
21154 (gdb)
21155 -var-assign var1 3
21156 ^done,value="3"
21157 (gdb)
21158 -var-update --all-values var1
21159 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
21160 type_changed="false"@}]
21161 (gdb)
21162 @end smallexample
21163
21164 @anchor{-var-update}
21165 The field in_scope may take three values:
21166
21167 @table @code
21168 @item "true"
21169 The variable object's current value is valid.
21170
21171 @item "false"
21172 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
21173 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
21174 scope.
21175
21176 @item "invalid"
21177 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
21178 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
21179 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
21180 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
21181 objects.
21182 @end table
21183
21184 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
21185 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
21186
21187 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
21188 @findex -var-set-frozen
21189 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
21190
21191 @subsubheading Synopsis
21192
21193 @smallexample
21194 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
21195 @end smallexample
21196
21197 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
21198 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
21199 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
21200 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
21201 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
21202 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
21203 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
21204 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
21205 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
21206 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
21207 @code{-var-update} does.
21208
21209 @subsubheading Example
21210
21211 @smallexample
21212 (gdb)
21213 -var-set-frozen V 1
21214 ^done
21215 (gdb)
21216 @end smallexample
21217
21218
21219 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21220 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
21221 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
21222
21223 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
21224 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
21225 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
21226 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
21227
21228 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
21229 @c @subheading -data-assign
21230 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
21231 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
21232 @c set variable
21233 @c @subsubheading Example
21234 @c N.A.
21235
21236 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
21237 @findex -data-disassemble
21238
21239 @subsubheading Synopsis
21240
21241 @smallexample
21242 -data-disassemble
21243 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
21244 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
21245 -- @var{mode}
21246 @end smallexample
21247
21248 @noindent
21249 Where:
21250
21251 @table @samp
21252 @item @var{start-addr}
21253 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
21254 @item @var{end-addr}
21255 is the end address
21256 @item @var{filename}
21257 is the name of the file to disassemble
21258 @item @var{linenum}
21259 is the line number to disassemble around
21260 @item @var{lines}
21261 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
21262 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
21263 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
21264 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
21265 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
21266 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
21267 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
21268 are displayed.
21269 @item @var{mode}
21270 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
21271 disassembly).
21272 @end table
21273
21274 @subsubheading Result
21275
21276 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
21277
21278 @itemize @bullet
21279 @item Address
21280 @item Func-name
21281 @item Offset
21282 @item Instruction
21283 @end itemize
21284
21285 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
21286 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
21287
21288 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21289
21290 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
21291
21292 @subsubheading Example
21293
21294 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
21295
21296 @smallexample
21297 (gdb)
21298 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
21299 ^done,
21300 asm_insns=[
21301 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21302 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21303 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21304 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21305 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
21306 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
21307 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
21308 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21309 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
21310 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
21311 (gdb)
21312 @end smallexample
21313
21314 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
21315 @code{main}.
21316
21317 @smallexample
21318 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
21319 ^done,asm_insns=[
21320 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21321 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
21322 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21323 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21324 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21325 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
21326 [@dots{}]
21327 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
21328 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
21329 (gdb)
21330 @end smallexample
21331
21332 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
21333
21334 @smallexample
21335 (gdb)
21336 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
21337 ^done,asm_insns=[
21338 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21339 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
21340 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21341 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21342 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21343 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
21344 (gdb)
21345 @end smallexample
21346
21347 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
21348
21349 @smallexample
21350 (gdb)
21351 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
21352 ^done,asm_insns=[
21353 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
21354 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
21355 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
21356 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
21357 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
21358 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
21359 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
21360 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
21361 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
21362 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
21363 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
21364 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
21365 (gdb)
21366 @end smallexample
21367
21368
21369 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
21370 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
21371
21372 @subsubheading Synopsis
21373
21374 @smallexample
21375 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
21376 @end smallexample
21377
21378 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
21379 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
21380 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
21381
21382 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21383
21384 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
21385 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
21386 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
21387
21388 @subsubheading Example
21389
21390 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
21391 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
21392 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
21393 output.
21394
21395 @smallexample
21396 211-data-evaluate-expression A
21397 211^done,value="1"
21398 (gdb)
21399 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
21400 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
21401 (gdb)
21402 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
21403 411^done,value="4"
21404 (gdb)
21405 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
21406 511^done,value="4"
21407 (gdb)
21408 @end smallexample
21409
21410
21411 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
21412 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
21413
21414 @subsubheading Synopsis
21415
21416 @smallexample
21417 -data-list-changed-registers
21418 @end smallexample
21419
21420 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
21421
21422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21423
21424 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
21425 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
21426
21427 @subsubheading Example
21428
21429 On a PPC MBX board:
21430
21431 @smallexample
21432 (gdb)
21433 -exec-continue
21434 ^running
21435
21436 (gdb)
21437 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
21438 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
21439 line="5"@}
21440 (gdb)
21441 -data-list-changed-registers
21442 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
21443 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
21444 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
21445 (gdb)
21446 @end smallexample
21447
21448
21449 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
21450 @findex -data-list-register-names
21451
21452 @subsubheading Synopsis
21453
21454 @smallexample
21455 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
21456 @end smallexample
21457
21458 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
21459 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
21460 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
21461 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
21462 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
21463 include empty register names.
21464
21465 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21466
21467 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
21468 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
21469 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
21470
21471 @subsubheading Example
21472
21473 For the PPC MBX board:
21474 @smallexample
21475 (gdb)
21476 -data-list-register-names
21477 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
21478 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
21479 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
21480 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
21481 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
21482 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
21483 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
21484 (gdb)
21485 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
21486 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
21487 (gdb)
21488 @end smallexample
21489
21490 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
21491 @findex -data-list-register-values
21492
21493 @subsubheading Synopsis
21494
21495 @smallexample
21496 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
21497 @end smallexample
21498
21499 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
21500 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
21501 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
21502 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
21503
21504 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
21505
21506 @table @code
21507 @item x
21508 Hexadecimal
21509 @item o
21510 Octal
21511 @item t
21512 Binary
21513 @item d
21514 Decimal
21515 @item r
21516 Raw
21517 @item N
21518 Natural
21519 @end table
21520
21521 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21522
21523 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
21524 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
21525
21526 @subsubheading Example
21527
21528 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
21529 don't appear in the actual output):
21530
21531 @smallexample
21532 (gdb)
21533 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
21534 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
21535 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
21536 (gdb)
21537 -data-list-register-values x
21538 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
21539 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
21540 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
21541 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
21542 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
21543 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
21544 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
21545 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
21546 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
21547 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
21548 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
21549 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
21550 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
21551 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
21552 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
21553 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
21554 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
21555 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
21556 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
21557 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
21558 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
21559 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
21560 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
21561 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
21562 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
21563 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
21564 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
21565 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
21566 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
21567 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
21568 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
21569 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
21570 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
21571 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
21572 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
21573 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
21574 (gdb)
21575 @end smallexample
21576
21577
21578 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
21579 @findex -data-read-memory
21580
21581 @subsubheading Synopsis
21582
21583 @smallexample
21584 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
21585 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
21586 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
21587 @end smallexample
21588
21589 @noindent
21590 where:
21591
21592 @table @samp
21593 @item @var{address}
21594 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
21595 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
21596 quoted using the C convention.
21597
21598 @item @var{word-format}
21599 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
21600 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
21601 ,Output Formats}).
21602
21603 @item @var{word-size}
21604 The size of each memory word in bytes.
21605
21606 @item @var{nr-rows}
21607 The number of rows in the output table.
21608
21609 @item @var{nr-cols}
21610 The number of columns in the output table.
21611
21612 @item @var{aschar}
21613 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
21614 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
21615 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
21616 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
21617
21618 @item @var{byte-offset}
21619 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
21620 @end table
21621
21622 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
21623 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
21624 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
21625 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
21626 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
21627 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
21628 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
21629 @samp{addr}.
21630
21631 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
21632 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
21633 @samp{prev-page}.
21634
21635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21636
21637 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
21638 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
21639
21640 @subsubheading Example
21641
21642 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
21643 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
21644 word. Display each word in hex.
21645
21646 @smallexample
21647 (gdb)
21648 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
21649 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
21650 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
21651 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
21652 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
21653 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
21654 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
21655 (gdb)
21656 @end smallexample
21657
21658 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
21659 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
21660
21661 @smallexample
21662 (gdb)
21663 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
21664 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
21665 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
21666 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
21667 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
21668 (gdb)
21669 @end smallexample
21670
21671 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
21672 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
21673 used as the non-printable character.
21674
21675 @smallexample
21676 (gdb)
21677 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
21678 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
21679 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
21680 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
21681 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21682 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21683 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21684 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
21685 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
21686 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
21687 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
21688 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
21689 (gdb)
21690 @end smallexample
21691
21692 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21693 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
21694 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
21695
21696 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
21697
21698 @c @subheading -trace-actions
21699
21700 @c @subheading -trace-delete
21701
21702 @c @subheading -trace-disable
21703
21704 @c @subheading -trace-dump
21705
21706 @c @subheading -trace-enable
21707
21708 @c @subheading -trace-exists
21709
21710 @c @subheading -trace-find
21711
21712 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
21713
21714 @c @subheading -trace-info
21715
21716 @c @subheading -trace-insert
21717
21718 @c @subheading -trace-list
21719
21720 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
21721
21722 @c @subheading -trace-save
21723
21724 @c @subheading -trace-start
21725
21726 @c @subheading -trace-stop
21727
21728
21729 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21730 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
21731 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
21732
21733
21734 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
21735 @findex -symbol-info-address
21736
21737 @subsubheading Synopsis
21738
21739 @smallexample
21740 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
21741 @end smallexample
21742
21743 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
21744
21745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21746
21747 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
21748
21749 @subsubheading Example
21750 N.A.
21751
21752
21753 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
21754 @findex -symbol-info-file
21755
21756 @subsubheading Synopsis
21757
21758 @smallexample
21759 -symbol-info-file
21760 @end smallexample
21761
21762 Show the file for the symbol.
21763
21764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21765
21766 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
21767 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
21768
21769 @subsubheading Example
21770 N.A.
21771
21772
21773 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
21774 @findex -symbol-info-function
21775
21776 @subsubheading Synopsis
21777
21778 @smallexample
21779 -symbol-info-function
21780 @end smallexample
21781
21782 Show which function the symbol lives in.
21783
21784 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21785
21786 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
21787
21788 @subsubheading Example
21789 N.A.
21790
21791
21792 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
21793 @findex -symbol-info-line
21794
21795 @subsubheading Synopsis
21796
21797 @smallexample
21798 -symbol-info-line
21799 @end smallexample
21800
21801 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
21802
21803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21804
21805 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
21806 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
21807
21808 @subsubheading Example
21809 N.A.
21810
21811
21812 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
21813 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
21814
21815 @subsubheading Synopsis
21816
21817 @smallexample
21818 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
21819 @end smallexample
21820
21821 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
21822
21823 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21824
21825 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
21826
21827 @subsubheading Example
21828 N.A.
21829
21830
21831 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
21832 @findex -symbol-list-functions
21833
21834 @subsubheading Synopsis
21835
21836 @smallexample
21837 -symbol-list-functions
21838 @end smallexample
21839
21840 List the functions in the executable.
21841
21842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21843
21844 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
21845 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21846
21847 @subsubheading Example
21848 N.A.
21849
21850
21851 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
21852 @findex -symbol-list-lines
21853
21854 @subsubheading Synopsis
21855
21856 @smallexample
21857 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
21858 @end smallexample
21859
21860 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
21861 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
21862 ascending PC order.
21863
21864 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21865
21866 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
21867
21868 @subsubheading Example
21869 @smallexample
21870 (gdb)
21871 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
21872 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
21873 (gdb)
21874 @end smallexample
21875
21876
21877 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
21878 @findex -symbol-list-types
21879
21880 @subsubheading Synopsis
21881
21882 @smallexample
21883 -symbol-list-types
21884 @end smallexample
21885
21886 List all the type names.
21887
21888 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21889
21890 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
21891 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21892
21893 @subsubheading Example
21894 N.A.
21895
21896
21897 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
21898 @findex -symbol-list-variables
21899
21900 @subsubheading Synopsis
21901
21902 @smallexample
21903 -symbol-list-variables
21904 @end smallexample
21905
21906 List all the global and static variable names.
21907
21908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21909
21910 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
21911
21912 @subsubheading Example
21913 N.A.
21914
21915
21916 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
21917 @findex -symbol-locate
21918
21919 @subsubheading Synopsis
21920
21921 @smallexample
21922 -symbol-locate
21923 @end smallexample
21924
21925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21926
21927 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
21928
21929 @subsubheading Example
21930 N.A.
21931
21932
21933 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
21934 @findex -symbol-type
21935
21936 @subsubheading Synopsis
21937
21938 @smallexample
21939 -symbol-type @var{variable}
21940 @end smallexample
21941
21942 Show type of @var{variable}.
21943
21944 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21945
21946 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
21947 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
21948
21949 @subsubheading Example
21950 N.A.
21951
21952
21953 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21954 @node GDB/MI File Commands
21955 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
21956
21957 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
21958 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
21959
21960 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
21961 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
21962
21963 @subsubheading Synopsis
21964
21965 @smallexample
21966 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
21967 @end smallexample
21968
21969 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
21970 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
21971 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
21972 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
21973 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
21974 notification.
21975
21976 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21977
21978 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
21979
21980 @subsubheading Example
21981
21982 @smallexample
21983 (gdb)
21984 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21985 ^done
21986 (gdb)
21987 @end smallexample
21988
21989
21990 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
21991 @findex -file-exec-file
21992
21993 @subsubheading Synopsis
21994
21995 @smallexample
21996 -file-exec-file @var{file}
21997 @end smallexample
21998
21999 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
22000 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
22001 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
22002 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
22003 notification.
22004
22005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22006
22007 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
22008
22009 @subsubheading Example
22010
22011 @smallexample
22012 (gdb)
22013 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22014 ^done
22015 (gdb)
22016 @end smallexample
22017
22018
22019 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
22020 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
22021
22022 @subsubheading Synopsis
22023
22024 @smallexample
22025 -file-list-exec-sections
22026 @end smallexample
22027
22028 List the sections of the current executable file.
22029
22030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22031
22032 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
22033 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
22034 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
22035
22036 @subsubheading Example
22037 N.A.
22038
22039
22040 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
22041 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
22042
22043 @subsubheading Synopsis
22044
22045 @smallexample
22046 -file-list-exec-source-file
22047 @end smallexample
22048
22049 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
22050 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
22051 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
22052 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
22053
22054 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22055
22056 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
22057
22058 @subsubheading Example
22059
22060 @smallexample
22061 (gdb)
22062 123-file-list-exec-source-file
22063 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
22064 (gdb)
22065 @end smallexample
22066
22067
22068 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
22069 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
22070
22071 @subsubheading Synopsis
22072
22073 @smallexample
22074 -file-list-exec-source-files
22075 @end smallexample
22076
22077 List the source files for the current executable.
22078
22079 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
22080 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
22081
22082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22083
22084 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
22085 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
22086
22087 @subsubheading Example
22088 @smallexample
22089 (gdb)
22090 -file-list-exec-source-files
22091 ^done,files=[
22092 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
22093 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
22094 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
22095 (gdb)
22096 @end smallexample
22097
22098 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
22099 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
22100
22101 @subsubheading Synopsis
22102
22103 @smallexample
22104 -file-list-shared-libraries
22105 @end smallexample
22106
22107 List the shared libraries in the program.
22108
22109 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22110
22111 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
22112
22113 @subsubheading Example
22114 N.A.
22115
22116
22117 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
22118 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
22119
22120 @subsubheading Synopsis
22121
22122 @smallexample
22123 -file-list-symbol-files
22124 @end smallexample
22125
22126 List symbol files.
22127
22128 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22129
22130 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
22131
22132 @subsubheading Example
22133 N.A.
22134
22135
22136 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
22137 @findex -file-symbol-file
22138
22139 @subsubheading Synopsis
22140
22141 @smallexample
22142 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
22143 @end smallexample
22144
22145 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
22146 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
22147 produced, except for a completion notification.
22148
22149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22150
22151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
22152
22153 @subsubheading Example
22154
22155 @smallexample
22156 (gdb)
22157 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
22158 ^done
22159 (gdb)
22160 @end smallexample
22161
22162 @ignore
22163 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22164 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
22165 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
22166
22167 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
22168
22169 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
22170
22171 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
22172
22173 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
22174
22175 @c @subheading -overlay-map
22176
22177 @c @subheading -overlay-off
22178
22179 @c @subheading -overlay-on
22180
22181 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
22182
22183 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22184 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
22185 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
22186
22187 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
22188
22189 @c @subheading -signal-handle
22190
22191 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
22192
22193 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
22194 @end ignore
22195
22196
22197 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22198 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
22199 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
22200
22201
22202 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
22203 @findex -target-attach
22204
22205 @subsubheading Synopsis
22206
22207 @smallexample
22208 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
22209 @end smallexample
22210
22211 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
22212
22213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22214
22215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
22216
22217 @subsubheading Example
22218 @smallexample
22219 (gdb)
22220 -target-attach 34
22221 =thread-created,id="1"
22222 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
22223 ^done
22224 (gdb)
22225 @end smallexample
22226
22227 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
22228 @findex -target-compare-sections
22229
22230 @subsubheading Synopsis
22231
22232 @smallexample
22233 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
22234 @end smallexample
22235
22236 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
22237 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
22238
22239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22240
22241 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
22242
22243 @subsubheading Example
22244 N.A.
22245
22246
22247 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
22248 @findex -target-detach
22249
22250 @subsubheading Synopsis
22251
22252 @smallexample
22253 -target-detach
22254 @end smallexample
22255
22256 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
22257 There's no output.
22258
22259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22260
22261 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
22262
22263 @subsubheading Example
22264
22265 @smallexample
22266 (gdb)
22267 -target-detach
22268 ^done
22269 (gdb)
22270 @end smallexample
22271
22272
22273 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
22274 @findex -target-disconnect
22275
22276 @subsubheading Synopsis
22277
22278 @smallexample
22279 -target-disconnect
22280 @end smallexample
22281
22282 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
22283 generally not resumed.
22284
22285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22286
22287 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
22288
22289 @subsubheading Example
22290
22291 @smallexample
22292 (gdb)
22293 -target-disconnect
22294 ^done
22295 (gdb)
22296 @end smallexample
22297
22298
22299 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
22300 @findex -target-download
22301
22302 @subsubheading Synopsis
22303
22304 @smallexample
22305 -target-download
22306 @end smallexample
22307
22308 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
22309 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
22310
22311 @table @samp
22312 @item section
22313 The name of the section.
22314 @item section-sent
22315 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
22316 @item section-size
22317 The size of the section.
22318 @item total-sent
22319 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
22320 @item total-size
22321 The size of the overall executable to download.
22322 @end table
22323
22324 @noindent
22325 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
22326 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
22327
22328 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
22329 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
22330
22331 @table @samp
22332 @item section
22333 The name of the section.
22334 @item section-size
22335 The size of the section.
22336 @item total-size
22337 The size of the overall executable to download.
22338 @end table
22339
22340 @noindent
22341 At the end, a summary is printed.
22342
22343 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22344
22345 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
22346
22347 @subsubheading Example
22348
22349 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
22350 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
22351
22352 @smallexample
22353 (gdb)
22354 -target-download
22355 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
22356 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
22357 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
22358 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
22359 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
22360 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
22361 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
22362 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
22363 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
22364 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
22365 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
22366 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
22367 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
22368 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
22369 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
22370 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
22371 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
22372 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
22373 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
22374 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
22375 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
22376 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
22377 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
22378 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
22379 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
22380 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
22381 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
22382 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
22383 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
22384 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
22385 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
22386 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
22387 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
22388 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
22389 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
22390 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
22391 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
22392 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
22393 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
22394 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
22395 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
22396 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
22397 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
22398 write-rate="429"
22399 (gdb)
22400 @end smallexample
22401
22402
22403 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
22404 @findex -target-exec-status
22405
22406 @subsubheading Synopsis
22407
22408 @smallexample
22409 -target-exec-status
22410 @end smallexample
22411
22412 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
22413 not, for instance).
22414
22415 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22416
22417 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
22418
22419 @subsubheading Example
22420 N.A.
22421
22422
22423 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
22424 @findex -target-list-available-targets
22425
22426 @subsubheading Synopsis
22427
22428 @smallexample
22429 -target-list-available-targets
22430 @end smallexample
22431
22432 List the possible targets to connect to.
22433
22434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22435
22436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
22437
22438 @subsubheading Example
22439 N.A.
22440
22441
22442 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
22443 @findex -target-list-current-targets
22444
22445 @subsubheading Synopsis
22446
22447 @smallexample
22448 -target-list-current-targets
22449 @end smallexample
22450
22451 Describe the current target.
22452
22453 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22454
22455 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
22456 other things).
22457
22458 @subsubheading Example
22459 N.A.
22460
22461
22462 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
22463 @findex -target-list-parameters
22464
22465 @subsubheading Synopsis
22466
22467 @smallexample
22468 -target-list-parameters
22469 @end smallexample
22470
22471 @c ????
22472
22473 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22474
22475 No equivalent.
22476
22477 @subsubheading Example
22478 N.A.
22479
22480
22481 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
22482 @findex -target-select
22483
22484 @subsubheading Synopsis
22485
22486 @smallexample
22487 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
22488 @end smallexample
22489
22490 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
22491
22492 @table @samp
22493 @item @var{type}
22494 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
22495 @item @var{parameters}
22496 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
22497 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
22498 @end table
22499
22500 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
22501 which the target program is, in the following form:
22502
22503 @smallexample
22504 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
22505 args=[@var{arg list}]
22506 @end smallexample
22507
22508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22509
22510 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
22511
22512 @subsubheading Example
22513
22514 @smallexample
22515 (gdb)
22516 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
22517 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
22518 (gdb)
22519 @end smallexample
22520
22521 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22522 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
22523 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
22524
22525
22526 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
22527 @findex -target-file-put
22528
22529 @subsubheading Synopsis
22530
22531 @smallexample
22532 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
22533 @end smallexample
22534
22535 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
22536 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
22537
22538 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22539
22540 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
22541
22542 @subsubheading Example
22543
22544 @smallexample
22545 (gdb)
22546 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
22547 ^done
22548 (gdb)
22549 @end smallexample
22550
22551
22552 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
22553 @findex -target-file-get
22554
22555 @subsubheading Synopsis
22556
22557 @smallexample
22558 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
22559 @end smallexample
22560
22561 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
22562 on the host system.
22563
22564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22565
22566 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
22567
22568 @subsubheading Example
22569
22570 @smallexample
22571 (gdb)
22572 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
22573 ^done
22574 (gdb)
22575 @end smallexample
22576
22577
22578 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
22579 @findex -target-file-delete
22580
22581 @subsubheading Synopsis
22582
22583 @smallexample
22584 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
22585 @end smallexample
22586
22587 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
22588
22589 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22590
22591 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
22592
22593 @subsubheading Example
22594
22595 @smallexample
22596 (gdb)
22597 -target-file-delete remotefile
22598 ^done
22599 (gdb)
22600 @end smallexample
22601
22602
22603 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22604 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
22605 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
22606
22607 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
22608
22609 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
22610 @findex -gdb-exit
22611
22612 @subsubheading Synopsis
22613
22614 @smallexample
22615 -gdb-exit
22616 @end smallexample
22617
22618 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
22619
22620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22621
22622 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
22623
22624 @subsubheading Example
22625
22626 @smallexample
22627 (gdb)
22628 -gdb-exit
22629 ^exit
22630 @end smallexample
22631
22632
22633 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
22634 @findex -exec-abort
22635
22636 @subsubheading Synopsis
22637
22638 @smallexample
22639 -exec-abort
22640 @end smallexample
22641
22642 Kill the inferior running program.
22643
22644 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22645
22646 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
22647
22648 @subsubheading Example
22649 N.A.
22650
22651
22652 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
22653 @findex -gdb-set
22654
22655 @subsubheading Synopsis
22656
22657 @smallexample
22658 -gdb-set
22659 @end smallexample
22660
22661 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
22662 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
22663
22664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22665
22666 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
22667
22668 @subsubheading Example
22669
22670 @smallexample
22671 (gdb)
22672 -gdb-set $foo=3
22673 ^done
22674 (gdb)
22675 @end smallexample
22676
22677
22678 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
22679 @findex -gdb-show
22680
22681 @subsubheading Synopsis
22682
22683 @smallexample
22684 -gdb-show
22685 @end smallexample
22686
22687 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
22688
22689 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22690
22691 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
22692
22693 @subsubheading Example
22694
22695 @smallexample
22696 (gdb)
22697 -gdb-show annotate
22698 ^done,value="0"
22699 (gdb)
22700 @end smallexample
22701
22702 @c @subheading -gdb-source
22703
22704
22705 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
22706 @findex -gdb-version
22707
22708 @subsubheading Synopsis
22709
22710 @smallexample
22711 -gdb-version
22712 @end smallexample
22713
22714 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
22715
22716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22717
22718 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
22719 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
22720
22721 @subsubheading Example
22722
22723 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
22724 @c box in TeX.
22725 @smallexample
22726 (gdb)
22727 -gdb-version
22728 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
22729 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
22730 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
22731 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
22732 ~ certain conditions.
22733 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
22734 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
22735 ~ details.
22736 ~This GDB was configured as
22737 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
22738 ^done
22739 (gdb)
22740 @end smallexample
22741
22742 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
22743 @findex -list-features
22744
22745 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
22746 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
22747 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
22748 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
22749 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
22750 startup.
22751
22752 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
22753 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
22754 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
22755 is given below.
22756
22757 Example output:
22758
22759 @smallexample
22760 (gdb) -list-features
22761 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
22762 @end smallexample
22763
22764 The current list of features is:
22765
22766 @table @samp
22767 @item frozen-varobjs
22768 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
22769 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
22770 of @code{-varobj-create}.
22771 @item pending-breakpoints
22772 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
22773 @item thread-info
22774 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
22775
22776 @end table
22777
22778 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
22779 @findex -list-target-features
22780
22781 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
22782 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
22783 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
22784 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
22785 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
22786 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
22787 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
22788 Example output:
22789
22790 @smallexample
22791 (gdb) -list-features
22792 ^done,result=["async"]
22793 @end smallexample
22794
22795 The current list of features is:
22796
22797 @table @samp
22798 @item async
22799 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
22800 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
22801 while the target is running.
22802
22803 @end table
22804
22805
22806 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
22807 @findex -interpreter-exec
22808
22809 @subheading Synopsis
22810
22811 @smallexample
22812 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
22813 @end smallexample
22814 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
22815
22816 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
22817
22818 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22819
22820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
22821
22822 @subheading Example
22823
22824 @smallexample
22825 (gdb)
22826 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
22827 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
22828 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
22829 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
22830 ^done
22831 (gdb)
22832 @end smallexample
22833
22834 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
22835 @findex -inferior-tty-set
22836
22837 @subheading Synopsis
22838
22839 @smallexample
22840 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22841 @end smallexample
22842
22843 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
22844
22845 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22846
22847 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
22848
22849 @subheading Example
22850
22851 @smallexample
22852 (gdb)
22853 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22854 ^done
22855 (gdb)
22856 @end smallexample
22857
22858 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
22859 @findex -inferior-tty-show
22860
22861 @subheading Synopsis
22862
22863 @smallexample
22864 -inferior-tty-show
22865 @end smallexample
22866
22867 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
22868
22869 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22870
22871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
22872
22873 @subheading Example
22874
22875 @smallexample
22876 (gdb)
22877 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
22878 ^done
22879 (gdb)
22880 -inferior-tty-show
22881 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
22882 (gdb)
22883 @end smallexample
22884
22885 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
22886 @findex -enable-timings
22887
22888 @subheading Synopsis
22889
22890 @smallexample
22891 -enable-timings [yes | no]
22892 @end smallexample
22893
22894 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
22895 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
22896 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
22897 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
22898
22899 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
22900
22901 No equivalent.
22902
22903 @subheading Example
22904
22905 @smallexample
22906 (gdb)
22907 -enable-timings
22908 ^done
22909 (gdb)
22910 -break-insert main
22911 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
22912 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
22913 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
22914 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
22915 (gdb)
22916 -enable-timings no
22917 ^done
22918 (gdb)
22919 -exec-run
22920 ^running
22921 (gdb)
22922 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
22923 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
22924 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
22925 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
22926 (gdb)
22927 @end smallexample
22928
22929 @node Annotations
22930 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
22931
22932 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
22933 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
22934 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
22935 relatively high level.
22936
22937 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
22938 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
22939
22940 @ignore
22941 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
22942 @end ignore
22943
22944 @menu
22945 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
22946 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
22947 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
22948 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
22949 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
22950 * Annotations for Running::
22951 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
22952 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
22953 @end menu
22954
22955 @node Annotations Overview
22956 @section What is an Annotation?
22957 @cindex annotations
22958
22959 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
22960 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
22961 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
22962 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
22963 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
22964 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
22965 cannot contain newline characters.
22966
22967 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
22968 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
22969 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
22970 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
22971 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
22972 means those three characters as output.
22973
22974 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
22975 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
22976 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
22977 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
22978 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
22979 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
22980 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
22981 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
22982 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
22983
22984 @table @code
22985 @kindex set annotate
22986 @item set annotate @var{level}
22987 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
22988 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
22989
22990 @item show annotate
22991 @kindex show annotate
22992 Show the current annotation level.
22993 @end table
22994
22995 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
22996
22997 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
22998
22999 @smallexample
23000 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
23001 GNU gdb 6.0
23002 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
23003 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
23004 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
23005 under certain conditions.
23006 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
23007 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
23008 for details.
23009 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
23010
23011 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
23012 (@value{GDBP})
23013 ^Z^Zprompt
23014 @kbd{quit}
23015
23016 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
23017 $
23018 @end smallexample
23019
23020 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
23021 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
23022 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
23023 output from @value{GDBN}.
23024
23025 @node Server Prefix
23026 @section The Server Prefix
23027 @cindex server prefix
23028
23029 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
23030 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
23031 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
23032 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
23033 a transparent manner.
23034
23035 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23036 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23037 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23038
23039 @node Prompting
23040 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
23041
23042 @cindex annotations for prompts
23043 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
23044 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
23045 over, etc.
23046
23047 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
23048 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
23049 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
23050 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
23051 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
23052 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
23053 features the following annotations:
23054
23055 @smallexample
23056 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
23057 ^Z^Zprompt
23058 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
23059 @end smallexample
23060
23061 The input types are
23062
23063 @table @code
23064 @findex pre-prompt annotation
23065 @findex prompt annotation
23066 @findex post-prompt annotation
23067 @item prompt
23068 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
23069
23070 @findex pre-commands annotation
23071 @findex commands annotation
23072 @findex post-commands annotation
23073 @item commands
23074 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
23075 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
23076
23077 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
23078 @findex overload-choice annotation
23079 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
23080 @item overload-choice
23081 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
23082
23083 @findex pre-query annotation
23084 @findex query annotation
23085 @findex post-query annotation
23086 @item query
23087 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
23088
23089 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
23090 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
23091 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
23092 @item prompt-for-continue
23093 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
23094 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
23095 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
23096 presence of annotations.
23097 @end table
23098
23099 @node Errors
23100 @section Errors
23101 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
23102
23103 @findex quit annotation
23104 @smallexample
23105 ^Z^Zquit
23106 @end smallexample
23107
23108 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
23109
23110 @findex error annotation
23111 @smallexample
23112 ^Z^Zerror
23113 @end smallexample
23114
23115 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
23116
23117 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
23118 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
23119 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
23120 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
23121 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
23122 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
23123 to the top level.
23124
23125 @findex error-begin annotation
23126 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
23127
23128 @smallexample
23129 ^Z^Zerror-begin
23130 @end smallexample
23131
23132 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
23133 message.
23134
23135 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
23136 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
23137 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
23138
23139 @node Invalidation
23140 @section Invalidation Notices
23141
23142 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
23143 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
23144 changed.
23145
23146 @table @code
23147 @findex frames-invalid annotation
23148 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
23149
23150 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
23151 have changed.
23152
23153 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
23154 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
23155
23156 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
23157 deleted a breakpoint.
23158 @end table
23159
23160 @node Annotations for Running
23161 @section Running the Program
23162 @cindex annotations for running programs
23163
23164 @findex starting annotation
23165 @findex stopping annotation
23166 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
23167 @code{step} or @code{continue},
23168
23169 @smallexample
23170 ^Z^Zstarting
23171 @end smallexample
23172
23173 is output. When the program stops,
23174
23175 @smallexample
23176 ^Z^Zstopped
23177 @end smallexample
23178
23179 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
23180 annotations describe how the program stopped.
23181
23182 @table @code
23183 @findex exited annotation
23184 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
23185 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
23186 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
23187
23188 @findex signalled annotation
23189 @findex signal-name annotation
23190 @findex signal-name-end annotation
23191 @findex signal-string annotation
23192 @findex signal-string-end annotation
23193 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
23194 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
23195 annotation continues:
23196
23197 @smallexample
23198 @var{intro-text}
23199 ^Z^Zsignal-name
23200 @var{name}
23201 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
23202 @var{middle-text}
23203 ^Z^Zsignal-string
23204 @var{string}
23205 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
23206 @var{end-text}
23207 @end smallexample
23208
23209 @noindent
23210 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
23211 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
23212 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
23213 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
23214 user's benefit and have no particular format.
23215
23216 @findex signal annotation
23217 @item ^Z^Zsignal
23218 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
23219 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
23220 terminated with it.
23221
23222 @findex breakpoint annotation
23223 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
23224 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
23225
23226 @findex watchpoint annotation
23227 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
23228 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
23229 @end table
23230
23231 @node Source Annotations
23232 @section Displaying Source
23233 @cindex annotations for source display
23234
23235 @findex source annotation
23236 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
23237
23238 @smallexample
23239 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
23240 @end smallexample
23241
23242 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
23243 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
23244 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
23245 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
23246 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
23247 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
23248 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
23249 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
23250 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
23251 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
23252 depend on the language).
23253
23254 @node GDB Bugs
23255 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
23256 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
23257 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
23258
23259 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
23260
23261 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
23262 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
23263 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
23264 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
23265
23266 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
23267 information that enables us to fix the bug.
23268
23269 @menu
23270 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
23271 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
23272 @end menu
23273
23274 @node Bug Criteria
23275 @section Have You Found a Bug?
23276 @cindex bug criteria
23277
23278 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
23279
23280 @itemize @bullet
23281 @cindex fatal signal
23282 @cindex debugger crash
23283 @cindex crash of debugger
23284 @item
23285 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
23286 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
23287
23288 @cindex error on valid input
23289 @item
23290 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
23291 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
23292 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
23293
23294 @cindex invalid input
23295 @item
23296 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
23297 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
23298 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
23299 for traditional practice''.
23300
23301 @item
23302 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
23303 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
23304 @end itemize
23305
23306 @node Bug Reporting
23307 @section How to Report Bugs
23308 @cindex bug reports
23309 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
23310
23311 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
23312 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
23313 contact that organization first.
23314
23315 You can find contact information for many support companies and
23316 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
23317 distribution.
23318 @c should add a web page ref...
23319
23320 @ifset BUGURL
23321 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
23322 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
23323 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
23324 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
23325 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
23326 be used.
23327
23328 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
23329 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
23330 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
23331 @samp{bug-gdb}.
23332
23333 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
23334 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
23335 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
23336 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
23337 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
23338 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
23339 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
23340 bug reports to the mailing list.
23341 @end ifset
23342 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
23343 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
23344 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
23345 @end ifclear
23346 @end ifset
23347
23348 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
23349 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
23350 fact or leave it out, state it!
23351
23352 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
23353 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
23354 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
23355 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
23356 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
23357 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
23358 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
23359 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
23360 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
23361
23362 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
23363 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
23364 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
23365 self-contained.
23366
23367 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
23368 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
23369 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
23370 bugs properly.
23371
23372 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
23373
23374 @itemize @bullet
23375 @item
23376 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
23377 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
23378 version}.
23379
23380 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
23381 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
23382
23383 @item
23384 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
23385 version number.
23386
23387 @item
23388 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
23389 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
23390
23391 @item
23392 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
23393 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
23394 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
23395 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
23396 those compilers.
23397
23398 @item
23399 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
23400 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
23401 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
23402 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
23403
23404 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
23405 and then we might not encounter the bug.
23406
23407 @item
23408 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
23409 reproduce the bug.
23410
23411 @item
23412 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
23413 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
23414
23415 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
23416 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
23417 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
23418 a chance to make a mistake.
23419
23420 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
23421 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
23422 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
23423 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
23424 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
23425 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
23426 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
23427 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
23428
23429 @pindex script
23430 @cindex recording a session script
23431 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
23432 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
23433 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
23434 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
23435
23436 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
23437 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
23438
23439 @item
23440 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
23441 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
23442 it by context, not by line number.
23443
23444 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
23445 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
23446
23447 @end itemize
23448
23449 Here are some things that are not necessary:
23450
23451 @itemize @bullet
23452 @item
23453 A description of the envelope of the bug.
23454
23455 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
23456 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
23457 changes will not affect it.
23458
23459 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
23460 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
23461 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
23462 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
23463
23464 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
23465 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
23466 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
23467 less time, and so on.
23468
23469 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
23470 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
23471
23472 @item
23473 A patch for the bug.
23474
23475 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
23476 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
23477 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
23478 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
23479
23480 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
23481 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
23482 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
23483 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
23484
23485 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
23486 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
23487 help us to understand.
23488
23489 @item
23490 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
23491
23492 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
23493 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
23494 @end itemize
23495
23496 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
23497 @c and consists of the two following files:
23498 @c rluser.texinfo
23499 @c inc-hist.texinfo
23500 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
23501 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
23502 @include rluser.texi
23503 @include inc-hist.texinfo
23504
23505
23506 @node Formatting Documentation
23507 @appendix Formatting Documentation
23508
23509 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
23510 @cindex reference card
23511 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
23512 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
23513 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
23514 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
23515 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
23516 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
23517
23518 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
23519 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
23520
23521 @smallexample
23522 make refcard.dvi
23523 @end smallexample
23524
23525 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
23526 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
23527 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
23528 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
23529 your @sc{dvi} output program.
23530
23531 @cindex documentation
23532
23533 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
23534 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
23535 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
23536 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
23537 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
23538 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
23539
23540 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
23541 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
23542 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
23543 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
23544 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
23545 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
23546 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
23547 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
23548
23549 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
23550 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
23551 @code{makeinfo}.
23552
23553 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
23554 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
23555 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
23556
23557 @smallexample
23558 cd gdb
23559 make gdb.info
23560 @end smallexample
23561
23562 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
23563 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
23564 Texinfo definitions file.
23565
23566 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
23567 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
23568 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
23569 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
23570 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
23571 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
23572 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
23573
23574 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
23575 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
23576 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
23577 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
23578 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
23579 directory.
23580
23581 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
23582 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
23583 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
23584 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
23585
23586 @smallexample
23587 make gdb.dvi
23588 @end smallexample
23589
23590 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
23591
23592 @node Installing GDB
23593 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
23594 @cindex installation
23595
23596 @menu
23597 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
23598 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
23599 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
23600 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
23601 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
23602 @end menu
23603
23604 @node Requirements
23605 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
23606 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
23607
23608 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
23609 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
23610
23611 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
23612 @table @asis
23613 @item ISO C90 compiler
23614 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
23615 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
23616
23617 @end table
23618
23619 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
23620 @table @asis
23621 @item Expat
23622 @anchor{Expat}
23623 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
23624 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
23625 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
23626 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
23627 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
23628 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
23629
23630 Expat is used for:
23631
23632 @itemize @bullet
23633 @item
23634 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
23635 @item
23636 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
23637 @item
23638 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
23639 @item
23640 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
23641 @end itemize
23642
23643 @item zlib
23644 @cindex compressed debug sections
23645 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
23646 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
23647 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
23648 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
23649 information in such binaries.
23650
23651 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
23652 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
23653 @url{http://zlib.net}.
23654
23655 @end table
23656
23657 @node Running Configure
23658 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
23659 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
23660 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
23661 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
23662 build the @code{gdb} program.
23663 @iftex
23664 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
23665 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
23666 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
23667 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
23668 @end iftex
23669
23670 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
23671 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
23672 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
23673
23674 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
23675 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
23676
23677 @table @code
23678 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
23679 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
23680
23681 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
23682 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
23683
23684 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
23685 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
23686
23687 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
23688 @sc{gnu} include files
23689
23690 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
23691 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
23692
23693 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
23694 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
23695
23696 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
23697 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
23698
23699 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
23700 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
23701
23702 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
23703 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
23704 @end table
23705
23706 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
23707 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
23708 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
23709
23710 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
23711 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
23712 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
23713 argument.
23714
23715 For example:
23716
23717 @smallexample
23718 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23719 ./configure @var{host}
23720 make
23721 @end smallexample
23722
23723 @noindent
23724 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
23725 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
23726 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
23727 correct value by examining your system.)
23728
23729 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
23730 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
23731 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
23732 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
23733
23734 @need 750
23735 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
23736 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
23737 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
23738
23739 @smallexample
23740 sh configure @var{host}
23741 @end smallexample
23742
23743 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
23744 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
23745 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
23746 @file{configure}
23747 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
23748 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
23749
23750 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
23751 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
23752 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
23753 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
23754 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
23755 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
23756 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
23757 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
23758 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23759
23760 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
23761 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
23762 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
23763 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
23764 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
23765
23766 @node Separate Objdir
23767 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
23768
23769 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
23770 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
23771 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
23772 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
23773 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
23774 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
23775 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
23776 program specified there.
23777
23778 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
23779 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
23780 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
23781 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
23782 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
23783 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
23784
23785 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
23786 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
23787
23788 @smallexample
23789 @group
23790 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
23791 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
23792 cd ../gdb-sun4
23793 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
23794 make
23795 @end group
23796 @end smallexample
23797
23798 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
23799 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
23800 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
23801 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
23802 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
23803 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
23804
23805 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
23806 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
23807 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
23808 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
23809 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
23810
23811 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
23812 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
23813 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
23814 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
23815 You specify a cross-debugging target by
23816 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
23817
23818 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
23819 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
23820 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
23821
23822 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
23823 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
23824 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
23825 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
23826 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
23827
23828 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
23829 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
23830 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
23831 with each other.
23832
23833 @node Config Names
23834 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
23835
23836 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
23837 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
23838 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
23839 of information in the following pattern:
23840
23841 @smallexample
23842 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
23843 @end smallexample
23844
23845 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
23846 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
23847 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
23848
23849 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
23850 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
23851 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
23852 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
23853 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
23854 abbreviations---for example:
23855
23856 @smallexample
23857 % sh config.sub i386-linux
23858 i386-pc-linux-gnu
23859 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
23860 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
23861 % sh config.sub hp9k700
23862 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
23863 % sh config.sub sun4
23864 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
23865 % sh config.sub sun3
23866 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
23867 % sh config.sub i986v
23868 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
23869 @end smallexample
23870
23871 @noindent
23872 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
23873 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
23874
23875 @node Configure Options
23876 @section @file{configure} Options
23877
23878 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
23879 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
23880 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
23881 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
23882
23883 @smallexample
23884 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
23885 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23886 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
23887 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
23888 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
23889 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
23890 @var{host}
23891 @end smallexample
23892
23893 @noindent
23894 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
23895 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
23896 @samp{--}.
23897
23898 @table @code
23899 @item --help
23900 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
23901
23902 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
23903 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
23904 @file{@var{dir}}.
23905
23906 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
23907 Configure the source to install programs under directory
23908 @file{@var{dir}}.
23909
23910 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
23911 @need 2000
23912 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
23913 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
23914 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
23915 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
23916 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
23917 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
23918 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
23919 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
23920 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
23921 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
23922 @var{dirname}.
23923
23924 @item --norecursion
23925 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
23926 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
23927
23928 @item --target=@var{target}
23929 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
23930 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
23931 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
23932
23933 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
23934
23935 @item @var{host} @dots{}
23936 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
23937
23938 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
23939 @end table
23940
23941 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
23942 needed for special purposes only.
23943
23944 @node Maintenance Commands
23945 @appendix Maintenance Commands
23946 @cindex maintenance commands
23947 @cindex internal commands
23948
23949 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
23950 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
23951 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
23952 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
23953 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
23954
23955 @table @code
23956 @kindex maint agent
23957 @item maint agent @var{expression}
23958 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
23959 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
23960 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
23961
23962 @kindex maint info breakpoints
23963 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
23964 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
23965 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
23966 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
23967 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
23968 is shown:
23969
23970 @table @code
23971 @item breakpoint
23972 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
23973
23974 @item watchpoint
23975 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
23976
23977 @item longjmp
23978 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
23979 @code{longjmp} calls.
23980
23981 @item longjmp resume
23982 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
23983
23984 @item until
23985 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
23986
23987 @item finish
23988 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
23989
23990 @item shlib events
23991 Shared library events.
23992
23993 @end table
23994
23995 @kindex maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
23996 @kindex maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
23997 @cindex displaced stepping support
23998 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
23999 @item maint set can-use-displaced-stepping
24000 @itemx maint show can-use-displaced-stepping
24001 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
24002 if the target supports it. The default is on. Displaced stepping is
24003 a way to single-step over breakpoints without removing them from the
24004 inferior, by executing an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was
24005 originally at the breakpoint location. It is also known as
24006 out-of-line single-stepping.
24007
24008 @kindex maint check-symtabs
24009 @item maint check-symtabs
24010 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
24011
24012 @kindex maint cplus first_component
24013 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
24014 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
24015
24016 @kindex maint cplus namespace
24017 @item maint cplus namespace
24018 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
24019
24020 @kindex maint demangle
24021 @item maint demangle @var{name}
24022 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
24023
24024 @kindex maint deprecate
24025 @kindex maint undeprecate
24026 @cindex deprecated commands
24027 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
24028 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
24029 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
24030 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
24031 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
24032 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
24033 the replacement as part of the warning.
24034
24035 @kindex maint dump-me
24036 @item maint dump-me
24037 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
24038 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
24039 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
24040 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
24041
24042 @kindex maint internal-error
24043 @kindex maint internal-warning
24044 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
24045 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
24046 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
24047 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
24048 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
24049 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
24050 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
24051 @value{GDBN} session.
24052
24053 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
24054 used as the text of the error or warning message.
24055
24056 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
24057
24058 @smallexample
24059 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
24060 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
24061 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
24062 debugging may prove unreliable.
24063 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
24064 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
24065 (@value{GDBP})
24066 @end smallexample
24067
24068 @kindex maint packet
24069 @item maint packet @var{text}
24070 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
24071 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
24072 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
24073 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
24074 checksum.
24075
24076 @kindex maint print architecture
24077 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24078 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
24079 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
24080
24081 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
24082 @item maint print c-tdesc
24083 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
24084 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
24085 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
24086
24087 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
24088 @item maint print dummy-frames
24089 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
24090
24091 @smallexample
24092 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
24093 @dots{}
24094 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
24095 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
24096 58 return (a + b);
24097 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
24098 @dots{}
24099 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
24100 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
24101 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
24102 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
24103 (@value{GDBP})
24104 @end smallexample
24105
24106 Takes an optional file parameter.
24107
24108 @kindex maint print registers
24109 @kindex maint print raw-registers
24110 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
24111 @kindex maint print register-groups
24112 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24113 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24114 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24115 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24116 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
24117
24118 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
24119 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
24120 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
24121 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
24122 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
24123 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
24124
24125 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
24126 write the information.
24127
24128 @kindex maint print reggroups
24129 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
24130 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
24131 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
24132 information.
24133
24134 The register groups info looks like this:
24135
24136 @smallexample
24137 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
24138 Group Type
24139 general user
24140 float user
24141 all user
24142 vector user
24143 system user
24144 save internal
24145 restore internal
24146 @end smallexample
24147
24148 @kindex flushregs
24149 @item flushregs
24150 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
24151
24152 @kindex maint print objfiles
24153 @cindex info for known object files
24154 @item maint print objfiles
24155 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
24156 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
24157 and symtabs.
24158
24159 @kindex maint print statistics
24160 @cindex bcache statistics
24161 @item maint print statistics
24162 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
24163 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
24164 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
24165 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
24166 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
24167 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
24168 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
24169 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
24170 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
24171 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
24172 lengths.
24173
24174 @kindex maint print target-stack
24175 @cindex target stack description
24176 @item maint print target-stack
24177 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
24178 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
24179 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
24180 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
24181 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
24182 address.
24183
24184 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
24185 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
24186
24187 @kindex maint print type
24188 @cindex type chain of a data type
24189 @item maint print type @var{expr}
24190 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
24191 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
24192 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
24193 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
24194 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
24195
24196 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
24197 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
24198 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
24199 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
24200 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
24201
24202 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
24203 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
24204 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
24205 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
24206 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
24207 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
24208 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
24209 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
24210 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
24211
24212 @kindex maint set profile
24213 @kindex maint show profile
24214 @cindex profiling GDB
24215 @item maint set profile
24216 @itemx maint show profile
24217 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
24218
24219 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
24220 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
24221 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
24222 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
24223 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
24224 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
24225 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
24226
24227 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
24228 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
24229
24230 @kindex maint set linux-async
24231 @kindex maint show linux-async
24232 @cindex asynchronous support
24233 @item maint set linux-async
24234 @itemx maint show linux-async
24235 Control the GNU/Linux native asynchronous support
24236 (@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
24237
24238 GNU/Linux native asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
24239 the @samp{maint set linux-async} command to enable it.
24240
24241 @kindex maint set remote-async
24242 @kindex maint show remote-async
24243 @cindex asynchronous support
24244 @item maint set remote-async
24245 @itemx maint show remote-async
24246 Control the remote asynchronous support
24247 (@pxref{Background Execution}) of @value{GDBN}.
24248
24249 Remote asynchronous support will be disabled until you use
24250 the @samp{maint set remote-async} command to enable it.
24251
24252 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
24253 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
24254 @item maint show-debug-regs
24255 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
24256 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
24257 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
24258 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
24259 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
24260
24261 @kindex maint space
24262 @cindex memory used by commands
24263 @item maint space
24264 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
24265 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
24266 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
24267 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
24268 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
24269
24270 @kindex maint time
24271 @cindex time of command execution
24272 @item maint time
24273 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
24274 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
24275 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
24276 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
24277 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
24278 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
24279 it's not possibly currently
24280 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
24281 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
24282
24283 @kindex maint translate-address
24284 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
24285 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
24286 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
24287 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
24288 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
24289 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
24290 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
24291
24292 @end table
24293
24294 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
24295 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
24296
24297 @table @code
24298 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
24299 @kindex set watchdog
24300 @cindex watchdog timer
24301 @cindex timeout for commands
24302 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
24303 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
24304 reports and error and the command is aborted.
24305
24306 @item show watchdog
24307 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
24308 @end table
24309
24310 @node Remote Protocol
24311 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
24312
24313 @menu
24314 * Overview::
24315 * Packets::
24316 * Stop Reply Packets::
24317 * General Query Packets::
24318 * Register Packet Format::
24319 * Tracepoint Packets::
24320 * Host I/O Packets::
24321 * Interrupts::
24322 * Packet Acknowledgment::
24323 * Examples::
24324 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
24325 * Library List Format::
24326 * Memory Map Format::
24327 @end menu
24328
24329 @node Overview
24330 @section Overview
24331
24332 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
24333 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
24334 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
24335 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
24336
24337 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
24338 transmitted and received data, respectively.
24339
24340 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
24341 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
24342 @cindex remote serial protocol
24343 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
24344 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
24345 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
24346 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
24347
24348 @smallexample
24349 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
24350 @end smallexample
24351 @noindent
24352
24353 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
24354 @noindent
24355 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
24356 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
24357 eight bit unsigned checksum).
24358
24359 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
24360 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
24361
24362 @smallexample
24363 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
24364 @end smallexample
24365
24366 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
24367 @noindent
24368 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
24369 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
24370 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
24371
24372 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
24373 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
24374 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
24375 retransmission):
24376
24377 @smallexample
24378 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
24379 <- @code{+}
24380 @end smallexample
24381 @noindent
24382
24383 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
24384 once a connection is established.
24385 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
24386
24387 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
24388 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
24389 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
24390 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
24391
24392 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
24393 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
24394 exceptions).
24395
24396 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
24397 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
24398 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
24399 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
24400
24401 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
24402 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
24403 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
24404
24405 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
24406 @anchor{Binary Data}
24407 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
24408 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
24409 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
24410 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
24411 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
24412 binary data.
24413
24414 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
24415 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
24416 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
24417 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
24418 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
24419 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
24420 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
24421 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
24422 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
24423 (described next).
24424
24425 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
24426 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
24427 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
24428 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
24429 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
24430 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
24431 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
24432 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
24433 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
24434 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
24435 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
24436 3}} more times.
24437
24438 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
24439 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
24440 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
24441 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
24442 @samp{0*"00}.
24443
24444 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
24445 error number. That number is not well defined.
24446
24447 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
24448 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
24449 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
24450 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
24451 on that response.
24452
24453 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
24454 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
24455 optional.
24456
24457 @node Packets
24458 @section Packets
24459
24460 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
24461 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
24462 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
24463 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
24464
24465 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
24466 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
24467 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
24468 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
24469 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
24470 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
24471 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
24472 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
24473 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
24474 @var{baz}.
24475
24476 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
24477 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
24478 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
24479 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
24480 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
24481 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
24482 pick any thread.
24483
24484 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
24485 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
24486 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
24487 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
24488 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
24489 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
24490 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
24491 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
24492 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
24493 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
24494 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
24495 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
24496 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
24497
24498 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
24499 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
24500 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
24501 more information.
24502
24503 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
24504 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
24505
24506 Here are the packet descriptions.
24507
24508 @table @samp
24509
24510 @item !
24511 @cindex @samp{!} packet
24512 @anchor{extended mode}
24513 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
24514 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
24515 debugged.
24516
24517 Reply:
24518 @table @samp
24519 @item OK
24520 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
24521 @end table
24522
24523 @item ?
24524 @cindex @samp{?} packet
24525 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
24526 step and continue.
24527
24528 Reply:
24529 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24530
24531 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
24532 @cindex @samp{A} packet
24533 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
24534 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
24535 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
24536
24537 Reply:
24538 @table @samp
24539 @item OK
24540 The arguments were set.
24541 @item E @var{NN}
24542 An error occurred.
24543 @end table
24544
24545 @item b @var{baud}
24546 @cindex @samp{b} packet
24547 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
24548 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
24549
24550 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
24551 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
24552 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
24553
24554 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
24555 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
24556 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
24557 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
24558 of view, nothing actually happened.}
24559
24560 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
24561 @cindex @samp{B} packet
24562 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
24563 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
24564
24565 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
24566 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
24567
24568 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
24569 @cindex @samp{c} packet
24570 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
24571 resume at current address.
24572
24573 Reply:
24574 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24575
24576 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
24577 @cindex @samp{C} packet
24578 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
24579 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
24580
24581 Reply:
24582 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24583
24584 @item d
24585 @cindex @samp{d} packet
24586 Toggle debug flag.
24587
24588 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
24589 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
24590
24591 @item D
24592 @itemx D;@var{pid}
24593 @cindex @samp{D} packet
24594 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
24595 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
24596 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
24597
24598 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
24599 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
24600 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
24601 big-endian hex string.
24602
24603 Reply:
24604 @table @samp
24605 @item OK
24606 for success
24607 @item E @var{NN}
24608 for an error
24609 @end table
24610
24611 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
24612 @cindex @samp{F} packet
24613 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
24614 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
24615 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
24616
24617 @item g
24618 @anchor{read registers packet}
24619 @cindex @samp{g} packet
24620 Read general registers.
24621
24622 Reply:
24623 @table @samp
24624 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24625 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
24626 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
24627 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
24628 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
24629 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
24630 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
24631 @item E @var{NN}
24632 for an error.
24633 @end table
24634
24635 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
24636 @cindex @samp{G} packet
24637 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
24638 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
24639
24640 Reply:
24641 @table @samp
24642 @item OK
24643 for success
24644 @item E @var{NN}
24645 for an error
24646 @end table
24647
24648 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
24649 @cindex @samp{H} packet
24650 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
24651 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
24652 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
24653 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
24654 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
24655
24656 Reply:
24657 @table @samp
24658 @item OK
24659 for success
24660 @item E @var{NN}
24661 for an error
24662 @end table
24663
24664 @c FIXME: JTC:
24665 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
24666 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
24667 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
24668 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
24669 @c described. For example:
24670 @c
24671 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
24672 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
24673 @c otherwise returns current registers.
24674 @c
24675 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
24676 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
24677 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
24678
24679 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
24680 @anchor{cycle step packet}
24681 @cindex @samp{i} packet
24682 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
24683 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
24684 step starting at that address.
24685
24686 @item I
24687 @cindex @samp{I} packet
24688 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
24689 step packet}.
24690
24691 @item k
24692 @cindex @samp{k} packet
24693 Kill request.
24694
24695 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
24696 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
24697 thread?)}.
24698
24699 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
24700 @cindex @samp{m} packet
24701 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
24702 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
24703
24704 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
24705 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
24706 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
24707 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
24708 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
24709 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
24710 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
24711 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
24712
24713 Reply:
24714 @table @samp
24715 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24716 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
24717 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
24718 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
24719 @item E @var{NN}
24720 @var{NN} is errno
24721 @end table
24722
24723 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24724 @cindex @samp{M} packet
24725 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
24726 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
24727 hexadecimal number.
24728
24729 Reply:
24730 @table @samp
24731 @item OK
24732 for success
24733 @item E @var{NN}
24734 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
24735 written).
24736 @end table
24737
24738 @item p @var{n}
24739 @cindex @samp{p} packet
24740 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
24741 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
24742 register value is encoded.
24743
24744 Reply:
24745 @table @samp
24746 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
24747 the register's value
24748 @item E @var{NN}
24749 for an error
24750 @item
24751 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
24752 @end table
24753
24754 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
24755 @anchor{write register packet}
24756 @cindex @samp{P} packet
24757 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
24758 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
24759 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
24760
24761 Reply:
24762 @table @samp
24763 @item OK
24764 for success
24765 @item E @var{NN}
24766 for an error
24767 @end table
24768
24769 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24770 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
24771 @cindex @samp{q} packet
24772 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
24773 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
24774 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
24775
24776 @item r
24777 @cindex @samp{r} packet
24778 Reset the entire system.
24779
24780 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
24781
24782 @item R @var{XX}
24783 @cindex @samp{R} packet
24784 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
24785 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24786
24787 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
24788
24789 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
24790 @cindex @samp{s} packet
24791 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
24792 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
24793
24794 Reply:
24795 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24796
24797 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
24798 @anchor{step with signal packet}
24799 @cindex @samp{S} packet
24800 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
24801 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
24802
24803 Reply:
24804 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24805
24806 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
24807 @cindex @samp{t} packet
24808 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
24809 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
24810 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
24811
24812 @item T @var{thread-id}
24813 @cindex @samp{T} packet
24814 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
24815
24816 Reply:
24817 @table @samp
24818 @item OK
24819 thread is still alive
24820 @item E @var{NN}
24821 thread is dead
24822 @end table
24823
24824 @item v
24825 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
24826 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
24827
24828 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
24829 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
24830 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
24831 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. The attached process is
24832 stopped.
24833
24834 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24835
24836 Reply:
24837 @table @samp
24838 @item E @var{nn}
24839 for an error
24840 @item @r{Any stop packet}
24841 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24842 @end table
24843
24844 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
24845 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
24846 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
24847 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
24848 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
24849 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
24850 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
24851 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
24852
24853 Currently supported actions are:
24854
24855 @table @samp
24856 @item c
24857 Continue.
24858 @item C @var{sig}
24859 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24860 @item s
24861 Step.
24862 @item S @var{sig}
24863 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
24864 @end table
24865
24866 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
24867 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
24868
24869 Reply:
24870 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
24871
24872 @item vCont?
24873 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
24874 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
24875
24876 Reply:
24877 @table @samp
24878 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
24879 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
24880 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
24881 @item
24882 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
24883 @end table
24884
24885 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
24886 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
24887 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
24888 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
24889
24890 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
24891 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
24892 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
24893 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
24894 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
24895 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
24896 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
24897 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
24898 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24899 packet is received.
24900
24901 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
24902 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
24903 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
24904 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
24905 @var{thread-id}.
24906
24907 Reply:
24908 @table @samp
24909 @item OK
24910 for success
24911 @item E @var{NN}
24912 for an error
24913 @end table
24914
24915 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24916 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
24917 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
24918 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
24919 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
24920 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
24921 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
24922 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
24923 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
24924 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
24925 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
24926 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
24927
24928
24929 Reply:
24930 @table @samp
24931 @item OK
24932 for success
24933 @item E.memtype
24934 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
24935 @item E @var{NN}
24936 for an error
24937 @end table
24938
24939 @item vFlashDone
24940 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
24941 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
24942 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
24943 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
24944 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
24945 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
24946 request is completed.
24947
24948 @item vKill;@var{pid}
24949 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
24950 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
24951 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
24952 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
24953 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
24954
24955 Reply:
24956 @table @samp
24957 @item E @var{nn}
24958 for an error
24959 @item OK
24960 for success
24961 @end table
24962
24963 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
24964 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
24965 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
24966 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
24967 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
24968 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
24969 state.
24970
24971 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
24972
24973 Reply:
24974 @table @samp
24975 @item E @var{nn}
24976 for an error
24977 @item @r{Any stop packet}
24978 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
24979 @end table
24980
24981 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
24982 @anchor{X packet}
24983 @cindex @samp{X} packet
24984 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
24985 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
24986 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24987
24988 Reply:
24989 @table @samp
24990 @item OK
24991 for success
24992 @item E @var{NN}
24993 for an error
24994 @end table
24995
24996 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24997 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
24998 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
24999 @cindex @samp{z} packet
25000 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
25001 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
25002 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
25003 @var{length} bytes.
25004
25005 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
25006 separately.
25007
25008 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
25009 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
25010 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
25011 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
25012 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
25013 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
25014
25015 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
25016 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
25017 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
25018 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
25019 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
25020 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
25021
25022 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
25023 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
25024 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
25025 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
25026 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
25027
25028 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
25029 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
25030 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
25031 target, is not defined.}
25032
25033 Reply:
25034 @table @samp
25035 @item OK
25036 success
25037 @item
25038 not supported
25039 @item E @var{NN}
25040 for an error
25041 @end table
25042
25043 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
25044 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
25045 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
25046 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
25047 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
25048 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
25049
25050 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
25051 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
25052
25053 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
25054 movement.}
25055
25056 Reply:
25057 @table @samp
25058 @item OK
25059 success
25060 @item
25061 not supported
25062 @item E @var{NN}
25063 for an error
25064 @end table
25065
25066 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
25067 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
25068 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
25069 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
25070 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
25071
25072 Reply:
25073 @table @samp
25074 @item OK
25075 success
25076 @item
25077 not supported
25078 @item E @var{NN}
25079 for an error
25080 @end table
25081
25082 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
25083 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
25084 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
25085 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
25086 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
25087
25088 Reply:
25089 @table @samp
25090 @item OK
25091 success
25092 @item
25093 not supported
25094 @item E @var{NN}
25095 for an error
25096 @end table
25097
25098 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
25099 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
25100 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
25101 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
25102 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
25103
25104 Reply:
25105 @table @samp
25106 @item OK
25107 success
25108 @item
25109 not supported
25110 @item E @var{NN}
25111 for an error
25112 @end table
25113
25114 @end table
25115
25116 @node Stop Reply Packets
25117 @section Stop Reply Packets
25118 @cindex stop reply packets
25119
25120 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
25121 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
25122 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
25123 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
25124 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
25125 @value{GDBN} source code.
25126
25127 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
25128 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
25129 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
25130 components.
25131
25132 @table @samp
25133
25134 @item S @var{AA}
25135 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
25136 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
25137 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
25138
25139 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
25140 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
25141 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
25142 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
25143 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
25144 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
25145 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
25146 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
25147
25148 @itemize @bullet
25149 @item
25150 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
25151 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
25152 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
25153 two-digit hex number.
25154
25155 @item
25156 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
25157 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
25158
25159 @item
25160 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
25161 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
25162 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
25163 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
25164
25165 @item
25166 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
25167 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
25168 future.
25169 @end itemize
25170
25171 The currently defined stop reasons are:
25172
25173 @table @samp
25174 @item watch
25175 @itemx rwatch
25176 @itemx awatch
25177 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
25178 hex.
25179
25180 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
25181 @item library
25182 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
25183 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
25184 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
25185 @end table
25186
25187 @item W @var{AA}
25188 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
25189 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
25190 applicable to certain targets.
25191
25192 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
25193 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
25194 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
25195 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
25196
25197 @item X @var{AA}
25198 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
25199 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
25200
25201 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
25202 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
25203 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
25204 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
25205
25206 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
25207 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
25208 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
25209 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
25210 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
25211
25212 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
25213 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
25214 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
25215 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
25216 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
25217 system calls.
25218
25219 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
25220 this very system call.
25221
25222 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
25223 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
25224 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
25225 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
25226 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
25227 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
25228
25229 @end table
25230
25231 @node General Query Packets
25232 @section General Query Packets
25233 @cindex remote query requests
25234
25235 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
25236 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
25237 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
25238 sending information to and from the stub.
25239
25240 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
25241 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
25242 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
25243 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
25244 conventions:
25245
25246 @itemize @bullet
25247 @item
25248 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
25249 @item
25250 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
25251 letter.
25252 @item
25253 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
25254 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
25255 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
25256 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
25257 @end itemize
25258
25259 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
25260 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
25261 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
25262 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
25263 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
25264 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
25265 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
25266 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
25267 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
25268 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
25269 packet.}.
25270
25271 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
25272 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
25273 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
25274 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
25275 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
25276
25277 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
25278
25279 @table @samp
25280
25281 @item qC
25282 @cindex current thread, remote request
25283 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
25284 Return the current thread ID.
25285
25286 Reply:
25287 @table @samp
25288 @item QC @var{thread-id}
25289 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
25290 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
25291 @item @r{(anything else)}
25292 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
25293 @end table
25294
25295 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
25296 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
25297 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
25298 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
25299 Reply:
25300 @table @samp
25301 @item E @var{NN}
25302 An error (such as memory fault)
25303 @item C @var{crc32}
25304 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
25305 @end table
25306
25307 @item qfThreadInfo
25308 @itemx qsThreadInfo
25309 @cindex list active threads, remote request
25310 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
25311 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
25312 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
25313 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
25314 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
25315 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
25316 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
25317 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
25318
25319 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
25320
25321 Reply:
25322 @table @samp
25323 @item m @var{thread-id}
25324 A single thread ID
25325 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
25326 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
25327 @item l
25328 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
25329 @end table
25330
25331 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
25332 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
25333 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
25334 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
25335 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
25336 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
25337 fields.
25338
25339 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
25340 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
25341 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
25342 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
25343 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
25344
25345 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
25346 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
25347
25348 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
25349 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
25350 information associated with the variable.)
25351
25352 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
25353 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
25354 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
25355 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
25356 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
25357 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
25358
25359 Reply:
25360 @table @samp
25361 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
25362 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
25363 local storage requested.
25364
25365 @item E @var{nn}
25366 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
25367
25368 @item
25369 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
25370 @end table
25371
25372 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
25373 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
25374 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
25375 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
25376 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
25377 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
25378 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
25379
25380 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
25381
25382 Reply:
25383 @table @samp
25384 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
25385 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
25386 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
25387 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
25388 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
25389 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
25390 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
25391 @end table
25392
25393 @item qOffsets
25394 @cindex section offsets, remote request
25395 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
25396 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
25397 image.
25398
25399 Reply:
25400 @table @samp
25401 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
25402 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
25403 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
25404 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
25405 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
25406 segments by the supplied offsets.
25407
25408 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
25409 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
25410 to the @code{Bss} section.}
25411
25412 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
25413 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
25414 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
25415 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
25416 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
25417 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
25418 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
25419 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
25420 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
25421 @end table
25422
25423 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
25424 @cindex thread information, remote request
25425 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
25426 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
25427 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
25428 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
25429
25430 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
25431 (see below).
25432
25433 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
25434
25435 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
25436 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
25437 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
25438 @anchor{QPassSignals}
25439 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
25440 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
25441 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
25442 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
25443 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
25444 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
25445 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
25446 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
25447 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
25448
25449 Reply:
25450 @table @samp
25451 @item OK
25452 The request succeeded.
25453
25454 @item E @var{nn}
25455 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
25456
25457 @item
25458 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
25459 the stub.
25460 @end table
25461
25462 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
25463 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
25464 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25465 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25466
25467 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
25468 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
25469 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
25470 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
25471 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
25472 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
25473 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
25474 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
25475 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
25476
25477 Reply:
25478 @table @samp
25479 @item OK
25480 A command response with no output.
25481 @item @var{OUTPUT}
25482 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
25483 @item E @var{NN}
25484 Indicate a badly formed request.
25485 @item
25486 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
25487 @end table
25488
25489 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
25490 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
25491 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
25492 packets.)
25493
25494 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
25495 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
25496 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
25497 @anchor{qSearch memory}
25498 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
25499 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
25500 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
25501
25502 Reply:
25503 @table @samp
25504 @item 0
25505 The pattern was not found.
25506 @item 1,address
25507 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
25508 @item E @var{NN}
25509 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
25510 @item
25511 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
25512 @end table
25513
25514 @item QStartNoAckMode
25515 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
25516 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
25517 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
25518 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
25519
25520 Reply:
25521 @table @samp
25522 @item OK
25523 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
25524 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
25525 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
25526 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
25527 @item
25528 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
25529 @end table
25530
25531 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
25532 @cindex supported packets, remote query
25533 @cindex features of the remote protocol
25534 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
25535 @anchor{qSupported}
25536 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
25537 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
25538 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
25539 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
25540 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
25541 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
25542 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
25543 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
25544 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
25545 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
25546 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
25547 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
25548 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
25549 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
25550
25551 Reply:
25552 @table @samp
25553 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
25554 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
25555 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
25556 possible forms).
25557 @item
25558 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
25559 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
25560 @end table
25561
25562 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
25563 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
25564 are:
25565
25566 @table @samp
25567 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
25568 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
25569 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
25570 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
25571 @item @var{name}+
25572 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
25573 need an associated value.
25574 @item @var{name}-
25575 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
25576 @item @var{name}?
25577 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
25578 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
25579 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
25580 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
25581 @end table
25582
25583 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
25584 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
25585 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
25586 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
25587 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
25588
25589 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
25590 are defined:
25591
25592 @table @samp
25593 @item multiprocess
25594 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
25595 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
25596 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
25597 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
25598 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
25599 @end table
25600
25601 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
25602 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
25603 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
25604 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
25605 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
25606 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
25607 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
25608 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
25609 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
25610 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
25611 all the features it supports.
25612
25613 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
25614 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
25615
25616 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
25617 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
25618 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
25619 form response.
25620
25621 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
25622 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
25623 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
25624 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
25625
25626 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
25627 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
25628 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
25629 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
25630 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
25631
25632 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
25633
25634 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
25635 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
25636 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
25637 @item Feature Name
25638 @tab Value Required
25639 @tab Default
25640 @tab Probe Allowed
25641
25642 @item @samp{PacketSize}
25643 @tab Yes
25644 @tab @samp{-}
25645 @tab No
25646
25647 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
25648 @tab No
25649 @tab @samp{-}
25650 @tab Yes
25651
25652 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
25653 @tab No
25654 @tab @samp{-}
25655 @tab Yes
25656
25657 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
25658 @tab No
25659 @tab @samp{-}
25660 @tab Yes
25661
25662 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25663 @tab No
25664 @tab @samp{-}
25665 @tab Yes
25666
25667 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
25668 @tab No
25669 @tab @samp{-}
25670 @tab Yes
25671
25672 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
25673 @tab No
25674 @tab @samp{-}
25675 @tab Yes
25676
25677 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
25678 @tab No
25679 @tab @samp{-}
25680 @tab Yes
25681
25682 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
25683 @tab No
25684 @tab @samp{-}
25685 @tab Yes
25686
25687 @item @samp{multiprocess}
25688 @tab No
25689 @tab @samp{-}
25690 @tab No
25691
25692 @end multitable
25693
25694 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
25695
25696 @table @samp
25697 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
25698 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
25699 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
25700 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
25701 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
25702 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
25703 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
25704 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
25705 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
25706 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
25707
25708 @item qXfer:auxv:read
25709 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
25710 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
25711
25712 @item qXfer:features:read
25713 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
25714 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
25715
25716 @item qXfer:libraries:read
25717 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
25718 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
25719
25720 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
25721 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
25722 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
25723
25724 @item qXfer:spu:read
25725 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
25726 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
25727
25728 @item qXfer:spu:write
25729 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
25730 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
25731
25732 @item QPassSignals
25733 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
25734 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
25735
25736 @item QStartNoAckMode
25737 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
25738 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
25739
25740 @item multiprocess
25741 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
25742 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
25743 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
25744 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
25745 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
25746 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
25747 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
25748 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
25749 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
25750 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
25751 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
25752
25753 @end table
25754
25755 @item qSymbol::
25756 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
25757 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
25758 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
25759 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
25760
25761 Reply:
25762 @table @samp
25763 @item OK
25764 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
25765 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
25766 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
25767 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
25768 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
25769 below.
25770 @end table
25771
25772 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
25773 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
25774
25775 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
25776 target has previously requested.
25777
25778 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
25779 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
25780 will be empty.
25781
25782 Reply:
25783 @table @samp
25784 @item OK
25785 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
25786 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
25787 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
25788 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
25789 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
25790 @end table
25791
25792 @item QTDP
25793 @itemx QTFrame
25794 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
25795
25796 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
25797 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
25798 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
25799 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
25800 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
25801 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
25802 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
25803 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
25804 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
25805 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
25806 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
25807
25808 Reply:
25809 @table @samp
25810 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
25811 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
25812 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
25813 the thread's attributes.
25814 @end table
25815
25816 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
25817 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
25818 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
25819 packets.)
25820
25821 @item QTStart
25822 @itemx QTStop
25823 @itemx QTinit
25824 @itemx QTro
25825 @itemx qTStatus
25826 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
25827
25828 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25829 @cindex read special object, remote request
25830 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
25831 @anchor{qXfer read}
25832 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
25833 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
25834 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
25835 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
25836 additional details about what data to access.
25837
25838 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25839 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25840 formats, listed below.
25841
25842 @table @samp
25843 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25844 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
25845 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
25846 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
25847
25848 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25849 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25850
25851 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25852 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
25853 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
25854 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
25855 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
25856
25857 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25858 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25859
25860 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25861 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
25862 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
25863 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25864 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
25865
25866 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
25867 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
25868 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
25869
25870 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25871 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25872
25873 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
25874 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
25875 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
25876 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
25877 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
25878
25879 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25880 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25881
25882 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
25883 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
25884 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25885 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
25886 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25887 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25888 in that context to be accessed.
25889
25890 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25891 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25892 @end table
25893
25894 Reply:
25895 @table @samp
25896 @item m @var{data}
25897 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
25898 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
25899 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
25900 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
25901 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
25902 request.
25903
25904 @item l @var{data}
25905 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
25906 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
25907 than the @var{length} in the request.
25908
25909 @item l
25910 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
25911 There is no more data to be read.
25912
25913 @item E00
25914 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25915
25916 @item E @var{nn}
25917 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
25918 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25919
25920 @item
25921 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
25922 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
25923 @end table
25924
25925 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25926 @cindex write data into object, remote request
25927 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
25928 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
25929 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
25930 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
25931 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
25932 to access.
25933
25934 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
25935 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
25936 formats, listed below.
25937
25938 @table @samp
25939 @item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
25940 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
25941 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
25942 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
25943 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
25944 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
25945 in that context to be accessed.
25946
25947 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
25948 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
25949 @end table
25950
25951 Reply:
25952 @table @samp
25953 @item @var{nn}
25954 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
25955 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
25956
25957 @item E00
25958 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
25959
25960 @item E @var{nn}
25961 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
25962 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
25963
25964 @item
25965 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
25966 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
25967 @end table
25968
25969 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
25970 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
25971 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
25972 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
25973 must respond with an empty packet.
25974
25975 @end table
25976
25977 @node Register Packet Format
25978 @section Register Packet Format
25979
25980 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
25981 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
25982 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
25983 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
25984 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
25985 most-significant - least-significant.
25986
25987 @table @r
25988
25989 @item MIPS32
25990
25991 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
25992 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
25993 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
25994
25995 @item MIPS64
25996
25997 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
25998 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
25999 as @code{MIPS32}.
26000
26001 @end table
26002
26003 @node Tracepoint Packets
26004 @section Tracepoint Packets
26005 @cindex tracepoint packets
26006 @cindex packets, tracepoint
26007
26008 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
26009 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
26010
26011 @table @samp
26012
26013 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
26014 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
26015 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
26016 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
26017 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
26018 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
26019 tracepoint's actions.
26020
26021 Replies:
26022 @table @samp
26023 @item OK
26024 The packet was understood and carried out.
26025 @item
26026 The packet was not recognized.
26027 @end table
26028
26029 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
26030 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
26031 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
26032 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
26033 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
26034 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
26035 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
26036
26037 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
26038 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
26039 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
26040 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
26041 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
26042 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
26043 tracepoint actions.
26044
26045 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
26046 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
26047 following forms:
26048
26049 @table @samp
26050
26051 @item R @var{mask}
26052 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
26053 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
26054 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
26055 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
26056 not fit in a 32-bit word.
26057
26058 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
26059 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
26060 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
26061 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
26062 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
26063 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
26064 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
26065
26066 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
26067 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
26068 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
26069 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
26070 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
26071 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
26072 packet).
26073
26074 @end table
26075
26076 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
26077 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
26078 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
26079 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
26080 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
26081 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
26082 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
26083 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
26084
26085 Replies:
26086 @table @samp
26087 @item OK
26088 The packet was understood and carried out.
26089 @item
26090 The packet was not recognized.
26091 @end table
26092
26093 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
26094 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
26095 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
26096 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
26097
26098 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
26099 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
26100 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
26101 one of the following forms:
26102
26103 @table @samp
26104 @item F @var{f}
26105 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
26106 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
26107 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
26108
26109 @item T @var{t}
26110 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
26111 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
26112
26113 @end table
26114
26115 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
26116 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
26117 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
26118 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
26119
26120 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
26121 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
26122 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
26123 is a hexadecimal number.
26124
26125 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
26126 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
26127 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
26128 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
26129 numbers.
26130
26131 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
26132 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
26133 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
26134
26135 @item QTStart
26136 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
26137 hits in the trace frame buffer.
26138
26139 @item QTStop
26140 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
26141
26142 @item QTinit
26143 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
26144
26145 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
26146 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
26147 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
26148 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
26149
26150 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
26151 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
26152 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
26153 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
26154
26155 @item qTStatus
26156 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
26157
26158 Replies:
26159 @table @samp
26160 @item T0
26161 There is no trace experiment running.
26162 @item T1
26163 There is a trace experiment running.
26164 @end table
26165
26166 @end table
26167
26168
26169 @node Host I/O Packets
26170 @section Host I/O Packets
26171 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
26172 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
26173
26174 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
26175 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
26176 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
26177 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
26178 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
26179 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
26180 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
26181 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
26182 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
26183 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
26184
26185 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
26186 its arguments. They have this format:
26187
26188 @table @samp
26189
26190 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
26191 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
26192 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
26193 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
26194 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
26195 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
26196 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
26197 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
26198 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
26199
26200 @end table
26201
26202 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
26203
26204 @table @samp
26205
26206 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
26207 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
26208 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
26209 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
26210 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
26211 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
26212 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
26213 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
26214 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
26215 @var{attachment}.
26216
26217 @item
26218 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
26219
26220 @end table
26221
26222 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
26223
26224 @table @samp
26225 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
26226 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
26227 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
26228 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
26229 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
26230 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
26231 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
26232
26233 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
26234 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
26235 -1 if an error occurs.
26236
26237 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
26238 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
26239 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
26240 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
26241 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
26242 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
26243 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
26244 @var{count} was zero.
26245
26246 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
26247 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
26248 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
26249 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
26250 some characters were escaped.
26251
26252 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
26253 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
26254 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
26255 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
26256 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
26257 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
26258 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
26259 error occurred.
26260
26261 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
26262 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
26263 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
26264
26265 @end table
26266
26267 @node Interrupts
26268 @section Interrupts
26269 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
26270
26271 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
26272 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
26273 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
26274 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
26275
26276 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
26277 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
26278 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
26279 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
26280 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
26281
26282 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
26283 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
26284 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
26285 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
26286 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
26287 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
26288 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
26289 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
26290
26291 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
26292 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
26293 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
26294 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
26295 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
26296 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
26297 program is stopped will be discarded.
26298
26299 @node Packet Acknowledgment
26300 @section Packet Acknowledgment
26301
26302 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
26303 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
26304 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
26305 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
26306 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
26307 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
26308 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
26309
26310 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
26311 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
26312 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
26313 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
26314 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
26315
26316 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
26317 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
26318 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
26319 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
26320
26321 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
26322 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
26323 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
26324 @pxref{qSupported}.
26325 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
26326 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
26327 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
26328 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
26329 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
26330 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
26331 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
26332
26333 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
26334 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
26335 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
26336 connection.
26337 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
26338 new connection is established,
26339 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
26340 for the current connection, once disabled.
26341
26342
26343 @node Examples
26344 @section Examples
26345
26346 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
26347 does not get any direct output:
26348
26349 @smallexample
26350 -> @code{R00}
26351 <- @code{+}
26352 @emph{target restarts}
26353 -> @code{?}
26354 <- @code{+}
26355 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
26356 -> @code{+}
26357 @end smallexample
26358
26359 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
26360
26361 @smallexample
26362 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
26363 <- @code{+}
26364 -> @code{s}
26365 <- @code{+}
26366 @emph{time passes}
26367 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
26368 -> @code{+}
26369 -> @code{g}
26370 <- @code{+}
26371 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
26372 -> @code{+}
26373 @end smallexample
26374
26375 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
26376 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
26377 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
26378
26379 @menu
26380 * File-I/O Overview::
26381 * Protocol Basics::
26382 * The F Request Packet::
26383 * The F Reply Packet::
26384 * The Ctrl-C Message::
26385 * Console I/O::
26386 * List of Supported Calls::
26387 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
26388 * Constants::
26389 * File-I/O Examples::
26390 @end menu
26391
26392 @node File-I/O Overview
26393 @subsection File-I/O Overview
26394 @cindex file-i/o overview
26395
26396 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
26397 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
26398 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
26399 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
26400 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
26401 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
26402
26403 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
26404 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
26405 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
26406 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
26407 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
26408
26409 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
26410 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
26411 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
26412 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
26413 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
26414 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
26415 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
26416
26417 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
26418 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
26419 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
26420 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
26421 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
26422
26423 @smallexample
26424 (@value{GDBP}) continue
26425 <- target requests 'system call X'
26426 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
26427 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
26428 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
26429 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
26430 @end smallexample
26431
26432 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
26433 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
26434 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
26435 system are not supported by this protocol.
26436
26437 @node Protocol Basics
26438 @subsection Protocol Basics
26439 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
26440
26441 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
26442 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
26443 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
26444 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
26445 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
26446 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
26447 to call the appropriate host system call:
26448
26449 @itemize @bullet
26450 @item
26451 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
26452
26453 @item
26454 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
26455 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
26456 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
26457 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
26458
26459 @end itemize
26460
26461 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
26462
26463 @itemize @bullet
26464 @item
26465 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
26466 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
26467 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
26468 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
26469 packet.
26470
26471 @item
26472 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
26473 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
26474
26475 @item
26476 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
26477
26478 @item
26479 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
26480
26481 @item
26482 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
26483 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
26484 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
26485 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
26486 packet.
26487
26488 @end itemize
26489
26490 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
26491 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
26492
26493 @itemize @bullet
26494 @item
26495 Return value.
26496
26497 @item
26498 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
26499
26500 @item
26501 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
26502
26503 @end itemize
26504
26505 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
26506 the latest continue or step action.
26507
26508 @node The F Request Packet
26509 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
26510 @cindex file-i/o request packet
26511 @cindex @code{F} request packet
26512
26513 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
26514
26515 @table @samp
26516 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
26517
26518 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
26519 This is just the name of the function.
26520
26521 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
26522 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
26523 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
26524 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
26525 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
26526 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
26527 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
26528
26529 @end table
26530
26531
26532
26533 @node The F Reply Packet
26534 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
26535 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
26536 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
26537
26538 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
26539
26540 @table @samp
26541
26542 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
26543
26544 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
26545
26546 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
26547 representation.
26548 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
26549
26550 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
26551 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
26552 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
26553
26554 @smallexample
26555 F0,0,C
26556 @end smallexample
26557
26558 @noindent
26559 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
26560
26561 @smallexample
26562 F-1,4,C
26563 @end smallexample
26564
26565 @noindent
26566 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
26567
26568 @end table
26569
26570
26571 @node The Ctrl-C Message
26572 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
26573 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
26574
26575 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
26576 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
26577 the target should behave as if it had
26578 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
26579 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
26580 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
26581 packet.
26582
26583 It's important for the target to know in which
26584 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
26585
26586 @itemize @bullet
26587 @item
26588 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
26589
26590 @item
26591 The system call on the host has been finished.
26592
26593 @end itemize
26594
26595 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
26596 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
26597 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
26598 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
26599 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
26600 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
26601
26602 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
26603 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
26604 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
26605 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
26606 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
26607 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
26608 or the full action has been completed.
26609
26610 @node Console I/O
26611 @subsection Console I/O
26612 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
26613
26614 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
26615 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
26616 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
26617 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
26618 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
26619 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
26620 conditions is met:
26621
26622 @itemize @bullet
26623 @item
26624 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
26625 @code{read}
26626 system call is treated as finished.
26627
26628 @item
26629 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
26630 newline.
26631
26632 @item
26633 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
26634 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
26635
26636 @end itemize
26637
26638 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
26639 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
26640 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
26641 is stopped at the user's request.
26642
26643
26644 @node List of Supported Calls
26645 @subsection List of Supported Calls
26646 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
26647
26648 @menu
26649 * open::
26650 * close::
26651 * read::
26652 * write::
26653 * lseek::
26654 * rename::
26655 * unlink::
26656 * stat/fstat::
26657 * gettimeofday::
26658 * isatty::
26659 * system::
26660 @end menu
26661
26662 @node open
26663 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
26664 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
26665
26666 @table @asis
26667 @item Synopsis:
26668 @smallexample
26669 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
26670 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
26671 @end smallexample
26672
26673 @item Request:
26674 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
26675
26676 @noindent
26677 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
26678
26679 @table @code
26680 @item O_CREAT
26681 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
26682 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
26683 are concerned.
26684
26685 @item O_EXCL
26686 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
26687 an error and open() fails.
26688
26689 @item O_TRUNC
26690 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
26691 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
26692 truncated to zero length.
26693
26694 @item O_APPEND
26695 The file is opened in append mode.
26696
26697 @item O_RDONLY
26698 The file is opened for reading only.
26699
26700 @item O_WRONLY
26701 The file is opened for writing only.
26702
26703 @item O_RDWR
26704 The file is opened for reading and writing.
26705 @end table
26706
26707 @noindent
26708 Other bits are silently ignored.
26709
26710
26711 @noindent
26712 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
26713
26714 @table @code
26715 @item S_IRUSR
26716 User has read permission.
26717
26718 @item S_IWUSR
26719 User has write permission.
26720
26721 @item S_IRGRP
26722 Group has read permission.
26723
26724 @item S_IWGRP
26725 Group has write permission.
26726
26727 @item S_IROTH
26728 Others have read permission.
26729
26730 @item S_IWOTH
26731 Others have write permission.
26732 @end table
26733
26734 @noindent
26735 Other bits are silently ignored.
26736
26737
26738 @item Return value:
26739 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
26740 occurred.
26741
26742 @item Errors:
26743
26744 @table @code
26745 @item EEXIST
26746 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
26747
26748 @item EISDIR
26749 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
26750
26751 @item EACCES
26752 The requested access is not allowed.
26753
26754 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26755 @var{pathname} was too long.
26756
26757 @item ENOENT
26758 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
26759
26760 @item ENODEV
26761 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
26762
26763 @item EROFS
26764 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
26765 write access was requested.
26766
26767 @item EFAULT
26768 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
26769
26770 @item ENOSPC
26771 No space on device to create the file.
26772
26773 @item EMFILE
26774 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
26775
26776 @item ENFILE
26777 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
26778 has been reached.
26779
26780 @item EINTR
26781 The call was interrupted by the user.
26782 @end table
26783
26784 @end table
26785
26786 @node close
26787 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
26788 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
26789
26790 @table @asis
26791 @item Synopsis:
26792 @smallexample
26793 int close(int fd);
26794 @end smallexample
26795
26796 @item Request:
26797 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
26798
26799 @item Return value:
26800 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
26801
26802 @item Errors:
26803
26804 @table @code
26805 @item EBADF
26806 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
26807
26808 @item EINTR
26809 The call was interrupted by the user.
26810 @end table
26811
26812 @end table
26813
26814 @node read
26815 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
26816 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
26817
26818 @table @asis
26819 @item Synopsis:
26820 @smallexample
26821 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
26822 @end smallexample
26823
26824 @item Request:
26825 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
26826
26827 @item Return value:
26828 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
26829 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
26830 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
26831
26832 @item Errors:
26833
26834 @table @code
26835 @item EBADF
26836 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
26837 reading.
26838
26839 @item EFAULT
26840 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26841
26842 @item EINTR
26843 The call was interrupted by the user.
26844 @end table
26845
26846 @end table
26847
26848 @node write
26849 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
26850 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
26851
26852 @table @asis
26853 @item Synopsis:
26854 @smallexample
26855 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
26856 @end smallexample
26857
26858 @item Request:
26859 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
26860
26861 @item Return value:
26862 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
26863 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
26864 is returned.
26865
26866 @item Errors:
26867
26868 @table @code
26869 @item EBADF
26870 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
26871 writing.
26872
26873 @item EFAULT
26874 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
26875
26876 @item EFBIG
26877 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
26878 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
26879
26880 @item ENOSPC
26881 No space on device to write the data.
26882
26883 @item EINTR
26884 The call was interrupted by the user.
26885 @end table
26886
26887 @end table
26888
26889 @node lseek
26890 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
26891 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
26892
26893 @table @asis
26894 @item Synopsis:
26895 @smallexample
26896 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
26897 @end smallexample
26898
26899 @item Request:
26900 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
26901
26902 @var{flag} is one of:
26903
26904 @table @code
26905 @item SEEK_SET
26906 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
26907
26908 @item SEEK_CUR
26909 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
26910 bytes.
26911
26912 @item SEEK_END
26913 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
26914 bytes.
26915 @end table
26916
26917 @item Return value:
26918 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
26919 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
26920 value of -1 is returned.
26921
26922 @item Errors:
26923
26924 @table @code
26925 @item EBADF
26926 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
26927
26928 @item ESPIPE
26929 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
26930
26931 @item EINVAL
26932 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
26933
26934 @item EINTR
26935 The call was interrupted by the user.
26936 @end table
26937
26938 @end table
26939
26940 @node rename
26941 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
26942 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
26943
26944 @table @asis
26945 @item Synopsis:
26946 @smallexample
26947 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
26948 @end smallexample
26949
26950 @item Request:
26951 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
26952
26953 @item Return value:
26954 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
26955
26956 @item Errors:
26957
26958 @table @code
26959 @item EISDIR
26960 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
26961 directory.
26962
26963 @item EEXIST
26964 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
26965
26966 @item EBUSY
26967 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
26968 process.
26969
26970 @item EINVAL
26971 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
26972 of itself.
26973
26974 @item ENOTDIR
26975 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
26976 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
26977 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
26978
26979 @item EFAULT
26980 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
26981
26982 @item EACCES
26983 No access to the file or the path of the file.
26984
26985 @item ENAMETOOLONG
26986
26987 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
26988
26989 @item ENOENT
26990 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
26991
26992 @item EROFS
26993 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
26994
26995 @item ENOSPC
26996 The device containing the file has no room for the new
26997 directory entry.
26998
26999 @item EINTR
27000 The call was interrupted by the user.
27001 @end table
27002
27003 @end table
27004
27005 @node unlink
27006 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
27007 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
27008
27009 @table @asis
27010 @item Synopsis:
27011 @smallexample
27012 int unlink(const char *pathname);
27013 @end smallexample
27014
27015 @item Request:
27016 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
27017
27018 @item Return value:
27019 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
27020
27021 @item Errors:
27022
27023 @table @code
27024 @item EACCES
27025 No access to the file or the path of the file.
27026
27027 @item EPERM
27028 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
27029
27030 @item EBUSY
27031 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
27032 being used by another process.
27033
27034 @item EFAULT
27035 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
27036
27037 @item ENAMETOOLONG
27038 @var{pathname} was too long.
27039
27040 @item ENOENT
27041 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
27042
27043 @item ENOTDIR
27044 A component of the path is not a directory.
27045
27046 @item EROFS
27047 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
27048
27049 @item EINTR
27050 The call was interrupted by the user.
27051 @end table
27052
27053 @end table
27054
27055 @node stat/fstat
27056 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
27057 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
27058 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
27059
27060 @table @asis
27061 @item Synopsis:
27062 @smallexample
27063 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
27064 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
27065 @end smallexample
27066
27067 @item Request:
27068 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
27069 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
27070
27071 @item Return value:
27072 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
27073
27074 @item Errors:
27075
27076 @table @code
27077 @item EBADF
27078 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
27079
27080 @item ENOENT
27081 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
27082 path is an empty string.
27083
27084 @item ENOTDIR
27085 A component of the path is not a directory.
27086
27087 @item EFAULT
27088 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
27089
27090 @item EACCES
27091 No access to the file or the path of the file.
27092
27093 @item ENAMETOOLONG
27094 @var{pathname} was too long.
27095
27096 @item EINTR
27097 The call was interrupted by the user.
27098 @end table
27099
27100 @end table
27101
27102 @node gettimeofday
27103 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
27104 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
27105
27106 @table @asis
27107 @item Synopsis:
27108 @smallexample
27109 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
27110 @end smallexample
27111
27112 @item Request:
27113 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
27114
27115 @item Return value:
27116 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
27117
27118 @item Errors:
27119
27120 @table @code
27121 @item EINVAL
27122 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
27123
27124 @item EFAULT
27125 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
27126 @end table
27127
27128 @end table
27129
27130 @node isatty
27131 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
27132 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
27133
27134 @table @asis
27135 @item Synopsis:
27136 @smallexample
27137 int isatty(int fd);
27138 @end smallexample
27139
27140 @item Request:
27141 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
27142
27143 @item Return value:
27144 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
27145
27146 @item Errors:
27147
27148 @table @code
27149 @item EINTR
27150 The call was interrupted by the user.
27151 @end table
27152
27153 @end table
27154
27155 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
27156 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
27157 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
27158 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
27159 needed.
27160
27161
27162 @node system
27163 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
27164 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
27165
27166 @table @asis
27167 @item Synopsis:
27168 @smallexample
27169 int system(const char *command);
27170 @end smallexample
27171
27172 @item Request:
27173 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
27174
27175 @item Return value:
27176 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
27177 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
27178 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
27179 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
27180 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
27181 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
27182 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
27183
27184 @item Errors:
27185
27186 @table @code
27187 @item EINTR
27188 The call was interrupted by the user.
27189 @end table
27190
27191 @end table
27192
27193 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
27194 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
27195 the host is simplified before it's returned
27196 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
27197 is discarded, and the return value consists
27198 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
27199
27200 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
27201 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
27202 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
27203
27204 @table @code
27205 @item set remote system-call-allowed
27206 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
27207 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
27208 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
27209
27210 @item show remote system-call-allowed
27211 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
27212 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
27213 protocol.
27214 @end table
27215
27216 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
27217 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
27218 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
27219
27220 @menu
27221 * Integral Datatypes::
27222 * Pointer Values::
27223 * Memory Transfer::
27224 * struct stat::
27225 * struct timeval::
27226 @end menu
27227
27228 @node Integral Datatypes
27229 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
27230 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
27231
27232 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
27233 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
27234 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
27235
27236 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
27237 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
27238
27239 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
27240
27241 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
27242 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
27243
27244 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
27245
27246 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
27247 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
27248 byte order.
27249
27250 @node Pointer Values
27251 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
27252 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
27253
27254 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
27255 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
27256 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
27257 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
27258
27259 @smallexample
27260 @code{1aaf/12}
27261 @end smallexample
27262
27263 @noindent
27264 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
27265 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
27266 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
27267 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
27268
27269 @smallexample
27270 @code{123456/d}
27271 @end smallexample
27272
27273 @node Memory Transfer
27274 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
27275 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
27276
27277 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
27278 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
27279 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
27280 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
27281 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
27282 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
27283 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
27284
27285
27286 @node struct stat
27287 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
27288 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
27289
27290 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
27291 is defined as follows:
27292
27293 @smallexample
27294 struct stat @{
27295 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
27296 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
27297 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
27298 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
27299 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
27300 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
27301 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
27302 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
27303 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
27304 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
27305 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
27306 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
27307 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
27308 @};
27309 @end smallexample
27310
27311 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
27312 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
27313 structure is of size 64 bytes.
27314
27315 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
27316 range of values.
27317
27318 @table @code
27319
27320 @item st_dev
27321 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
27322
27323 @item st_ino
27324 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
27325
27326 @item st_mode
27327 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
27328 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
27329
27330 @item st_uid
27331 @itemx st_gid
27332 @itemx st_rdev
27333 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
27334
27335 @item st_atime
27336 @itemx st_mtime
27337 @itemx st_ctime
27338 These values have a host and file system dependent
27339 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
27340 support exact timing values.
27341 @end table
27342
27343 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
27344 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
27345 continuing.
27346
27347 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
27348 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
27349 get truncated on the target.
27350
27351 @node struct timeval
27352 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
27353 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
27354
27355 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
27356 is defined as follows:
27357
27358 @smallexample
27359 struct timeval @{
27360 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
27361 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
27362 @};
27363 @end smallexample
27364
27365 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
27366 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
27367 structure is of size 8 bytes.
27368
27369 @node Constants
27370 @subsection Constants
27371 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
27372
27373 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
27374 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
27375 values before and after the call as needed.
27376
27377 @menu
27378 * Open Flags::
27379 * mode_t Values::
27380 * Errno Values::
27381 * Lseek Flags::
27382 * Limits::
27383 @end menu
27384
27385 @node Open Flags
27386 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
27387 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
27388
27389 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
27390
27391 @smallexample
27392 O_RDONLY 0x0
27393 O_WRONLY 0x1
27394 O_RDWR 0x2
27395 O_APPEND 0x8
27396 O_CREAT 0x200
27397 O_TRUNC 0x400
27398 O_EXCL 0x800
27399 @end smallexample
27400
27401 @node mode_t Values
27402 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
27403 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
27404
27405 All values are given in octal representation.
27406
27407 @smallexample
27408 S_IFREG 0100000
27409 S_IFDIR 040000
27410 S_IRUSR 0400
27411 S_IWUSR 0200
27412 S_IXUSR 0100
27413 S_IRGRP 040
27414 S_IWGRP 020
27415 S_IXGRP 010
27416 S_IROTH 04
27417 S_IWOTH 02
27418 S_IXOTH 01
27419 @end smallexample
27420
27421 @node Errno Values
27422 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
27423 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
27424
27425 All values are given in decimal representation.
27426
27427 @smallexample
27428 EPERM 1
27429 ENOENT 2
27430 EINTR 4
27431 EBADF 9
27432 EACCES 13
27433 EFAULT 14
27434 EBUSY 16
27435 EEXIST 17
27436 ENODEV 19
27437 ENOTDIR 20
27438 EISDIR 21
27439 EINVAL 22
27440 ENFILE 23
27441 EMFILE 24
27442 EFBIG 27
27443 ENOSPC 28
27444 ESPIPE 29
27445 EROFS 30
27446 ENAMETOOLONG 91
27447 EUNKNOWN 9999
27448 @end smallexample
27449
27450 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
27451 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
27452
27453 @node Lseek Flags
27454 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
27455 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
27456
27457 @smallexample
27458 SEEK_SET 0
27459 SEEK_CUR 1
27460 SEEK_END 2
27461 @end smallexample
27462
27463 @node Limits
27464 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
27465 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
27466
27467 All values are given in decimal representation.
27468
27469 @smallexample
27470 INT_MIN -2147483648
27471 INT_MAX 2147483647
27472 UINT_MAX 4294967295
27473 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
27474 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
27475 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
27476 @end smallexample
27477
27478 @node File-I/O Examples
27479 @subsection File-I/O Examples
27480 @cindex file-i/o examples
27481
27482 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
27483 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
27484
27485 @smallexample
27486 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
27487 @emph{request memory read from target}
27488 -> @code{m1234,6}
27489 <- XXXXXX
27490 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
27491 -> @code{F6}
27492 @end smallexample
27493
27494 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
27495 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
27496
27497 @smallexample
27498 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27499 @emph{request memory write to target}
27500 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
27501 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
27502 -> @code{F6}
27503 @end smallexample
27504
27505 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
27506 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
27507
27508 @smallexample
27509 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27510 -> @code{F-1,9}
27511 @end smallexample
27512
27513 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
27514 host is called:
27515
27516 @smallexample
27517 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27518 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
27519 <- @code{T02}
27520 @end smallexample
27521
27522 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
27523 host is called:
27524
27525 @smallexample
27526 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
27527 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
27528 <- @code{T02}
27529 @end smallexample
27530
27531 @node Library List Format
27532 @section Library List Format
27533 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
27534
27535 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
27536 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
27537 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
27538 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
27539 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
27540 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
27541 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
27542 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
27543 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
27544 are loaded.
27545
27546 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
27547 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
27548 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
27549 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
27550
27551 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
27552 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
27553 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
27554 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
27555 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
27556 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
27557
27558 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27559 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
27560
27561 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
27562 offset, looks like this:
27563
27564 @smallexample
27565 <library-list>
27566 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
27567 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
27568 </library>
27569 </library-list>
27570 @end smallexample
27571
27572 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
27573 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
27574
27575 @smallexample
27576 <library-list>
27577 <library name="sharedlib.o">
27578 <section address="0x10000000"/>
27579 <section address="0x20000000"/>
27580 <section address="0x30000000"/>
27581 </library>
27582 </library-list>
27583 @end smallexample
27584
27585 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
27586
27587 @smallexample
27588 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
27589 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
27590 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
27591 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
27592 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
27593 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
27594 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
27595 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
27596 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
27597 @end smallexample
27598
27599 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
27600 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
27601 section for each library.
27602
27603 @node Memory Map Format
27604 @section Memory Map Format
27605 @cindex memory map format
27606
27607 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
27608 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
27609 memory map.
27610
27611 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
27612 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
27613 lists memory regions.
27614
27615 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27616 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
27617
27618 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
27619
27620 @smallexample
27621 <?xml version="1.0"?>
27622 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
27623 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
27624 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
27625 <memory-map>
27626 region...
27627 </memory-map>
27628 @end smallexample
27629
27630 Each region can be either:
27631
27632 @itemize
27633
27634 @item
27635 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
27636 bytes from there:
27637
27638 @smallexample
27639 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
27640 @end smallexample
27641
27642
27643 @item
27644 A region of read-only memory:
27645
27646 @smallexample
27647 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
27648 @end smallexample
27649
27650
27651 @item
27652 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
27653 bytes in length:
27654
27655 @smallexample
27656 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
27657 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
27658 </memory>
27659 @end smallexample
27660
27661 @end itemize
27662
27663 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
27664 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
27665 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
27666
27667 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
27668
27669 @smallexample
27670 <!-- ................................................... -->
27671 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
27672 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
27673 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
27674 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
27675 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
27676 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
27677 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
27678 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
27679 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
27680 and its type, or device. -->
27681 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
27682 start CDATA #REQUIRED
27683 length CDATA #REQUIRED
27684 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
27685 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
27686 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
27687 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
27688 @end smallexample
27689
27690 @include agentexpr.texi
27691
27692 @node Target Descriptions
27693 @appendix Target Descriptions
27694 @cindex target descriptions
27695
27696 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
27697 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
27698 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
27699
27700 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
27701 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
27702 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
27703 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
27704 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
27705 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
27706 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
27707
27708 @itemize @bullet
27709 @item
27710 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
27711 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
27712 @item
27713 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
27714 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
27715 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
27716 @item
27717 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
27718 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
27719 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
27720 @end itemize
27721
27722 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
27723 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
27724 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
27725 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
27726 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
27727
27728 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
27729 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
27730
27731 @menu
27732 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
27733 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
27734 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
27735 descriptions.
27736 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
27737 @end menu
27738
27739 @node Retrieving Descriptions
27740 @section Retrieving Descriptions
27741
27742 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
27743 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
27744 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
27745 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
27746 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
27747 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
27748 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
27749 Format}.
27750
27751 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
27752 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
27753 specify a file are:
27754
27755 @table @code
27756 @cindex set tdesc filename
27757 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
27758 Read the target description from @var{path}.
27759
27760 @cindex unset tdesc filename
27761 @item unset tdesc filename
27762 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
27763 will use the description supplied by the current target.
27764
27765 @cindex show tdesc filename
27766 @item show tdesc filename
27767 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
27768 @end table
27769
27770
27771 @node Target Description Format
27772 @section Target Description Format
27773 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
27774
27775 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
27776 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
27777 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
27778 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
27779 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
27780 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
27781 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
27782
27783 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
27784 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
27785 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
27786 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
27787
27788 Here is a simple target description:
27789
27790 @smallexample
27791 <target version="1.0">
27792 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
27793 </target>
27794 @end smallexample
27795
27796 @noindent
27797 This minimal description only says that the target uses
27798 the x86-64 architecture.
27799
27800 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
27801 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
27802 are explained further below.
27803
27804 @smallexample
27805 <?xml version="1.0"?>
27806 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
27807 <target version="1.0">
27808 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
27809 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
27810 </target>
27811 @end smallexample
27812
27813 @noindent
27814 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
27815 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
27816 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
27817 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
27818 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
27819 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
27820 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
27821 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
27822 the version mismatch.
27823
27824 @subsection Inclusion
27825 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
27826 @cindex XInclude
27827 @ifnotinfo
27828 @cindex <xi:include>
27829 @end ifnotinfo
27830
27831 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
27832 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
27833 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
27834 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
27835 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
27836
27837 @smallexample
27838 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
27839 @end smallexample
27840
27841 @noindent
27842 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
27843 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
27844 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
27845 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
27846 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
27847 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
27848 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
27849 original description.
27850
27851 @subsection Architecture
27852 @cindex <architecture>
27853
27854 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
27855
27856 @smallexample
27857 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
27858 @end smallexample
27859
27860 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
27861 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
27862 Debugging Target}).
27863
27864 @subsection Features
27865 @cindex <feature>
27866
27867 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
27868 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
27869 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
27870 has this form:
27871
27872 @smallexample
27873 <feature name="@var{name}">
27874 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
27875 @var{reg}@dots{}
27876 </feature>
27877 @end smallexample
27878
27879 @noindent
27880 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
27881 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
27882 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
27883 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
27884
27885 @subsection Types
27886
27887 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
27888 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
27889 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
27890 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
27891 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
27892
27893 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
27894 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
27895 Types must be defined before they are used.
27896
27897 @cindex <vector>
27898 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
27899 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
27900 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
27901 @var{count}:
27902
27903 @smallexample
27904 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
27905 @end smallexample
27906
27907 @cindex <union>
27908 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
27909 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
27910 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
27911 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
27912
27913 @smallexample
27914 <union id="@var{id}">
27915 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
27916 @dots{}
27917 </union>
27918 @end smallexample
27919
27920 @subsection Registers
27921 @cindex <reg>
27922
27923 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
27924
27925 @smallexample
27926 <reg name="@var{name}"
27927 bitsize="@var{size}"
27928 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
27929 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
27930 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
27931 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
27932 @end smallexample
27933
27934 @noindent
27935 The components are as follows:
27936
27937 @table @var
27938
27939 @item name
27940 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
27941
27942 @item bitsize
27943 The register's size, in bits.
27944
27945 @item regnum
27946 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
27947 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
27948 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
27949 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
27950 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
27951 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
27952 in order of increasing register number.
27953
27954 @item save-restore
27955 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
27956 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
27957 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
27958 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
27959 ABI.
27960
27961 @item type
27962 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
27963 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
27964 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
27965 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
27966 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
27967 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
27968
27969 @item group
27970 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
27971 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
27972 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
27973 in @code{info registers}.
27974
27975 @end table
27976
27977 @node Predefined Target Types
27978 @section Predefined Target Types
27979 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
27980
27981 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
27982 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
27983 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
27984 types. The currently supported types are:
27985
27986 @table @code
27987
27988 @item int8
27989 @itemx int16
27990 @itemx int32
27991 @itemx int64
27992 @itemx int128
27993 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
27994
27995 @item uint8
27996 @itemx uint16
27997 @itemx uint32
27998 @itemx uint64
27999 @itemx uint128
28000 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
28001
28002 @item code_ptr
28003 @itemx data_ptr
28004 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
28005 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
28006 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
28007 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
28008 may be marked as data pointers.
28009
28010 @item ieee_single
28011 Single precision IEEE floating point.
28012
28013 @item ieee_double
28014 Double precision IEEE floating point.
28015
28016 @item arm_fpa_ext
28017 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
28018
28019 @end table
28020
28021 @node Standard Target Features
28022 @section Standard Target Features
28023 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
28024
28025 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
28026 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
28027 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
28028 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
28029 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
28030 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
28031 can recognize them.
28032
28033 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
28034 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
28035 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
28036 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
28037 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
28038 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
28039 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
28040 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
28041
28042 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
28043 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
28044 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
28045
28046 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
28047 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
28048 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
28049 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
28050
28051 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
28052 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
28053 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
28054
28055 @menu
28056 * ARM Features::
28057 * MIPS Features::
28058 * M68K Features::
28059 * PowerPC Features::
28060 @end menu
28061
28062
28063 @node ARM Features
28064 @subsection ARM Features
28065 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
28066
28067 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
28068 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
28069 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
28070
28071 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
28072 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
28073
28074 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
28075 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
28076 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
28077 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
28078
28079 @node MIPS Features
28080 @subsection MIPS Features
28081 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
28082
28083 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
28084 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
28085 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
28086 on the target.
28087
28088 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
28089 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
28090 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
28091
28092 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
28093 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
28094 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
28095 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
28096
28097 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
28098 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
28099 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
28100
28101 @node M68K Features
28102 @subsection M68K Features
28103 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
28104
28105 @table @code
28106 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
28107 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
28108 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
28109 One of those features must be always present.
28110 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
28111 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
28112 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
28113 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
28114
28115 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
28116 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
28117 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
28118 @samp{fpiaddr}.
28119 @end table
28120
28121 @node PowerPC Features
28122 @subsection PowerPC Features
28123 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
28124
28125 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
28126 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
28127 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
28128 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
28129
28130 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
28131 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
28132
28133 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
28134 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
28135 and @samp{vrsave}.
28136
28137 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
28138 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
28139 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
28140 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
28141 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
28142 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
28143
28144 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
28145 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
28146 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
28147 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
28148 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
28149 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
28150 user.
28151
28152 @include gpl.texi
28153
28154 @raisesections
28155 @include fdl.texi
28156 @lowersections
28157
28158 @node Index
28159 @unnumbered Index
28160
28161 @printindex cp
28162
28163 @tex
28164 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
28165 % meantime:
28166 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
28167 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
28168 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
28169 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
28170 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
28171 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
28172 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
28173 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
28174 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
28175 \page\colophon
28176 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
28177 @end tex
28178
28179 @bye
This page took 0.620593 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.